WO2003077836A2 - Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies - Google Patents
Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- WO2003077836A2 WO2003077836A2 PCT/US2002/035728 US0235728W WO03077836A2 WO 2003077836 A2 WO2003077836 A2 WO 2003077836A2 US 0235728 W US0235728 W US 0235728W WO 03077836 A2 WO03077836 A2 WO 03077836A2
- Authority
- WO
- WIPO (PCT)
- Prior art keywords
- cells
- polypeptide
- seq
- sequence
- sequences
- Prior art date
Links
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 title claims abstract description 221
- 239000000203 mixture Substances 0.000 title claims abstract description 137
- 208000002250 Hematologic Neoplasms Diseases 0.000 title abstract description 111
- 238000001514 detection method Methods 0.000 title abstract description 36
- 238000002560 therapeutic procedure Methods 0.000 title abstract description 33
- 238000003745 diagnosis Methods 0.000 title abstract description 20
- 108090000765 processed proteins & peptides Proteins 0.000 claims abstract description 454
- 102000004196 processed proteins & peptides Human genes 0.000 claims abstract description 318
- 229920001184 polypeptide Polymers 0.000 claims abstract description 251
- 206010028980 Neoplasm Diseases 0.000 claims abstract description 40
- 239000012472 biological sample Substances 0.000 claims abstract description 31
- 201000011510 cancer Diseases 0.000 claims abstract description 15
- 108090000623 proteins and genes Proteins 0.000 claims description 185
- 102000040430 polynucleotide Human genes 0.000 claims description 164
- 108091033319 polynucleotide Proteins 0.000 claims description 164
- 239000002157 polynucleotide Substances 0.000 claims description 164
- 210000001744 T-lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 claims description 105
- 102000004169 proteins and genes Human genes 0.000 claims description 104
- 230000014509 gene expression Effects 0.000 claims description 79
- 150000001413 amino acids Chemical class 0.000 claims description 53
- 239000000523 sample Substances 0.000 claims description 50
- 239000002773 nucleotide Substances 0.000 claims description 41
- 125000003729 nucleotide group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 41
- 210000000612 antigen-presenting cell Anatomy 0.000 claims description 31
- 239000013604 expression vector Substances 0.000 claims description 28
- 239000008194 pharmaceutical composition Substances 0.000 claims description 20
- 108091034117 Oligonucleotide Proteins 0.000 claims description 16
- JLCPHMBAVCMARE-UHFFFAOYSA-N [3-[[3-[[3-[[3-[[3-[[3-[[3-[[3-[[3-[[3-[[3-[[5-(2-amino-6-oxo-1H-purin-9-yl)-3-[[3-[[3-[[3-[[3-[[3-[[5-(2-amino-6-oxo-1H-purin-9-yl)-3-[[5-(2-amino-6-oxo-1H-purin-9-yl)-3-hydroxyoxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxyoxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(5-methyl-2,4-dioxopyrimidin-1-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(6-aminopurin-9-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(6-aminopurin-9-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(6-aminopurin-9-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(6-aminopurin-9-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxyoxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(5-methyl-2,4-dioxopyrimidin-1-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(4-amino-2-oxopyrimidin-1-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(5-methyl-2,4-dioxopyrimidin-1-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(5-methyl-2,4-dioxopyrimidin-1-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(6-aminopurin-9-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(6-aminopurin-9-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(4-amino-2-oxopyrimidin-1-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(4-amino-2-oxopyrimidin-1-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(4-amino-2-oxopyrimidin-1-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(6-aminopurin-9-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-5-(4-amino-2-oxopyrimidin-1-yl)oxolan-2-yl]methyl [5-(6-aminopurin-9-yl)-2-(hydroxymethyl)oxolan-3-yl] hydrogen phosphate Polymers Cc1cn(C2CC(OP(O)(=O)OCC3OC(CC3OP(O)(=O)OCC3OC(CC3O)n3cnc4c3nc(N)[nH]c4=O)n3cnc4c3nc(N)[nH]c4=O)C(COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3COP(O)(=O)OC3CC(OC3CO)n3cnc4c(N)ncnc34)n3ccc(N)nc3=O)n3cnc4c(N)ncnc34)n3ccc(N)nc3=O)n3ccc(N)nc3=O)n3ccc(N)nc3=O)n3cnc4c(N)ncnc34)n3cnc4c(N)ncnc34)n3cc(C)c(=O)[nH]c3=O)n3cc(C)c(=O)[nH]c3=O)n3ccc(N)nc3=O)n3cc(C)c(=O)[nH]c3=O)n3cnc4c3nc(N)[nH]c4=O)n3cnc4c(N)ncnc34)n3cnc4c(N)ncnc34)n3cnc4c(N)ncnc34)n3cnc4c(N)ncnc34)O2)c(=O)[nH]c1=O JLCPHMBAVCMARE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 16
- 238000006243 chemical reaction Methods 0.000 claims description 15
- 230000003308 immunostimulating effect Effects 0.000 claims description 13
- 239000000969 carrier Substances 0.000 claims description 12
- 229960001438 immunostimulant agent Drugs 0.000 claims description 12
- 239000003022 immunostimulating agent Substances 0.000 claims description 12
- 238000011161 development Methods 0.000 claims description 10
- 230000028993 immune response Effects 0.000 claims description 10
- 230000000638 stimulation Effects 0.000 claims description 10
- 239000011230 binding agent Substances 0.000 claims description 8
- 230000004936 stimulating effect Effects 0.000 claims description 3
- 208000010839 B-cell chronic lymphocytic leukemia Diseases 0.000 claims description 2
- 230000002401 inhibitory effect Effects 0.000 claims 2
- 210000001266 CD8-positive T-lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 claims 1
- 238000003757 reverse transcription PCR Methods 0.000 claims 1
- 210000004027 cell Anatomy 0.000 abstract description 178
- 206010066476 Haematological malignancy Diseases 0.000 abstract description 89
- 239000012634 fragment Substances 0.000 abstract description 77
- 208000037265 diseases, disorders, signs and symptoms Diseases 0.000 abstract description 24
- 241001465754 Metazoa Species 0.000 abstract description 23
- 230000001225 therapeutic effect Effects 0.000 abstract description 23
- 201000010099 disease Diseases 0.000 abstract description 20
- 206010025323 Lymphomas Diseases 0.000 abstract description 13
- 230000005867 T cell response Effects 0.000 abstract description 13
- 230000000890 antigenic effect Effects 0.000 abstract description 10
- 208000004736 B-Cell Leukemia Diseases 0.000 abstract description 8
- 208000003950 B-cell lymphoma Diseases 0.000 abstract description 8
- 208000034578 Multiple myelomas Diseases 0.000 abstract description 8
- 208000032839 leukemia Diseases 0.000 abstract description 8
- 238000004393 prognosis Methods 0.000 abstract description 7
- 230000036210 malignancy Effects 0.000 abstract description 3
- 230000002265 prevention Effects 0.000 abstract description 3
- 230000006450 immune cell response Effects 0.000 abstract description 2
- 108020004414 DNA Proteins 0.000 description 111
- 235000018102 proteins Nutrition 0.000 description 98
- 230000027455 binding Effects 0.000 description 86
- 150000007523 nucleic acids Chemical group 0.000 description 86
- 238000009739 binding Methods 0.000 description 85
- 239000000427 antigen Substances 0.000 description 82
- 108091007433 antigens Proteins 0.000 description 81
- 102000036639 antigens Human genes 0.000 description 81
- 239000013598 vector Substances 0.000 description 74
- 108091032973 (ribonucleotides)n+m Proteins 0.000 description 73
- 102000039446 nucleic acids Human genes 0.000 description 64
- 108020004707 nucleic acids Proteins 0.000 description 64
- 108091092562 ribozyme Proteins 0.000 description 53
- 108090000994 Catalytic RNA Proteins 0.000 description 52
- 102000053642 Catalytic RNA Human genes 0.000 description 52
- 125000003275 alpha amino acid group Chemical group 0.000 description 51
- 235000001014 amino acid Nutrition 0.000 description 51
- 229940024606 amino acid Drugs 0.000 description 50
- 229940035032 monophosphoryl lipid a Drugs 0.000 description 47
- 239000002671 adjuvant Substances 0.000 description 44
- 108091028043 Nucleic acid sequence Proteins 0.000 description 41
- 241000701161 unidentified adenovirus Species 0.000 description 40
- 108091093037 Peptide nucleic acid Proteins 0.000 description 37
- COLNVLDHVKWLRT-QMMMGPOBSA-N L-phenylalanine Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CC1=CC=CC=C1 COLNVLDHVKWLRT-QMMMGPOBSA-N 0.000 description 35
- 230000003321 amplification Effects 0.000 description 34
- 238000003199 nucleic acid amplification method Methods 0.000 description 34
- 239000003795 chemical substances by application Substances 0.000 description 33
- 150000001875 compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 33
- 230000000295 complement effect Effects 0.000 description 31
- 230000015572 biosynthetic process Effects 0.000 description 30
- 239000003814 drug Substances 0.000 description 30
- 238000012384 transportation and delivery Methods 0.000 description 30
- 241000700605 Viruses Species 0.000 description 29
- 238000009472 formulation Methods 0.000 description 29
- 229960005486 vaccine Drugs 0.000 description 29
- 108091026890 Coding region Proteins 0.000 description 28
- 239000002502 liposome Substances 0.000 description 27
- -1 antibody Proteins 0.000 description 26
- 230000000694 effects Effects 0.000 description 26
- 238000009396 hybridization Methods 0.000 description 26
- 238000000338 in vitro Methods 0.000 description 26
- 125000005647 linker group Chemical group 0.000 description 25
- 238000007792 addition Methods 0.000 description 24
- 108020004999 messenger RNA Proteins 0.000 description 24
- 238000003786 synthesis reaction Methods 0.000 description 24
- 102000053602 DNA Human genes 0.000 description 23
- 241000282414 Homo sapiens Species 0.000 description 23
- 230000002163 immunogen Effects 0.000 description 22
- 238000002360 preparation method Methods 0.000 description 22
- 210000004443 dendritic cell Anatomy 0.000 description 21
- 239000000243 solution Substances 0.000 description 21
- 230000003612 virological effect Effects 0.000 description 21
- 102000037865 fusion proteins Human genes 0.000 description 20
- 108020001507 fusion proteins Proteins 0.000 description 20
- 102000004190 Enzymes Human genes 0.000 description 19
- 108090000790 Enzymes Proteins 0.000 description 19
- 238000003556 assay Methods 0.000 description 19
- 229940088598 enzyme Drugs 0.000 description 19
- 239000000047 product Substances 0.000 description 19
- 230000000692 anti-sense effect Effects 0.000 description 18
- 238000001727 in vivo Methods 0.000 description 18
- 238000004519 manufacturing process Methods 0.000 description 18
- 230000004048 modification Effects 0.000 description 18
- 238000012986 modification Methods 0.000 description 18
- 230000035755 proliferation Effects 0.000 description 18
- 230000004044 response Effects 0.000 description 18
- 239000000126 substance Substances 0.000 description 18
- 210000001519 tissue Anatomy 0.000 description 18
- 239000003153 chemical reaction reagent Substances 0.000 description 17
- 230000014616 translation Effects 0.000 description 17
- 238000011282 treatment Methods 0.000 description 17
- 230000002255 enzymatic effect Effects 0.000 description 16
- 230000004927 fusion Effects 0.000 description 16
- 238000013518 transcription Methods 0.000 description 16
- 230000035897 transcription Effects 0.000 description 16
- 150000003839 salts Chemical class 0.000 description 15
- 102000004127 Cytokines Human genes 0.000 description 14
- 108090000695 Cytokines Proteins 0.000 description 14
- 238000004458 analytical method Methods 0.000 description 14
- 230000001580 bacterial effect Effects 0.000 description 14
- 239000002299 complementary DNA Substances 0.000 description 14
- 239000013612 plasmid Substances 0.000 description 14
- 238000013519 translation Methods 0.000 description 14
- 239000002585 base Substances 0.000 description 13
- 238000003776 cleavage reaction Methods 0.000 description 13
- 238000012217 deletion Methods 0.000 description 13
- 230000037430 deletion Effects 0.000 description 13
- 239000002158 endotoxin Substances 0.000 description 13
- GZQKNULLWNGMCW-PWQABINMSA-N lipid A (E. coli) Chemical compound O1[C@H](CO)[C@@H](OP(O)(O)=O)[C@H](OC(=O)C[C@@H](CCCCCCCCCCC)OC(=O)CCCCCCCCCCCCC)[C@@H](NC(=O)C[C@@H](CCCCCCCCCCC)OC(=O)CCCCCCCCCCC)[C@@H]1OC[C@@H]1[C@@H](O)[C@H](OC(=O)C[C@H](O)CCCCCCCCCCC)[C@@H](NC(=O)C[C@H](O)CCCCCCCCCCC)[C@@H](OP(O)(O)=O)O1 GZQKNULLWNGMCW-PWQABINMSA-N 0.000 description 13
- 239000002245 particle Substances 0.000 description 13
- 238000003752 polymerase chain reaction Methods 0.000 description 13
- 230000008569 process Effects 0.000 description 13
- 230000007017 scission Effects 0.000 description 13
- 102000008394 Immunoglobulin Fragments Human genes 0.000 description 12
- 108010021625 Immunoglobulin Fragments Proteins 0.000 description 12
- 230000004913 activation Effects 0.000 description 12
- 238000005516 engineering process Methods 0.000 description 12
- 230000006870 function Effects 0.000 description 12
- 230000002068 genetic effect Effects 0.000 description 12
- 238000002649 immunization Methods 0.000 description 12
- 230000003053 immunization Effects 0.000 description 12
- 230000001965 increasing effect Effects 0.000 description 12
- 238000000746 purification Methods 0.000 description 12
- 239000000758 substrate Substances 0.000 description 12
- 241000702421 Dependoparvovirus Species 0.000 description 11
- 101000716102 Homo sapiens T-cell surface glycoprotein CD4 Proteins 0.000 description 11
- 241000699670 Mus sp. Species 0.000 description 11
- 230000008901 benefit Effects 0.000 description 11
- 229940079593 drug Drugs 0.000 description 11
- 238000011534 incubation Methods 0.000 description 11
- 230000001105 regulatory effect Effects 0.000 description 11
- 230000010076 replication Effects 0.000 description 11
- 238000002741 site-directed mutagenesis Methods 0.000 description 11
- 239000007787 solid Substances 0.000 description 11
- 241000894007 species Species 0.000 description 11
- 238000006467 substitution reaction Methods 0.000 description 11
- 238000002965 ELISA Methods 0.000 description 10
- 108010002350 Interleukin-2 Proteins 0.000 description 10
- 102000000588 Interleukin-2 Human genes 0.000 description 10
- 102100036011 T-cell surface glycoprotein CD4 Human genes 0.000 description 10
- 238000013459 approach Methods 0.000 description 10
- 230000001419 dependent effect Effects 0.000 description 10
- 230000001404 mediated effect Effects 0.000 description 10
- 230000035772 mutation Effects 0.000 description 10
- 239000003981 vehicle Substances 0.000 description 10
- 230000008878 coupling Effects 0.000 description 9
- 238000010168 coupling process Methods 0.000 description 9
- 238000005859 coupling reaction Methods 0.000 description 9
- 239000003623 enhancer Substances 0.000 description 9
- 230000010354 integration Effects 0.000 description 9
- 210000004962 mammalian cell Anatomy 0.000 description 9
- 239000003550 marker Substances 0.000 description 9
- 230000007246 mechanism Effects 0.000 description 9
- 239000004005 microsphere Substances 0.000 description 9
- 238000004806 packaging method and process Methods 0.000 description 9
- 210000005259 peripheral blood Anatomy 0.000 description 9
- 239000011886 peripheral blood Substances 0.000 description 9
- 238000010561 standard procedure Methods 0.000 description 9
- 229940124597 therapeutic agent Drugs 0.000 description 9
- 238000001890 transfection Methods 0.000 description 9
- YBJHBAHKTGYVGT-ZKWXMUAHSA-N (+)-Biotin Chemical compound N1C(=O)N[C@@H]2[C@H](CCCCC(=O)O)SC[C@@H]21 YBJHBAHKTGYVGT-ZKWXMUAHSA-N 0.000 description 8
- 241000124008 Mammalia Species 0.000 description 8
- 239000004480 active ingredient Substances 0.000 description 8
- 210000001185 bone marrow Anatomy 0.000 description 8
- 239000000872 buffer Substances 0.000 description 8
- 230000018109 developmental process Effects 0.000 description 8
- 238000003018 immunoassay Methods 0.000 description 8
- 208000015181 infectious disease Diseases 0.000 description 8
- 239000012071 phase Substances 0.000 description 8
- 230000009257 reactivity Effects 0.000 description 8
- 102000005962 receptors Human genes 0.000 description 8
- 108020003175 receptors Proteins 0.000 description 8
- 210000002966 serum Anatomy 0.000 description 8
- 238000012546 transfer Methods 0.000 description 8
- XETCRXVKJHBPMK-MJSODCSWSA-N trehalose 6,6'-dimycolate Chemical compound C([C@@H]1[C@H]([C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H](O[C@@H]2[C@@H]([C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](COC(=O)C(CCCCCCCCCCC3C(C3)CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC)C(O)CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC)O2)O)O1)O)OC(=O)C(C(O)CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC)CCCCCCCCCCC1CC1CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC XETCRXVKJHBPMK-MJSODCSWSA-N 0.000 description 8
- 108020004705 Codon Proteins 0.000 description 7
- 108090000626 DNA-directed RNA polymerases Proteins 0.000 description 7
- 102000004163 DNA-directed RNA polymerases Human genes 0.000 description 7
- 241000588724 Escherichia coli Species 0.000 description 7
- 102000001706 Immunoglobulin Fab Fragments Human genes 0.000 description 7
- 108010054477 Immunoglobulin Fab Fragments Proteins 0.000 description 7
- 108091007491 NSP3 Papain-like protease domains Proteins 0.000 description 7
- 208000015914 Non-Hodgkin lymphomas Diseases 0.000 description 7
- 108091081024 Start codon Proteins 0.000 description 7
- 230000006044 T cell activation Effects 0.000 description 7
- 239000002253 acid Substances 0.000 description 7
- 230000001413 cellular effect Effects 0.000 description 7
- 238000010367 cloning Methods 0.000 description 7
- 210000004408 hybridoma Anatomy 0.000 description 7
- 238000003780 insertion Methods 0.000 description 7
- 230000037431 insertion Effects 0.000 description 7
- 239000007788 liquid Substances 0.000 description 7
- 230000007935 neutral effect Effects 0.000 description 7
- 238000012552 review Methods 0.000 description 7
- 102000040650 (ribonucleotides)n+m Human genes 0.000 description 6
- 241000894006 Bacteria Species 0.000 description 6
- PEDCQBHIVMGVHV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Glycerine Chemical compound OCC(O)CO PEDCQBHIVMGVHV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- DHMQDGOQFOQNFH-UHFFFAOYSA-N Glycine Chemical compound NCC(O)=O DHMQDGOQFOQNFH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 108060003951 Immunoglobulin Proteins 0.000 description 6
- 108700026244 Open Reading Frames Proteins 0.000 description 6
- 240000004808 Saccharomyces cerevisiae Species 0.000 description 6
- 235000014680 Saccharomyces cerevisiae Nutrition 0.000 description 6
- FAPWRFPIFSIZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-M Sodium chloride Chemical compound [Na+].[Cl-] FAPWRFPIFSIZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 6
- 230000009471 action Effects 0.000 description 6
- 125000000539 amino acid group Chemical group 0.000 description 6
- 239000011324 bead Substances 0.000 description 6
- 239000008280 blood Substances 0.000 description 6
- 230000021615 conjugation Effects 0.000 description 6
- 230000002950 deficient Effects 0.000 description 6
- 230000029087 digestion Effects 0.000 description 6
- 231100000655 enterotoxin Toxicity 0.000 description 6
- 150000004676 glycans Chemical class 0.000 description 6
- 230000001900 immune effect Effects 0.000 description 6
- 102000018358 immunoglobulin Human genes 0.000 description 6
- 238000002347 injection Methods 0.000 description 6
- 239000007924 injection Substances 0.000 description 6
- 239000012528 membrane Substances 0.000 description 6
- 210000004379 membrane Anatomy 0.000 description 6
- 238000012544 monitoring process Methods 0.000 description 6
- 229920001282 polysaccharide Polymers 0.000 description 6
- 239000005017 polysaccharide Substances 0.000 description 6
- 238000011321 prophylaxis Methods 0.000 description 6
- 125000006853 reporter group Chemical group 0.000 description 6
- 230000001177 retroviral effect Effects 0.000 description 6
- 230000002103 transcriptional effect Effects 0.000 description 6
- 210000004881 tumor cell Anatomy 0.000 description 6
- XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N water Substances O XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- MTCFGRXMJLQNBG-REOHCLBHSA-N (2S)-2-Amino-3-hydroxypropansäure Chemical compound OC[C@H](N)C(O)=O MTCFGRXMJLQNBG-REOHCLBHSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 108020000948 Antisense Oligonucleotides Proteins 0.000 description 5
- 108090000565 Capsid Proteins Proteins 0.000 description 5
- 108010039939 Cell Wall Skeleton Proteins 0.000 description 5
- 102100023321 Ceruloplasmin Human genes 0.000 description 5
- 241000196324 Embryophyta Species 0.000 description 5
- 241000282412 Homo Species 0.000 description 5
- AYFVYJQAPQTCCC-GBXIJSLDSA-N L-threonine Chemical compound C[C@@H](O)[C@H](N)C(O)=O AYFVYJQAPQTCCC-GBXIJSLDSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 206010035226 Plasma cell myeloma Diseases 0.000 description 5
- 239000004365 Protease Substances 0.000 description 5
- 108020004511 Recombinant DNA Proteins 0.000 description 5
- 108010008281 Recombinant Fusion Proteins Proteins 0.000 description 5
- 102000007056 Recombinant Fusion Proteins Human genes 0.000 description 5
- 241000251131 Sphyrna Species 0.000 description 5
- 108020005202 Viral DNA Proteins 0.000 description 5
- 150000007513 acids Chemical class 0.000 description 5
- 238000001042 affinity chromatography Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000005875 antibody response Effects 0.000 description 5
- 239000002246 antineoplastic agent Substances 0.000 description 5
- 239000000074 antisense oligonucleotide Substances 0.000 description 5
- 238000012230 antisense oligonucleotides Methods 0.000 description 5
- 239000007864 aqueous solution Substances 0.000 description 5
- 230000004071 biological effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 210000004369 blood Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 230000015556 catabolic process Effects 0.000 description 5
- 210000004520 cell wall skeleton Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 230000009089 cytolysis Effects 0.000 description 5
- 230000001461 cytolytic effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 239000006185 dispersion Substances 0.000 description 5
- 239000012530 fluid Substances 0.000 description 5
- 210000002443 helper t lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 229940127121 immunoconjugate Drugs 0.000 description 5
- 230000001976 improved effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 230000006698 induction Effects 0.000 description 5
- 238000007918 intramuscular administration Methods 0.000 description 5
- 238000002372 labelling Methods 0.000 description 5
- 150000002632 lipids Chemical class 0.000 description 5
- 230000003211 malignant effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 239000011159 matrix material Substances 0.000 description 5
- 244000005700 microbiome Species 0.000 description 5
- 238000002703 mutagenesis Methods 0.000 description 5
- 231100000350 mutagenesis Toxicity 0.000 description 5
- 239000002088 nanocapsule Substances 0.000 description 5
- 230000036961 partial effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 210000005105 peripheral blood lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 238000012545 processing Methods 0.000 description 5
- 238000012216 screening Methods 0.000 description 5
- 238000007920 subcutaneous administration Methods 0.000 description 5
- 238000012360 testing method Methods 0.000 description 5
- 239000013603 viral vector Substances 0.000 description 5
- OYPRJOBELJOOCE-UHFFFAOYSA-N Calcium Chemical compound [Ca] OYPRJOBELJOOCE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 108020004635 Complementary DNA Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 230000004543 DNA replication Effects 0.000 description 4
- LFQSCWFLJHTTHZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Ethanol Chemical compound CCO LFQSCWFLJHTTHZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 108091060211 Expressed sequence tag Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 108010017213 Granulocyte-Macrophage Colony-Stimulating Factor Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 102100039620 Granulocyte-macrophage colony-stimulating factor Human genes 0.000 description 4
- 101000611183 Homo sapiens Tumor necrosis factor Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 102100034343 Integrase Human genes 0.000 description 4
- XUJNEKJLAYXESH-REOHCLBHSA-N L-Cysteine Chemical compound SC[C@H](N)C(O)=O XUJNEKJLAYXESH-REOHCLBHSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 241000283973 Oryctolagus cuniculus Species 0.000 description 4
- 108090000526 Papain Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 102000057297 Pepsin A Human genes 0.000 description 4
- 108090000284 Pepsin A Proteins 0.000 description 4
- ISWSIDIOOBJBQZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Phenol Chemical compound OC1=CC=CC=C1 ISWSIDIOOBJBQZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 241000700159 Rattus Species 0.000 description 4
- 108091008874 T cell receptors Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 102000016266 T-Cell Antigen Receptors Human genes 0.000 description 4
- IQFYYKKMVGJFEH-XLPZGREQSA-N Thymidine Chemical compound O=C1NC(=O)C(C)=CN1[C@@H]1O[C@H](CO)[C@@H](O)C1 IQFYYKKMVGJFEH-XLPZGREQSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 102100040247 Tumor necrosis factor Human genes 0.000 description 4
- 239000013543 active substance Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000000443 aerosol Substances 0.000 description 4
- 210000003719 b-lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 4
- 229960002685 biotin Drugs 0.000 description 4
- 239000011616 biotin Substances 0.000 description 4
- 235000020958 biotin Nutrition 0.000 description 4
- 210000004899 c-terminal region Anatomy 0.000 description 4
- 239000011575 calcium Substances 0.000 description 4
- 229910052791 calcium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 210000000170 cell membrane Anatomy 0.000 description 4
- 230000008859 change Effects 0.000 description 4
- 238000000576 coating method Methods 0.000 description 4
- 230000001186 cumulative effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 235000018417 cysteine Nutrition 0.000 description 4
- 230000004069 differentiation Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000002612 dispersion medium Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000000147 enterotoxin Substances 0.000 description 4
- RWSXRVCMGQZWBV-WDSKDSINSA-N glutathione Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CCC(=O)N[C@@H](CS)C(=O)NCC(O)=O RWSXRVCMGQZWBV-WDSKDSINSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 230000012010 growth Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000001963 growth medium Substances 0.000 description 4
- 230000005847 immunogenicity Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000016784 immunoglobulin production Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000001939 inductive effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 238000001802 infusion Methods 0.000 description 4
- 239000003112 inhibitor Substances 0.000 description 4
- 230000005764 inhibitory process Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000000977 initiatory effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000003834 intracellular effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 238000001990 intravenous administration Methods 0.000 description 4
- 229920006008 lipopolysaccharide Polymers 0.000 description 4
- 239000000463 material Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000002609 medium Substances 0.000 description 4
- BSOQXXWZTUDTEL-ZUYCGGNHSA-N muramyl dipeptide Chemical compound OC(=O)CC[C@H](C(N)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](C)NC(=O)[C@@H](C)O[C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@@H](O)[C@@H]1NC(C)=O BSOQXXWZTUDTEL-ZUYCGGNHSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 201000000050 myeloid neoplasm Diseases 0.000 description 4
- 239000002105 nanoparticle Substances 0.000 description 4
- 229940055729 papain Drugs 0.000 description 4
- 235000019834 papain Nutrition 0.000 description 4
- 238000010647 peptide synthesis reaction Methods 0.000 description 4
- 239000000546 pharmaceutical excipient Substances 0.000 description 4
- 230000003389 potentiating effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 238000001556 precipitation Methods 0.000 description 4
- 239000003755 preservative agent Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000011541 reaction mixture Substances 0.000 description 4
- 230000028327 secretion Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000011780 sodium chloride Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000007790 solid phase Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000002904 solvent Substances 0.000 description 4
- 238000001179 sorption measurement Methods 0.000 description 4
- 235000000346 sugar Nutrition 0.000 description 4
- 231100000617 superantigen Toxicity 0.000 description 4
- 239000004094 surface-active agent Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000000725 suspension Substances 0.000 description 4
- 230000002194 synthesizing effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000008685 targeting Effects 0.000 description 4
- 125000003396 thiol group Chemical group [H]S* 0.000 description 4
- 108700028369 Alleles Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 206010003445 Ascites Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 208000035143 Bacterial infection Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 241000283707 Capra Species 0.000 description 3
- VYZAMTAEIAYCRO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Chromium Chemical compound [Cr] VYZAMTAEIAYCRO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 241000759568 Corixa Species 0.000 description 3
- WQZGKKKJIJFFOK-QTVWNMPRSA-N D-mannopyranose Chemical compound OC[C@H]1OC(O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H]1O WQZGKKKJIJFFOK-QTVWNMPRSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 102100037840 Dehydrogenase/reductase SDR family member 2, mitochondrial Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 229920002307 Dextran Polymers 0.000 description 3
- KCXVZYZYPLLWCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N EDTA Chemical compound OC(=O)CN(CC(O)=O)CCN(CC(O)=O)CC(O)=O KCXVZYZYPLLWCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 108010013369 Enteropeptidase Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 102100029727 Enteropeptidase Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 108700024394 Exon Proteins 0.000 description 3
- WQZGKKKJIJFFOK-GASJEMHNSA-N Glucose Natural products OC[C@H]1OC(O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H]1O WQZGKKKJIJFFOK-GASJEMHNSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 108010070675 Glutathione transferase Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 102100029100 Hematopoietic prostaglandin D synthase Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 108091027305 Heteroduplex Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 241001135569 Human adenovirus 5 Species 0.000 description 3
- 102000018071 Immunoglobulin Fc Fragments Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 108010091135 Immunoglobulin Fc Fragments Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 101710203526 Integrase Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 108010074328 Interferon-gamma Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 108091092195 Intron Proteins 0.000 description 3
- DCXYFEDJOCDNAF-REOHCLBHSA-N L-asparagine Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CC(N)=O DCXYFEDJOCDNAF-REOHCLBHSA-N 0.000 description 3
- OUYCCCASQSFEME-QMMMGPOBSA-N L-tyrosine Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CC1=CC=C(O)C=C1 OUYCCCASQSFEME-QMMMGPOBSA-N 0.000 description 3
- KDXKERNSBIXSRK-UHFFFAOYSA-N Lysine Natural products NCCCCC(N)C(O)=O KDXKERNSBIXSRK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 241000699666 Mus <mouse, genus> Species 0.000 description 3
- 241001494479 Pecora Species 0.000 description 3
- 101710182846 Polyhedrin Proteins 0.000 description 3
- DNIAPMSPPWPWGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N Propylene glycol Chemical compound CC(O)CO DNIAPMSPPWPWGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 101710188053 Protein D Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 101710132893 Resolvase Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 102000006382 Ribonucleases Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 108010083644 Ribonucleases Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 241000723873 Tobacco mosaic virus Species 0.000 description 3
- 108060008682 Tumor Necrosis Factor Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 102000000852 Tumor Necrosis Factor-alpha Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 239000008351 acetate buffer Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000002411 adverse Effects 0.000 description 3
- WNROFYMDJYEPJX-UHFFFAOYSA-K aluminium hydroxide Chemical compound [OH-].[OH-].[OH-].[Al+3] WNROFYMDJYEPJX-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 3
- 229940024545 aluminum hydroxide Drugs 0.000 description 3
- 239000003242 anti bacterial agent Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000000844 anti-bacterial effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000003429 antifungal agent Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229940121375 antifungal agent Drugs 0.000 description 3
- WQZGKKKJIJFFOK-VFUOTHLCSA-N beta-D-glucose Chemical compound OC[C@H]1O[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H]1O WQZGKKKJIJFFOK-VFUOTHLCSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 239000001506 calcium phosphate Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229910000389 calcium phosphate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 235000011010 calcium phosphates Nutrition 0.000 description 3
- 125000003178 carboxy group Chemical group [H]OC(*)=O 0.000 description 3
- 238000012512 characterization method Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000007795 chemical reaction product Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229910052804 chromium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 239000011651 chromium Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000002759 chromosomal effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 210000000349 chromosome Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 238000010276 construction Methods 0.000 description 3
- 125000004122 cyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- XUJNEKJLAYXESH-UHFFFAOYSA-N cysteine Natural products SCC(N)C(O)=O XUJNEKJLAYXESH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 230000007812 deficiency Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000006731 degradation reaction Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000000432 density-gradient centrifugation Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000003085 diluting agent Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000000539 dimer Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000003292 diminished effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000003937 drug carrier Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000000975 dye Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000002708 enhancing effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 210000002919 epithelial cell Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 210000003527 eukaryotic cell Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 238000000605 extraction Methods 0.000 description 3
- 150000004665 fatty acids Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 150000002190 fatty acyls Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 125000001924 fatty-acyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 108700004026 gag Genes Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 239000000499 gel Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000007429 general method Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000008103 glucose Substances 0.000 description 3
- 210000003958 hematopoietic stem cell Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 108060003552 hemocyanin Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 210000003494 hepatocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 230000007062 hydrolysis Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000006460 hydrolysis reaction Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000002209 hydrophobic effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000002513 implantation Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000036512 infertility Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000004615 ingredient Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000007912 intraperitoneal administration Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000009545 invasion Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000002955 isolation Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000007951 isotonicity adjuster Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000003446 ligand Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000002101 lytic effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 210000002540 macrophage Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 238000012423 maintenance Methods 0.000 description 3
- 229910052751 metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 239000002184 metal Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000002493 microarray Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000003278 mimic effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 210000001616 monocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 239000013642 negative control Substances 0.000 description 3
- 231100000252 nontoxic Toxicity 0.000 description 3
- 230000003000 nontoxic effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000003921 oil Substances 0.000 description 3
- 235000019198 oils Nutrition 0.000 description 3
- 229920001542 oligosaccharide Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 150000002482 oligosaccharides Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 210000000056 organ Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 230000001717 pathogenic effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 229940111202 pepsin Drugs 0.000 description 3
- 230000035699 permeability Effects 0.000 description 3
- 150000003904 phospholipids Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 230000008488 polyadenylation Effects 0.000 description 3
- 229920001223 polyethylene glycol Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 239000000843 powder Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000002243 precursor Substances 0.000 description 3
- 125000002924 primary amino group Chemical group [H]N([H])* 0.000 description 3
- 230000037452 priming Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000001243 protein synthesis Methods 0.000 description 3
- 150000003212 purines Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 230000002285 radioactive effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000003127 radioimmunoassay Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000006798 recombination Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000011084 recovery Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000009467 reduction Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000000241 respiratory effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 108091008146 restriction endonucleases Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 238000010839 reverse transcription Methods 0.000 description 3
- 150000003384 small molecules Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 210000004989 spleen cell Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 150000008163 sugars Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 238000013268 sustained release Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000012730 sustained-release form Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000000699 topical effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 231100000419 toxicity Toxicity 0.000 description 3
- 239000003053 toxin Substances 0.000 description 3
- 231100000765 toxin Toxicity 0.000 description 3
- 108700012359 toxins Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 230000009466 transformation Effects 0.000 description 3
- QORWJWZARLRLPR-UHFFFAOYSA-H tricalcium bis(phosphate) Chemical compound [Ca+2].[Ca+2].[Ca+2].[O-]P([O-])([O-])=O.[O-]P([O-])([O-])=O QORWJWZARLRLPR-UHFFFAOYSA-H 0.000 description 3
- 241001430294 unidentified retrovirus Species 0.000 description 3
- 238000011144 upstream manufacturing Methods 0.000 description 3
- 210000002845 virion Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 238000005406 washing Methods 0.000 description 3
- 125000003088 (fluoren-9-ylmethoxy)carbonyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- IQFYYKKMVGJFEH-OFKYTIFKSA-N 1-[(2r,4s,5r)-4-hydroxy-5-(tritiooxymethyl)oxolan-2-yl]-5-methylpyrimidine-2,4-dione Chemical compound C1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO[3H])O[C@H]1N1C(=O)NC(=O)C(C)=C1 IQFYYKKMVGJFEH-OFKYTIFKSA-N 0.000 description 2
- NFGXHKASABOEEW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-methylethyl 11-methoxy-3,7,11-trimethyl-2,4-dodecadienoate Chemical compound COC(C)(C)CCCC(C)CC=CC(C)=CC(=O)OC(C)C NFGXHKASABOEEW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- KDCGOANMDULRCW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 7H-purine Chemical compound N1=CNC2=NC=NC2=C1 KDCGOANMDULRCW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 208000024893 Acute lymphoblastic leukemia Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 208000014697 Acute lymphocytic leukaemia Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 206010001258 Adenoviral infections Diseases 0.000 description 2
- QGZKDVFQNNGYKY-UHFFFAOYSA-O Ammonium Chemical compound [NH4+] QGZKDVFQNNGYKY-UHFFFAOYSA-O 0.000 description 2
- IJGRMHOSHXDMSA-UHFFFAOYSA-N Atomic nitrogen Chemical compound N#N IJGRMHOSHXDMSA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 241000201370 Autographa californica nucleopolyhedrovirus Species 0.000 description 2
- 208000032791 BCR-ABL1 positive chronic myelogenous leukemia Diseases 0.000 description 2
- DWRXFEITVBNRMK-UHFFFAOYSA-N Beta-D-1-Arabinofuranosylthymine Natural products O=C1NC(=O)C(C)=CN1C1C(O)C(O)C(CO)O1 DWRXFEITVBNRMK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 108091003079 Bovine Serum Albumin Proteins 0.000 description 2
- FERIUCNNQQJTOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N Butyric acid Chemical compound CCCC(O)=O FERIUCNNQQJTOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 101710132601 Capsid protein Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 241001227713 Chiron Species 0.000 description 2
- 229920002101 Chitin Polymers 0.000 description 2
- HEDRZPFGACZZDS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Chloroform Chemical compound ClC(Cl)Cl HEDRZPFGACZZDS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 208000010833 Chronic myeloid leukaemia Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 108700010070 Codon Usage Proteins 0.000 description 2
- FBPFZTCFMRRESA-KVTDHHQDSA-N D-Mannitol Chemical compound OC[C@@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H](O)CO FBPFZTCFMRRESA-KVTDHHQDSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 108010017826 DNA Polymerase I Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 102000004594 DNA Polymerase I Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108010014303 DNA-directed DNA polymerase Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 102000016928 DNA-directed DNA polymerase Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108010042407 Endonucleases Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 108010074860 Factor Xa Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 229920001917 Ficoll Polymers 0.000 description 2
- ZHNUHDYFZUAESO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Formamide Chemical compound NC=O ZHNUHDYFZUAESO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 108700007698 Genetic Terminator Regions Proteins 0.000 description 2
- WHUUTDBJXJRKMK-UHFFFAOYSA-N Glutamic acid Natural products OC(=O)C(N)CCC(O)=O WHUUTDBJXJRKMK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 108010024636 Glutathione Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 239000004471 Glycine Substances 0.000 description 2
- 108091027874 Group I catalytic intron Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 241000724709 Hepatitis delta virus Species 0.000 description 2
- 241000238631 Hexapoda Species 0.000 description 2
- 208000017604 Hodgkin disease Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 208000010747 Hodgkins lymphoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 241000598171 Human adenovirus sp. Species 0.000 description 2
- DGAQECJNVWCQMB-PUAWFVPOSA-M Ilexoside XXIX Chemical compound C[C@@H]1CC[C@@]2(CC[C@@]3(C(=CC[C@H]4[C@]3(CC[C@@H]5[C@@]4(CC[C@@H](C5(C)C)OS(=O)(=O)[O-])C)C)[C@@H]2[C@]1(C)O)C)C(=O)O[C@H]6[C@@H]([C@H]([C@@H]([C@H](O6)CO)O)O)O.[Na+] DGAQECJNVWCQMB-PUAWFVPOSA-M 0.000 description 2
- SIKJAQJRHWYJAI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Indole Chemical compound C1=CC=C2NC=CC2=C1 SIKJAQJRHWYJAI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 102100037877 Intercellular adhesion molecule 1 Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 102100037850 Interferon gamma Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108090000978 Interleukin-4 Proteins 0.000 description 2
- XEEYBQQBJWHFJM-UHFFFAOYSA-N Iron Chemical class [Fe] XEEYBQQBJWHFJM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000000998 L-alanino group Chemical group [H]N([*])[C@](C([H])([H])[H])([H])C(=O)O[H] 0.000 description 2
- CKLJMWTZIZZHCS-REOHCLBHSA-N L-aspartic acid Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CC(O)=O CKLJMWTZIZZHCS-REOHCLBHSA-N 0.000 description 2
- WHUUTDBJXJRKMK-VKHMYHEASA-N L-glutamic acid Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CCC(O)=O WHUUTDBJXJRKMK-VKHMYHEASA-N 0.000 description 2
- HNDVDQJCIGZPNO-YFKPBYRVSA-N L-histidine Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CC1=CN=CN1 HNDVDQJCIGZPNO-YFKPBYRVSA-N 0.000 description 2
- FBOZXECLQNJBKD-ZDUSSCGKSA-N L-methotrexate Chemical compound C=1N=C2N=C(N)N=C(N)C2=NC=1CN(C)C1=CC=C(C(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(O)=O)C(O)=O)C=C1 FBOZXECLQNJBKD-ZDUSSCGKSA-N 0.000 description 2
- GUBGYTABKSRVRQ-QKKXKWKRSA-N Lactose Natural products OC[C@H]1O[C@@H](O[C@H]2[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)C(O)O[C@@H]2CO)[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H]1O GUBGYTABKSRVRQ-QKKXKWKRSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 102000003960 Ligases Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108090000364 Ligases Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 102000008072 Lymphokines Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108010074338 Lymphokines Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 239000004472 Lysine Substances 0.000 description 2
- 108010047702 MPG peptide Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 229930195725 Mannitol Natural products 0.000 description 2
- 102000018697 Membrane Proteins Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108010052285 Membrane Proteins Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 201000003793 Myelodysplastic syndrome Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 208000033761 Myelogenous Chronic BCR-ABL Positive Leukemia Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 108091061960 Naked DNA Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 241000221960 Neurospora Species 0.000 description 2
- 101710163270 Nuclease Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 208000002151 Pleural effusion Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 239000004793 Polystyrene Substances 0.000 description 2
- ZLMJMSJWJFRBEC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Potassium Chemical compound [K] ZLMJMSJWJFRBEC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 208000006664 Precursor Cell Lymphoblastic Leukemia-Lymphoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 108010076504 Protein Sorting Signals Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 230000006819 RNA synthesis Effects 0.000 description 2
- 108010092799 RNA-directed DNA polymerase Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 241000220317 Rosa Species 0.000 description 2
- 241000714474 Rous sarcoma virus Species 0.000 description 2
- 108020004682 Single-Stranded DNA Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 238000002105 Southern blotting Methods 0.000 description 2
- 241000256251 Spodoptera frugiperda Species 0.000 description 2
- 241000191940 Staphylococcus Species 0.000 description 2
- 229920002472 Starch Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 241000193996 Streptococcus pyogenes Species 0.000 description 2
- 229930006000 Sucrose Natural products 0.000 description 2
- CZMRCDWAGMRECN-UGDNZRGBSA-N Sucrose Chemical compound O[C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@@]1(CO)O[C@@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O1 CZMRCDWAGMRECN-UGDNZRGBSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000037453 T cell priming Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000006052 T cell proliferation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 101710101607 Toxic shock syndrome toxin-1 Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 108091023040 Transcription factor Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 102000040945 Transcription factor Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 241000255985 Trichoplusia Species 0.000 description 2
- DRTQHJPVMGBUCF-XVFCMESISA-N Uridine Chemical compound O[C@@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@H]1N1C(=O)NC(=O)C=C1 DRTQHJPVMGBUCF-XVFCMESISA-N 0.000 description 2
- 206010046865 Vaccinia virus infection Diseases 0.000 description 2
- UZQJVUCHXGYFLQ-AYDHOLPZSA-N [(2s,3r,4s,5r,6r)-4-[(2s,3r,4s,5r,6r)-4-[(2r,3r,4s,5r,6r)-4-[(2s,3r,4s,5r,6r)-3,5-dihydroxy-6-(hydroxymethyl)-4-[(2s,3r,4s,5s,6r)-3,4,5-trihydroxy-6-(hydroxymethyl)oxan-2-yl]oxyoxan-2-yl]oxy-3,5-dihydroxy-6-(hydroxymethyl)oxan-2-yl]oxy-3,5-dihydroxy-6-(hy Chemical compound O([C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@H]([C@@H]1O)O[C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@H]([C@@H]1O)O[C@H]1CC[C@]2(C)[C@H]3CC=C4[C@@]([C@@]3(CC[C@H]2[C@@]1(C=O)C)C)(C)CC(O)[C@]1(CCC(CC14)(C)C)C(=O)O[C@H]1[C@@H]([C@@H](O[C@H]2[C@@H]([C@@H](O[C@H]3[C@@H]([C@@H](O[C@H]4[C@@H]([C@@H](O[C@H]5[C@@H]([C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O5)O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O4)O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O3)O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O2)O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O1)O)[C@@H]1O[C@H](CO)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H]1O UZQJVUCHXGYFLQ-AYDHOLPZSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000002159 abnormal effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000003070 absorption delaying agent Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000010521 absorption reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000021736 acetylation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000006640 acetylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000001154 acute effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000010933 acylation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000005917 acylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000009824 affinity maturation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000032683 aging Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000000735 allogeneic effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000004075 alteration Effects 0.000 description 2
- 125000003277 amino group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 210000004102 animal cell Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 238000000137 annealing Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000012736 aqueous medium Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000003190 augmentative effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 208000022362 bacterial infectious disease Diseases 0.000 description 2
- MSWZFWKMSRAUBD-UHFFFAOYSA-N beta-D-galactosamine Natural products NC1C(O)OC(CO)C(O)C1O MSWZFWKMSRAUBD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- IQFYYKKMVGJFEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N beta-L-thymidine Natural products O=C1NC(=O)C(C)=CN1C1OC(CO)C(O)C1 IQFYYKKMVGJFEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000003115 biocidal effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 229920001400 block copolymer Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 230000000903 blocking effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 210000000988 bone and bone Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 229940098773 bovine serum albumin Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 239000008366 buffered solution Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000002775 capsule Substances 0.000 description 2
- 150000001720 carbohydrates Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 230000003197 catalytic effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000006555 catalytic reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 150000001768 cations Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 230000022131 cell cycle Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000002659 cell therapy Methods 0.000 description 2
- 229920002678 cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000001913 cellulose Substances 0.000 description 2
- 210000001175 cerebrospinal fluid Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 238000007385 chemical modification Methods 0.000 description 2
- OSASVXMJTNOKOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N chlorobutanol Chemical compound CC(C)(O)C(Cl)(Cl)Cl OSASVXMJTNOKOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- HVYWMOMLDIMFJA-DPAQBDIFSA-N cholesterol Chemical compound C1C=C2C[C@@H](O)CC[C@]2(C)[C@@H]2[C@@H]1[C@@H]1CC[C@H]([C@H](C)CCCC(C)C)[C@@]1(C)CC2 HVYWMOMLDIMFJA-DPAQBDIFSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000004587 chromatography analysis Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000011248 coating agent Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000002860 competitive effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000007796 conventional method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000001351 cycling effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 210000001151 cytotoxic T lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- GVJHHUAWPYXKBD-UHFFFAOYSA-N d-alpha-tocopherol Natural products OC1=C(C)C(C)=C2OC(CCCC(C)CCCC(C)CCCC(C)C)(C)CCC2=C1C GVJHHUAWPYXKBD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000007423 decrease Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000003247 decreasing effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000000502 dialysis Methods 0.000 description 2
- 235000014113 dietary fatty acids Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- LOKCTEFSRHRXRJ-UHFFFAOYSA-I dipotassium trisodium dihydrogen phosphate hydrogen phosphate dichloride Chemical compound P(=O)(O)(O)[O-].[K+].P(=O)(O)([O-])[O-].[Na+].[Na+].[Cl-].[K+].[Cl-].[Na+] LOKCTEFSRHRXRJ-UHFFFAOYSA-I 0.000 description 2
- 208000035475 disorder Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 238000006073 displacement reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000004520 electroporation Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000005538 encapsulation Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000002346 endotoxic effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 108700004025 env Genes Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 229930195729 fatty acid Natural products 0.000 description 2
- 239000000194 fatty acid Substances 0.000 description 2
- 210000004700 fetal blood Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 238000001943 fluorescence-activated cell sorting Methods 0.000 description 2
- 125000000524 functional group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 238000001476 gene delivery Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000001415 gene therapy Methods 0.000 description 2
- 229960003180 glutathione Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 230000013595 glycosylation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000006206 glycosylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 150000004820 halides Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 238000004128 high performance liquid chromatography Methods 0.000 description 2
- HNDVDQJCIGZPNO-UHFFFAOYSA-N histidine Natural products OC(=O)C(N)CC1=CN=CN1 HNDVDQJCIGZPNO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000000487 histidyl group Chemical group [H]N([H])C(C(=O)O*)C([H])([H])C1=C([H])N([H])C([H])=N1 0.000 description 2
- 238000002744 homologous recombination Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000006801 homologous recombination Effects 0.000 description 2
- 210000005260 human cell Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- FDGQSTZJBFJUBT-UHFFFAOYSA-N hypoxanthine Chemical compound O=C1NC=NC2=C1NC=N2 FDGQSTZJBFJUBT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000011065 in-situ storage Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000010348 incorporation Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000000411 inducer Substances 0.000 description 2
- 150000007529 inorganic bases Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 230000003993 interaction Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000011901 isothermal amplification Methods 0.000 description 2
- 108010045069 keyhole-limpet hemocyanin Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 210000003292 kidney cell Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 230000002147 killing effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000004816 latex Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229920000126 latex Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 230000000670 limiting effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 210000004185 liver Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 238000011068 loading method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 210000004698 lymphocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- HQKMJHAJHXVSDF-UHFFFAOYSA-L magnesium stearate Chemical compound [Mg+2].CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC([O-])=O.CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC([O-])=O HQKMJHAJHXVSDF-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 2
- 239000006249 magnetic particle Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000014759 maintenance of location Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000000594 mannitol Substances 0.000 description 2
- 235000010355 mannitol Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 230000035800 maturation Effects 0.000 description 2
- MIKKOBKEXMRYFQ-WZTVWXICSA-N meglumine amidotrizoate Chemical compound C[NH2+]C[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H](O)CO.CC(=O)NC1=C(I)C(NC(C)=O)=C(I)C(C([O-])=O)=C1I MIKKOBKEXMRYFQ-WZTVWXICSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000002844 melting Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000008018 melting Effects 0.000 description 2
- 125000001360 methionine group Chemical group N[C@@H](CCSC)C(=O)* 0.000 description 2
- 229960000485 methotrexate Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 238000000520 microinjection Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000011859 microparticle Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000003595 mist Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000010369 molecular cloning Methods 0.000 description 2
- 210000003205 muscle Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 239000002077 nanosphere Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000007764 o/w emulsion Substances 0.000 description 2
- 150000007530 organic bases Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 230000002018 overexpression Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000007911 parenteral administration Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000035515 penetration Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000002823 phage display Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000002953 phosphate buffered saline Substances 0.000 description 2
- 125000002467 phosphate group Chemical group [H]OP(=O)(O[H])O[*] 0.000 description 2
- 239000013600 plasmid vector Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229920003023 plastic Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000004033 plastic Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000007747 plating Methods 0.000 description 2
- 108700004029 pol Genes Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 229920000642 polymer Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 238000006116 polymerization reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 229920002223 polystyrene Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 230000001323 posttranslational effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000011591 potassium Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910052700 potassium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 230000002335 preservative effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000002062 proliferating effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000002035 prolonged effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000017854 proteolysis Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000002510 pyrogen Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000001397 quillaja saponaria molina bark Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000005215 recombination Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000008439 repair process Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000003362 replicative effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 229910052702 rhenium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 229930182490 saponin Natural products 0.000 description 2
- 150000007949 saponins Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 239000006152 selective media Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000035945 sensitivity Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000012163 sequencing technique Methods 0.000 description 2
- QZAYGJVTTNCVMB-UHFFFAOYSA-N serotonin Chemical compound C1=C(O)C=C2C(CCN)=CNC2=C1 QZAYGJVTTNCVMB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 210000003491 skin Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 239000011734 sodium Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910052708 sodium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 238000010532 solid phase synthesis reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000000527 sonication Methods 0.000 description 2
- 210000000952 spleen Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 239000007921 spray Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000000087 stabilizing effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000010473 stable expression Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000008107 starch Substances 0.000 description 2
- 235000019698 starch Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 238000003860 storage Methods 0.000 description 2
- 125000001424 substituent group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 239000005720 sucrose Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000006228 supernatant Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000002459 sustained effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 208000024891 symptom Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 229940104230 thymidine Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 239000011732 tocopherol Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229960001295 tocopherol Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 235000010384 tocopherol Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 229930003799 tocopherol Natural products 0.000 description 2
- 230000001988 toxicity Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000007704 transition Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000014621 translational initiation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000011269 treatment regimen Methods 0.000 description 2
- GETQZCLCWQTVFV-UHFFFAOYSA-N trimethylamine Chemical compound CN(C)C GETQZCLCWQTVFV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000001226 triphosphate Substances 0.000 description 2
- 235000011178 triphosphate Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 125000002264 triphosphate group Chemical class [H]OP(=O)(O[H])OP(=O)(O[H])OP(=O)(O[H])O* 0.000 description 2
- 241001515965 unidentified phage Species 0.000 description 2
- 238000002255 vaccination Methods 0.000 description 2
- 208000007089 vaccinia Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 230000006648 viral gene expression Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000029812 viral genome replication Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000009385 viral infection Effects 0.000 description 2
- GVJHHUAWPYXKBD-IEOSBIPESA-N α-tocopherol Chemical compound OC1=C(C)C(C)=C2O[C@@](CCC[C@H](C)CCC[C@H](C)CCCC(C)C)(C)CCC2=C1C GVJHHUAWPYXKBD-IEOSBIPESA-N 0.000 description 2
- DGVVWUTYPXICAM-UHFFFAOYSA-N β‐Mercaptoethanol Chemical compound OCCS DGVVWUTYPXICAM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- OCUSNPIJIZCRSZ-ZTZWCFDHSA-N (2s)-2-amino-3-methylbutanoic acid;(2s)-2-amino-4-methylpentanoic acid;(2s,3s)-2-amino-3-methylpentanoic acid Chemical compound CC(C)[C@H](N)C(O)=O.CC[C@H](C)[C@H](N)C(O)=O.CC(C)C[C@H](N)C(O)=O OCUSNPIJIZCRSZ-ZTZWCFDHSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MZOFCQQQCNRIBI-VMXHOPILSA-N (3s)-4-[[(2s)-1-[[(2s)-1-[[(1s)-1-carboxy-2-hydroxyethyl]amino]-4-methyl-1-oxopentan-2-yl]amino]-5-(diaminomethylideneamino)-1-oxopentan-2-yl]amino]-3-[[2-[[(2s)-2,6-diaminohexanoyl]amino]acetyl]amino]-4-oxobutanoic acid Chemical compound OC[C@@H](C(O)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(C)C)NC(=O)[C@H](CCCN=C(N)N)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(O)=O)NC(=O)CNC(=O)[C@@H](N)CCCCN MZOFCQQQCNRIBI-VMXHOPILSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UGXDVELKRYZPDM-XLXQKPBQSA-N (4r)-4-[[(2s,3r)-2-[[(2r)-2-[(2r,3r,4r,5r)-2-acetamido-4,5,6-trihydroxy-1-oxohexan-3-yl]oxypropanoyl]amino]-3-hydroxybutanoyl]amino]-5-amino-5-oxopentanoic acid Chemical compound OC(=O)CC[C@H](C(N)=O)NC(=O)[C@H]([C@H](O)C)NC(=O)[C@@H](C)O[C@@H]([C@H](O)[C@H](O)CO)[C@@H](NC(C)=O)C=O UGXDVELKRYZPDM-XLXQKPBQSA-N 0.000 description 1
- NWUYHJFMYQTDRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2-bis(ethenyl)benzene;1-ethenyl-2-ethylbenzene;styrene Chemical compound C=CC1=CC=CC=C1.CCC1=CC=CC=C1C=C.C=CC1=CC=CC=C1C=C NWUYHJFMYQTDRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IIZPXYDJLKNOIY-JXPKJXOSSA-N 1-palmitoyl-2-arachidonoyl-sn-glycero-3-phosphocholine Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC(=O)OC[C@H](COP([O-])(=O)OCC[N+](C)(C)C)OC(=O)CCC\C=C/C\C=C/C\C=C/C\C=C/CCCCC IIZPXYDJLKNOIY-JXPKJXOSSA-N 0.000 description 1
- PIINGYXNCHTJTF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-(2-azaniumylethylamino)acetate Chemical compound NCCNCC(O)=O PIINGYXNCHTJTF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MSWZFWKMSRAUBD-GASJEMHNSA-N 2-amino-2-deoxy-D-galactopyranose Chemical compound N[C@H]1C(O)O[C@H](CO)[C@H](O)[C@@H]1O MSWZFWKMSRAUBD-GASJEMHNSA-N 0.000 description 1
- VOBNSQKMDIOJTQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-aminoethyl phosphono hydrogen phosphate Chemical group NCCOP(O)(=O)OP(O)(O)=O VOBNSQKMDIOJTQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FTZIQBGFCYJWKA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(4,5-dimethylthiazol-2-yl)-2,5-diphenyltetrazolium Chemical compound S1C(C)=C(C)N=C1[N+]1=NC(C=2C=CC=CC=2)=NN1C1=CC=CC=C1 FTZIQBGFCYJWKA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000004080 3-carboxypropanoyl group Chemical group O=C([*])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C(O[H])=O 0.000 description 1
- KYQCXUMVJGMDNG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4,5,6,7,8-pentahydroxy-2-oxooctanoic acid Chemical group OCC(O)C(O)C(O)C(O)CC(=O)C(O)=O KYQCXUMVJGMDNG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- TVZGACDUOSZQKY-LBPRGKRZSA-N 4-aminofolic acid Chemical compound C1=NC2=NC(N)=NC(N)=C2N=C1CNC1=CC=C(C(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(O)=O)C(O)=O)C=C1 TVZGACDUOSZQKY-LBPRGKRZSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 208000030507 AIDS Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108010066676 Abrin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010042708 Acetylmuramyl-Alanyl-Isoglutamine Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 208000031261 Acute myeloid leukaemia Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229930024421 Adenine Natural products 0.000 description 1
- GFFGJBXGBJISGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Adenine Chemical compound NC1=NC=NC2=C1N=CN2 GFFGJBXGBJISGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229920000936 Agarose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 102000009027 Albumins Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010088751 Albumins Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010025188 Alcohol oxidase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000002260 Alkaline Phosphatase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108020004774 Alkaline Phosphatase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- GUBGYTABKSRVRQ-XLOQQCSPSA-N Alpha-Lactose Chemical compound O[C@@H]1[C@@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@H]1O[C@@H]1[C@@H](CO)O[C@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H]1O GUBGYTABKSRVRQ-XLOQQCSPSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000024188 Andala Species 0.000 description 1
- 102000006306 Antigen Receptors Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010083359 Antigen Receptors Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000272478 Aquila Species 0.000 description 1
- 239000004475 Arginine Substances 0.000 description 1
- 241000238421 Arthropoda Species 0.000 description 1
- DCXYFEDJOCDNAF-UHFFFAOYSA-N Asparagine Natural products OC(=O)C(N)CC(N)=O DCXYFEDJOCDNAF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 102100032306 Aurora kinase B Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108090000749 Aurora kinase B Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000271566 Aves Species 0.000 description 1
- 108090001008 Avidin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 230000003844 B-cell-activation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 102100026189 Beta-galactosidase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 206010005003 Bladder cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000018240 Bone Marrow Failure disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010065553 Bone marrow failure Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000283690 Bos taurus Species 0.000 description 1
- 206010006187 Breast cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000026310 Breast neoplasm Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108010029697 CD40 Ligand Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101150013553 CD40 gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100032937 CD40 ligand Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 235000007627 Caesalpinia Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 241000522234 Caesalpinia Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000222120 Candida <Saccharomycetales> Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000282465 Canis Species 0.000 description 1
- 102000014914 Carrier Proteins Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010078791 Carrier Proteins Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000701489 Cauliflower mosaic virus Species 0.000 description 1
- 102000000844 Cell Surface Receptors Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010001857 Cell Surface Receptors Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000282693 Cercopithecidae Species 0.000 description 1
- 229920001661 Chitosan Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000005496 Chlorsulfuron Substances 0.000 description 1
- 102000009016 Cholera Toxin Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010049048 Cholera Toxin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010009685 Cholinergic Receptors Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000588879 Chromobacterium violaceum Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000193468 Clostridium perfringens Species 0.000 description 1
- 101710094648 Coat protein Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010009944 Colon cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000001333 Colorectal Neoplasms Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108020004394 Complementary RNA Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000557626 Corvus corax Species 0.000 description 1
- 108091029430 CpG site Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108050006400 Cyclin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229920000858 Cyclodextrin Polymers 0.000 description 1
- IGXWBGJHJZYPQS-SSDOTTSWSA-N D-Luciferin Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@H]1CSC(C=2SC3=CC=C(O)C=C3N=2)=N1 IGXWBGJHJZYPQS-SSDOTTSWSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000008574 D-amino acids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- YVGGHNCTFXOJCH-UHFFFAOYSA-N DDT Chemical compound C1=CC(Cl)=CC=C1C(C(Cl)(Cl)Cl)C1=CC=C(Cl)C=C1 YVGGHNCTFXOJCH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 101150074155 DHFR gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010076804 DNA Restriction Enzymes Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101710177611 DNA polymerase II large subunit Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101710184669 DNA polymerase II small subunit Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 230000006820 DNA synthesis Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000007900 DNA-DNA hybridization Methods 0.000 description 1
- CYCGRDQQIOGCKX-UHFFFAOYSA-N Dehydro-luciferin Natural products OC(=O)C1=CSC(C=2SC3=CC(O)=CC=C3N=2)=N1 CYCGRDQQIOGCKX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000009007 Diagnostic Kit Methods 0.000 description 1
- 206010061818 Disease progression Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000725618 Duck hepatitis B virus Species 0.000 description 1
- 108010024212 E-Selectin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100023471 E-selectin Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102100038132 Endogenous retrovirus group K member 6 Pro protein Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102100031780 Endonuclease Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102000004533 Endonucleases Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 101710146739 Enterotoxin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101710091045 Envelope protein Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000283073 Equus caballus Species 0.000 description 1
- 101000867232 Escherichia coli Heat-stable enterotoxin II Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000282324 Felis Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000724791 Filamentous phage Species 0.000 description 1
- BJGNCJDXODQBOB-UHFFFAOYSA-N Fivefly Luciferin Natural products OC(=O)C1CSC(C=2SC3=CC(O)=CC=C3N=2)=N1 BJGNCJDXODQBOB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- BDAGIHXWWSANSR-UHFFFAOYSA-M Formate Chemical compound [O-]C=O BDAGIHXWWSANSR-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- 208000000666 Fowlpox Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000233866 Fungi Species 0.000 description 1
- 108010010803 Gelatin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108700004714 Gelonium multiflorum GEL Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108700028146 Genetic Enhancer Elements Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 239000004366 Glucose oxidase Substances 0.000 description 1
- 108010015776 Glucose oxidase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000053187 Glucuronidase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010060309 Glucuronidase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229930186217 Glycolipid Natural products 0.000 description 1
- 102100021181 Golgi phosphoprotein 3 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 241000590002 Helicobacter pylori Species 0.000 description 1
- 101710154606 Hemagglutinin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100031573 Hematopoietic progenitor cell antigen CD34 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- HTTJABKRGRZYRN-UHFFFAOYSA-N Heparin Chemical compound OC1C(NC(=O)C)C(O)OC(COS(O)(=O)=O)C1OC1C(OS(O)(=O)=O)C(O)C(OC2C(C(OS(O)(=O)=O)C(OC3C(C(O)C(O)C(O3)C(O)=O)OS(O)(=O)=O)C(CO)O2)NS(O)(=O)=O)C(C(O)=O)O1 HTTJABKRGRZYRN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000700721 Hepatitis B virus Species 0.000 description 1
- 241001441571 Hiodontidae Species 0.000 description 1
- 108010027412 Histocompatibility Antigens Class II Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000018713 Histocompatibility Antigens Class II Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 101000777663 Homo sapiens Hematopoietic progenitor cell antigen CD34 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101000599852 Homo sapiens Intercellular adhesion molecule 1 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101000582320 Homo sapiens Neurogenic differentiation factor 6 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101000851176 Homo sapiens Pro-epidermal growth factor Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101000914484 Homo sapiens T-lymphocyte activation antigen CD80 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010001336 Horseradish Peroxidase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000713772 Human immunodeficiency virus 1 Species 0.000 description 1
- AVXURJPOCDRRFD-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hydroxylamine Chemical compound ON AVXURJPOCDRRFD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229920002153 Hydroxypropyl cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- UGQMRVRMYYASKQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hypoxanthine nucleoside Natural products OC1C(O)C(CO)OC1N1C(NC=NC2=O)=C2N=C1 UGQMRVRMYYASKQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 108010073807 IgG Receptors Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000009490 IgG Receptors Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102000017727 Immunoglobulin Variable Region Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010067060 Immunoglobulin Variable Region Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010062016 Immunosuppression Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108020005350 Initiator Codon Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100034349 Integrase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010064593 Intercellular Adhesion Molecule-1 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000008070 Interferon-gamma Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102000000589 Interleukin-1 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010002352 Interleukin-1 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010065805 Interleukin-12 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000013462 Interleukin-12 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010002386 Interleukin-3 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000000646 Interleukin-3 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010002616 Interleukin-5 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108090001005 Interleukin-6 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010002586 Interleukin-7 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000000704 Interleukin-7 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- QNAYBMKLOCPYGJ-REOHCLBHSA-N L-alanine Chemical compound C[C@H](N)C(O)=O QNAYBMKLOCPYGJ-REOHCLBHSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000008575 L-amino acids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- ZDXPYRJPNDTMRX-VKHMYHEASA-N L-glutamine Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CCC(N)=O ZDXPYRJPNDTMRX-VKHMYHEASA-N 0.000 description 1
- AGPKZVBTJJNPAG-WHFBIAKZSA-N L-isoleucine Chemical compound CC[C@H](C)[C@H](N)C(O)=O AGPKZVBTJJNPAG-WHFBIAKZSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ROHFNLRQFUQHCH-YFKPBYRVSA-N L-leucine Chemical compound CC(C)C[C@H](N)C(O)=O ROHFNLRQFUQHCH-YFKPBYRVSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000000174 L-prolyl group Chemical group [H]N1C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])[C@@]1([H])C(*)=O 0.000 description 1
- 125000000773 L-serino group Chemical group [H]OC(=O)[C@@]([H])(N([H])*)C([H])([H])O[H] 0.000 description 1
- QIVBCDIJIAJPQS-VIFPVBQESA-N L-tryptophane Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C(C[C@H](N)C(O)=O)=CNC2=C1 QIVBCDIJIAJPQS-VIFPVBQESA-N 0.000 description 1
- 108090001090 Lectins Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000004856 Lectins Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 241000713666 Lentivirus Species 0.000 description 1
- 108090001030 Lipoproteins Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000004895 Lipoproteins Human genes 0.000 description 1
- WHXSMMKQMYFTQS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Lithium Chemical compound [Li] WHXSMMKQMYFTQS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 108060001084 Luciferase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 239000005089 Luciferase Substances 0.000 description 1
- DDWFXDSYGUXRAY-UHFFFAOYSA-N Luciferin Natural products CCc1c(C)c(CC2NC(=O)C(=C2C=C)C)[nH]c1Cc3[nH]c4C(=C5/NC(CC(=O)O)C(C)C5CC(=O)O)CC(=O)c4c3C DDWFXDSYGUXRAY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 206010058467 Lung neoplasm malignant Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000219745 Lupinus Species 0.000 description 1
- 102000043129 MHC class I family Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108091054437 MHC class I family Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101710125418 Major capsid protein Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010031099 Mannose Receptor Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010027476 Metastases Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 101100261636 Methanothermobacter marburgensis (strain ATCC BAA-927 / DSM 2133 / JCM 14651 / NBRC 100331 / OCM 82 / Marburg) trpB2 gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010048723 Multiple-drug resistance Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000204795 Muraena helena Species 0.000 description 1
- 102000016943 Muramidase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010014251 Muramidase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241001529936 Murinae Species 0.000 description 1
- UQOFGTXDASPNLL-XHNCKOQMSA-N Muscarine Chemical compound C[C@@H]1O[C@H](C[N+](C)(C)C)C[C@H]1O UQOFGTXDASPNLL-XHNCKOQMSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000187479 Mycobacterium tuberculosis Species 0.000 description 1
- 208000033776 Myeloid Acute Leukemia Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108010062010 N-Acetylmuramoyl-L-alanine Amidase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 125000001429 N-terminal alpha-amino-acid group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 206010028735 Nasal congestion Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229930193140 Neomycin Natural products 0.000 description 1
- 102100030589 Neurogenic differentiation factor 6 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 241001028048 Nicola Species 0.000 description 1
- 239000000020 Nitrocellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000000636 Northern blotting Methods 0.000 description 1
- 108020004711 Nucleic Acid Probes Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108700001237 Nucleic Acid-Based Vaccines Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108091005461 Nucleic proteins Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101710141454 Nucleoprotein Proteins 0.000 description 1
- XDMCWZFLLGVIID-SXPRBRBTSA-N O-(3-O-D-galactosyl-N-acetyl-beta-D-galactosaminyl)-L-serine Chemical compound CC(=O)N[C@H]1[C@H](OC[C@H]([NH3+])C([O-])=O)O[C@H](CO)[C@H](O)[C@@H]1OC1[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O1 XDMCWZFLLGVIID-SXPRBRBTSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 240000007817 Olea europaea Species 0.000 description 1
- 108700020796 Oncogene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000043276 Oncogene Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 206010053159 Organ failure Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 101710093908 Outer capsid protein VP4 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101710135467 Outer capsid protein sigma-1 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 238000012408 PCR amplification Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229910019142 PO4 Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 241000237988 Patellidae Species 0.000 description 1
- 108091005804 Peptidases Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000007079 Peptide Fragments Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010033276 Peptide Fragments Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010067902 Peptide Library Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 201000005702 Pertussis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010057249 Phagocytosis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 101100124346 Photorhabdus laumondii subsp. laumondii (strain DSM 15139 / CIP 105565 / TT01) hisCD gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 208000000474 Poliomyelitis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000276498 Pollachius virens Species 0.000 description 1
- 239000002202 Polyethylene glycol Substances 0.000 description 1
- 241001505332 Polyomavirus sp. Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000243142 Porifera Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000288906 Primates Species 0.000 description 1
- 101710083689 Probable capsid protein Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010060862 Prostate cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000000236 Prostatic Neoplasms Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 101710176177 Protein A56 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010029485 Protein Isoforms Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000001708 Protein Isoforms Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102000003923 Protein Kinase C Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108090000315 Protein Kinase C Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101710188315 Protein X Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000589517 Pseudomonas aeruginosa Species 0.000 description 1
- 101000762949 Pseudomonas aeruginosa (strain ATCC 15692 / DSM 22644 / CIP 104116 / JCM 14847 / LMG 12228 / 1C / PRS 101 / PAO1) Exotoxin A Proteins 0.000 description 1
- CZPWVGJYEJSRLH-UHFFFAOYSA-N Pyrimidine Chemical compound C1=CN=CN=C1 CZPWVGJYEJSRLH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 108010066717 Q beta Replicase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000017143 RNA Polymerase I Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010013845 RNA Polymerase I Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000009572 RNA Polymerase II Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010009460 RNA Polymerase II Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108020004518 RNA Probes Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 239000003391 RNA probe Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000007022 RNA scission Effects 0.000 description 1
- 241001068263 Replication competent viruses Species 0.000 description 1
- 102000004389 Ribonucleoproteins Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010081734 Ribonucleoproteins Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010003581 Ribulose-bisphosphate carboxylase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010039491 Ricin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241001222774 Salmonella enterica subsp. enterica serovar Minnesota Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000710961 Semliki Forest virus Species 0.000 description 1
- 108091081021 Sense strand Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229920002684 Sepharose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- MTCFGRXMJLQNBG-UHFFFAOYSA-N Serine Natural products OCC(N)C(O)=O MTCFGRXMJLQNBG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 108010079723 Shiga Toxin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010032838 Sialoglycoproteins Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000007365 Sialoglycoproteins Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 241000700584 Simplexvirus Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000710960 Sindbis virus Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000191963 Staphylococcus epidermidis Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000529895 Stercorarius Species 0.000 description 1
- 108010090804 Streptavidin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000193998 Streptococcus pneumoniae Species 0.000 description 1
- 101710172711 Structural protein Proteins 0.000 description 1
- OUUQCZGPVNCOIJ-UHFFFAOYSA-M Superoxide Chemical compound [O-][O] OUUQCZGPVNCOIJ-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- 102100027222 T-lymphocyte activation antigen CD80 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 101710137500 T7 RNA polymerase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241001365914 Taira Species 0.000 description 1
- 108010006785 Taq Polymerase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010017842 Telomerase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010043376 Tetanus Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 101710097834 Thiol protease Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100036407 Thioredoxin Human genes 0.000 description 1
- AYFVYJQAPQTCCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Threonine Natural products CC(O)C(N)C(O)=O AYFVYJQAPQTCCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000004473 Threonine Substances 0.000 description 1
- 108090000190 Thrombin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100034196 Thrombopoietin receptor Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 102000006601 Thymidine Kinase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108020004440 Thymidine kinase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101710120037 Toxin CcdB Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000223997 Toxoplasma gondii Species 0.000 description 1
- 101800001690 Transmembrane protein gp41 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- GLNADSQYFUSGOU-GPTZEZBUSA-J Trypan blue Chemical compound [Na+].[Na+].[Na+].[Na+].C1=C(S([O-])(=O)=O)C=C2C=C(S([O-])(=O)=O)C(/N=N/C3=CC=C(C=C3C)C=3C=C(C(=CC=3)\N=N\C=3C(=CC4=CC(=CC(N)=C4C=3O)S([O-])(=O)=O)S([O-])(=O)=O)C)=C(O)C2=C1N GLNADSQYFUSGOU-GPTZEZBUSA-J 0.000 description 1
- QIVBCDIJIAJPQS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Tryptophan Natural products C1=CC=C2C(CC(N)C(O)=O)=CNC2=C1 QIVBCDIJIAJPQS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 102100040245 Tumor necrosis factor receptor superfamily member 5 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 208000007097 Urinary Bladder Neoplasms Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000700618 Vaccinia virus Species 0.000 description 1
- KZSNJWFQEVHDMF-UHFFFAOYSA-N Valine Chemical compound CC(C)C(N)C(O)=O KZSNJWFQEVHDMF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000251539 Vertebrata <Metazoa> Species 0.000 description 1
- 108010003533 Viral Envelope Proteins Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108700005077 Viral Genes Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010067390 Viral Proteins Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108020000999 Viral RNA Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 208000036142 Viral infection Diseases 0.000 description 1
- IXKSXJFAGXLQOQ-XISFHERQSA-N WHWLQLKPGQPMY Chemical compound C([C@@H](C(=O)N[C@@H](CC=1C2=CC=CC=C2NC=1)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(C)C)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(N)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(C)C)C(=O)N1CCC[C@H]1C(=O)NCC(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(N)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(O)=O)C(=O)N1CCC[C@H]1C(=O)N[C@@H](CCSC)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC=1C=CC(O)=CC=1)C(O)=O)NC(=O)[C@@H](N)CC=1C2=CC=CC=C2NC=1)C1=CNC=N1 IXKSXJFAGXLQOQ-XISFHERQSA-N 0.000 description 1
- HCHKCACWOHOZIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N Zinc Chemical class [Zn] HCHKCACWOHOZIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ATBOMIWRCZXYSZ-XZBBILGWSA-N [1-[2,3-dihydroxypropoxy(hydroxy)phosphoryl]oxy-3-hexadecanoyloxypropan-2-yl] (9e,12e)-octadeca-9,12-dienoate Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC(=O)OCC(COP(O)(=O)OCC(O)CO)OC(=O)CCCCCCC\C=C\C\C=C\CCCCC ATBOMIWRCZXYSZ-XZBBILGWSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FHICGHSMIPIAPL-HDYAAECPSA-N [2-[3-[6-[3-[(5R,6aS,6bR,12aR)-10-[6-[2-[2-[4,5-dihydroxy-3-(3,4,5-trihydroxyoxan-2-yl)oxyoxan-2-yl]ethoxy]ethyl]-3,4,5-trihydroxyoxan-2-yl]oxy-5-hydroxy-2,2,6a,6b,9,9,12a-heptamethyl-1,3,4,5,6,6a,7,8,8a,10,11,12,13,14b-tetradecahydropicene-4a-carbonyl]peroxypropyl]-5-[[5-[8-[3,5-dihydroxy-4-(3,4,5-trihydroxyoxan-2-yl)oxyoxan-2-yl]octoxy]-3,4-dihydroxy-6-methyloxan-2-yl]methoxy]-3,4-dihydroxyoxan-2-yl]propoxymethyl]-5-hydroxy-3-[(6S)-6-hydroxy-2,6-dimethylocta-2,7-dienoyl]oxy-6-methyloxan-4-yl] (2E,6S)-6-hydroxy-2-(hydroxymethyl)-6-methylocta-2,7-dienoate Chemical compound C=C[C@@](C)(O)CCC=C(C)C(=O)OC1C(OC(=O)C(\CO)=C\CC[C@](C)(O)C=C)C(O)C(C)OC1COCCCC1C(O)C(O)C(OCC2C(C(O)C(OCCCCCCCCC3C(C(OC4C(C(O)C(O)CO4)O)C(O)CO3)O)C(C)O2)O)C(CCCOOC(=O)C23C(CC(C)(C)CC2)C=2[C@@]([C@]4(C)CCC5C(C)(C)C(OC6C(C(O)C(O)C(CCOCCC7C(C(O)C(O)CO7)OC7C(C(O)C(O)CO7)O)O6)O)CC[C@]5(C)C4CC=2)(C)C[C@H]3O)O1 FHICGHSMIPIAPL-HDYAAECPSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000009825 accumulation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000002777 acetyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C(*)=O 0.000 description 1
- 102000034337 acetylcholine receptors Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108020002494 acetyltransferase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000005421 acetyltransferase Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 238000005903 acid hydrolysis reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000003213 activating effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000011149 active material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000011374 additional therapy Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229960000643 adenine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 238000001261 affinity purification Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000007818 agglutination assay Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002776 aggregation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000004220 aggregation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000013019 agitation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229960003767 alanine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000004279 alanine Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 238000012867 alanine scanning Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000000217 alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 230000029936 alkylation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000005804 alkylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000172 allergic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000012637 allosteric effector Substances 0.000 description 1
- AWUCVROLDVIAJX-UHFFFAOYSA-N alpha-glycerophosphate Natural products OCC(O)COP(O)(O)=O AWUCVROLDVIAJX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940037003 alum Drugs 0.000 description 1
- AZDRQVAHHNSJOQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N alumane Chemical class [AlH3] AZDRQVAHHNSJOQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ILRRQNADMUWWFW-UHFFFAOYSA-K aluminium phosphate Chemical compound O1[Al]2OP1(=O)O2 ILRRQNADMUWWFW-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 1
- 238000005576 amination reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 150000001412 amines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000003862 amino acid derivatives Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229940126575 aminoglycoside Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229960003896 aminopterin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 150000008064 anhydrides Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 235000010208 anthocyanin Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229930002877 anthocyanin Natural products 0.000 description 1
- 239000004410 anthocyanin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000004636 anthocyanins Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 230000000340 anti-metabolite Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000845 anti-microbial effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000259 anti-tumor effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005809 anti-tumor immunity Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000840 anti-viral effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000011319 anticancer therapy Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000002518 antifoaming agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000030741 antigen processing and presentation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229940100197 antimetabolite Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000002256 antimetabolite Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000003963 antioxidant agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000006708 antioxidants Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000008135 aqueous vehicle Substances 0.000 description 1
- ODKSFYDXXFIFQN-UHFFFAOYSA-N arginine Natural products OC(=O)C(N)CCCNC(N)=N ODKSFYDXXFIFQN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960001230 asparagine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000009582 asparagine Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 235000003704 aspartic acid Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229910052789 astatine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 125000004429 atom Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 208000010668 atopic eczema Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000003416 augmentation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000006472 autoimmune response Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005812 autoimmune toxicity Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000037429 base substitution Effects 0.000 description 1
- 108010005774 beta-Galactosidase Proteins 0.000 description 1
- DRTQHJPVMGBUCF-PSQAKQOGSA-N beta-L-uridine Natural products O[C@H]1[C@@H](O)[C@H](CO)O[C@@H]1N1C(=O)NC(=O)C=C1 DRTQHJPVMGBUCF-PSQAKQOGSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OQFSQFPPLPISGP-UHFFFAOYSA-N beta-carboxyaspartic acid Natural products OC(=O)C(N)C(C(O)=O)C(O)=O OQFSQFPPLPISGP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000001588 bifunctional effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000227 bioadhesive Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000004166 bioassay Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000013060 biological fluid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229960000074 biopharmaceutical Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229920001222 biopolymer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229910052797 bismuth Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000002981 blocking agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 210000000601 blood cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 210000002798 bone marrow cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 238000010322 bone marrow transplantation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 210000004556 brain Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 210000000481 breast Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 210000003123 bronchiole Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000007975 buffered saline Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000010804 cDNA synthesis Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000003185 calcium uptake Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005773 cancer-related death Effects 0.000 description 1
- 235000014633 carbohydrates Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 125000002915 carbonyl group Chemical group [*:2]C([*:1])=O 0.000 description 1
- 230000021523 carboxylation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000006473 carboxylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000002843 carboxylic acid group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 231100000504 carcinogenesis Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 101150055766 cat gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108020001778 catalytic domains Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 125000002091 cationic group Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 238000004113 cell culture Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000012832 cell culture technique Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000007910 cell fusion Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000010261 cell growth Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000004663 cell proliferation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000001516 cell proliferation assay Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000006285 cell suspension Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000003833 cell viability Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000007541 cellular toxicity Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000013522 chelant Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000002738 chelating agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000009920 chelation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000012412 chemical coupling Methods 0.000 description 1
- 201000002687 childhood acute myeloid leukemia Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229960005091 chloramphenicol Drugs 0.000 description 1
- WIIZWVCIJKGZOK-RKDXNWHRSA-N chloramphenicol Chemical compound ClC(Cl)C(=O)N[C@H](CO)[C@H](O)C1=CC=C([N+]([O-])=O)C=C1 WIIZWVCIJKGZOK-RKDXNWHRSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960004926 chlorobutanol Drugs 0.000 description 1
- VJYIFXVZLXQVHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N chlorsulfuron Chemical compound COC1=NC(C)=NC(NC(=O)NS(=O)(=O)C=2C(=CC=CC=2)Cl)=N1 VJYIFXVZLXQVHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 235000012000 cholesterol Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000013611 chromosomal DNA Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000001886 ciliary effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000004087 circulation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000009668 clonal growth Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000084 colloidal system Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000012875 competitive assay Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003184 complementary RNA Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000009918 complex formation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000004590 computer program Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012141 concentrate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 108091036078 conserved sequence Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 239000000356 contaminant Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000011109 contamination Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000139 costimulatory effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000007822 coupling agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000006071 cream Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000004132 cross linking Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003431 cross linking reagent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000013078 crystal Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000012228 culture supernatant Substances 0.000 description 1
- 210000004748 cultured cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 238000012258 culturing Methods 0.000 description 1
- WZHCOOQXZCIUNC-UHFFFAOYSA-N cyclandelate Chemical compound C1C(C)(C)CC(C)CC1OC(=O)C(O)C1=CC=CC=C1 WZHCOOQXZCIUNC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940097362 cyclodextrins Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 150000001945 cysteines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 230000001086 cytosolic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229940127089 cytotoxic agent Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000003145 cytotoxic factor Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000003013 cytotoxicity Effects 0.000 description 1
- 231100000135 cytotoxicity Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 230000007547 defect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000003111 delayed effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000002716 delivery method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 210000001787 dendrite Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 238000009795 derivation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000013461 design Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003599 detergent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000032 diagnostic agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940039227 diagnostic agent Drugs 0.000 description 1
- UGMCXQCYOVCMTB-UHFFFAOYSA-K dihydroxy(stearato)aluminium Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC(=O)O[Al](O)O UGMCXQCYOVCMTB-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 1
- 238000010790 dilution Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012895 dilution Substances 0.000 description 1
- 108700042119 disaccharide tripeptide Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 230000005750 disease progression Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000010494 dissociation reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000005593 dissociations Effects 0.000 description 1
- VHJLVAABSRFDPM-QWWZWVQMSA-N dithiothreitol Chemical compound SC[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)CS VHJLVAABSRFDPM-QWWZWVQMSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000002552 dosage form Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000012377 drug delivery Methods 0.000 description 1
- 241001493065 dsRNA viruses Species 0.000 description 1
- 239000012636 effector Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000010828 elution Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000000839 emulsion Substances 0.000 description 1
- 231100000284 endotoxic Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 210000003743 erythrocyte Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 125000004185 ester group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- BEFDCLMNVWHSGT-UHFFFAOYSA-N ethenylcyclopentane Chemical compound C=CC1CCCC1 BEFDCLMNVWHSGT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000001747 exhibiting effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000001808 exosome Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 231100000776 exotoxin Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 239000002095 exotoxin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000010195 expression analysis Methods 0.000 description 1
- 235000013861 fat-free Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000000835 fiber Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000011152 fibreglass Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000945 filler Substances 0.000 description 1
- 108700014844 flt3 ligand Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 238000006062 fragmentation reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012458 free base Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000004108 freeze drying Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012737 fresh medium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 101150098622 gag gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229940083124 ganglion-blocking antiadrenergic secondary and tertiary amines Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 150000002270 gangliosides Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000007789 gas Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000001502 gel electrophoresis Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000008273 gelatin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920000159 gelatin Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 235000019322 gelatine Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 235000011852 gelatine desserts Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 238000002523 gelfiltration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000007274 generation of a signal involved in cell-cell signaling Effects 0.000 description 1
- 102000054766 genetic haplotypes Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 231100000025 genetic toxicology Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 230000001738 genotoxic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 231100000734 genotoxic potential Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 239000011521 glass Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229960002442 glucosamine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229940116332 glucose oxidase Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000019420 glucose oxidase Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 125000002791 glucosyl group Chemical group C1([C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H](O1)CO)* 0.000 description 1
- 235000013922 glutamic acid Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000004220 glutamic acid Substances 0.000 description 1
- ZDXPYRJPNDTMRX-UHFFFAOYSA-N glutamine Natural products OC(=O)C(N)CCC(N)=O ZDXPYRJPNDTMRX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- PCHJSUWPFVWCPO-UHFFFAOYSA-N gold Chemical compound [Au] PCHJSUWPFVWCPO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052737 gold Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000010931 gold Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000002710 gonadal effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003102 growth factor Substances 0.000 description 1
- PJJJBBJSCAKJQF-UHFFFAOYSA-N guanidinium chloride Chemical compound [Cl-].NC(N)=[NH2+] PJJJBBJSCAKJQF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000003505 heat denaturation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229910001385 heavy metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229940037467 helicobacter pylori Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000000185 hemagglutinin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000002489 hematologic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229960002897 heparin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229920000669 heparin Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 208000006454 hepatitis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 231100000283 hepatitis Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 206010073071 hepatocellular carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 125000002017 heptosyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 230000002363 herbicidal effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000004009 herbicide Substances 0.000 description 1
- 101150113423 hisD gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 230000028996 humoral immune response Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000004754 hybrid cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 235000011167 hydrochloric acid Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000000017 hydrogel Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000001257 hydrogen Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052739 hydrogen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 150000004679 hydroxides Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 125000002887 hydroxy group Chemical group [H]O* 0.000 description 1
- 239000001863 hydroxypropyl cellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000010977 hydroxypropyl cellulose Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 230000003100 immobilizing effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002519 immonomodulatory effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000008105 immune reaction Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229940072221 immunoglobulins Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000002434 immunopotentiative effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000001114 immunoprecipitation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000001506 immunosuppresive effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001024 immunotherapeutic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000009169 immunotherapy Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000006872 improvement Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000007901 in situ hybridization Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002779 inactivation Effects 0.000 description 1
- PZOUSPYUWWUPPK-UHFFFAOYSA-N indole Natural products CC1=CC=CC2=C1C=CN2 PZOUSPYUWWUPPK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- RKJUIXBNRJVNHR-UHFFFAOYSA-N indolenine Natural products C1=CC=C2CC=NC2=C1 RKJUIXBNRJVNHR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000002458 infectious effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001524 infective effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000028709 inflammatory response Effects 0.000 description 1
- 208000037798 influenza B Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000007972 injectable composition Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000011081 inoculation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000002054 inoculum Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000007689 inspection Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002452 interceptive effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229960003130 interferon gamma Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 238000007917 intracranial administration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000008863 intramolecular interaction Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000007928 intraperitoneal injection Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000007913 intrathecal administration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002601 intratumoral effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000010253 intravenous injection Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000007852 inverse PCR Methods 0.000 description 1
- PGLTVOMIXTUURA-UHFFFAOYSA-N iodoacetamide Chemical compound NC(=O)CI PGLTVOMIXTUURA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000004255 ion exchange chromatography Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003456 ion exchange resin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920003303 ion-exchange polymer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 150000002500 ions Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229910052742 iron Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 230000002427 irreversible effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- JJWLVOIRVHMVIS-UHFFFAOYSA-N isopropylamine Chemical compound CC(C)N JJWLVOIRVHMVIS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 210000003734 kidney Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 101150066555 lacZ gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 239000008101 lactose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000787 lecithin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940067606 lecithin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000010445 lecithin Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000002523 lectin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000021633 leukocyte mediated immunity Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000007834 ligase chain reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000029226 lipidation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229910052744 lithium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 244000144972 livestock Species 0.000 description 1
- 230000004807 localization Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000007774 longterm Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000006210 lotion Substances 0.000 description 1
- 210000004072 lung Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 201000005202 lung cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000020816 lung neoplasm Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 210000001165 lymph node Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000012139 lysis buffer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229960000274 lysozyme Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000004325 lysozyme Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000010335 lysozyme Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229920002521 macromolecule Polymers 0.000 description 1
- ZLNQQNXFFQJAID-UHFFFAOYSA-L magnesium carbonate Chemical compound [Mg+2].[O-]C([O-])=O ZLNQQNXFFQJAID-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- 239000001095 magnesium carbonate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910000021 magnesium carbonate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 159000000003 magnesium salts Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 235000019359 magnesium stearate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 238000004949 mass spectrometry Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000005259 measurement Methods 0.000 description 1
- 201000001441 melanoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 210000004779 membrane envelope Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229910021645 metal ion Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229910044991 metal oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 150000004706 metal oxides Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000002739 metals Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 238000010208 microarray analysis Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000813 microbial effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000000908 micropen lithography Methods 0.000 description 1
- 235000013336 milk Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000008267 milk Substances 0.000 description 1
- 210000004080 milk Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000002480 mineral oil Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000010446 mineral oil Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 150000007522 mineralic acids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- ZAHQPTJLOCWVPG-UHFFFAOYSA-N mitoxantrone dihydrochloride Chemical compound Cl.Cl.O=C1C2=C(O)C=CC(O)=C2C(=O)C2=C1C(NCCNCCO)=CC=C2NCCNCCO ZAHQPTJLOCWVPG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 108091005601 modified peptides Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 230000007193 modulation by symbiont of host erythrocyte aggregation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000020654 modulation by virus of host translation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000002991 molded plastic Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000004784 molecular pathogenesis Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000178 monomer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 210000000663 muscle cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000003471 mutagenic agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000000869 mutational effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002071 myeloproliferative effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229940037525 nasal preparations Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 210000000822 natural killer cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229960004927 neomycin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000001613 neoplastic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- GVUGOAYIVIDWIO-UFWWTJHBSA-N nepidermin Chemical compound C([C@@H](C(=O)N[C@@H]([C@@H](C)CC)C(=O)NCC(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(O)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCCNC(N)=N)C(=O)N[C@@H](CS)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(N)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC=1C=CC(O)=CC=1)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCCNC(N)=N)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(O)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(C)C)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCCCN)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC=1C2=CC=CC=C2NC=1)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC=1C2=CC=CC=C2NC=1)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(O)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(C)C)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCCNC(N)=N)C(O)=O)NC(=O)CNC(=O)[C@@H](NC(=O)[C@@H](NC(=O)[C@H](CS)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(N)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](CS)NC(=O)[C@H](C)NC(=O)[C@H](CC=1C=CC(O)=CC=1)NC(=O)[C@H](CCCCN)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(O)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(C)C)NC(=O)[C@H](C)NC(=O)[C@H](CCC(O)=O)NC(=O)[C@@H](NC(=O)[C@H](CC=1C=CC(O)=CC=1)NC(=O)[C@H](CCSC)NC(=O)[C@H](CS)NC(=O)[C@@H](NC(=O)CNC(=O)[C@H](CC(O)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](CC=1NC=NC=1)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(C)C)NC(=O)[C@H](CS)NC(=O)[C@H](CC=1C=CC(O)=CC=1)NC(=O)CNC(=O)[C@H](CC(O)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](CC=1NC=NC=1)NC(=O)[C@H](CO)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(C)C)NC(=O)[C@H]1N(CCC1)C(=O)[C@H](CS)NC(=O)[C@H](CCC(O)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](CO)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(O)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](CO)NC(=O)[C@@H](N)CC(N)=O)C(C)C)[C@@H](C)CC)C(C)C)C(C)C)C1=CC=C(O)C=C1 GVUGOAYIVIDWIO-UFWWTJHBSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 101150115538 nero gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 238000006386 neutralization reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229920001220 nitrocellulos Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229910052757 nitrogen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 231100000957 no side effect Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 230000009871 nonspecific binding Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000007899 nucleic acid hybridization Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000002853 nucleic acid probe Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000001821 nucleic acid purification Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000001668 nucleic acid synthesis Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000269 nucleophilic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000030648 nucleus localization Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000005457 optimization Methods 0.000 description 1
- 150000007524 organic acids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 235000005985 organic acids Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 230000008520 organization Effects 0.000 description 1
- 244000052769 pathogen Species 0.000 description 1
- 230000000149 penetrating effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000737 periodic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000003819 peripheral blood mononuclear cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 230000002093 peripheral effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000003200 peritoneal cavity Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 210000003024 peritoneal macrophage Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 230000002688 persistence Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000008782 phagocytosis Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000008249 pharmaceutical aerosol Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000825 pharmaceutical preparation Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000009520 phase I clinical trial Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229960003742 phenol Drugs 0.000 description 1
- COLNVLDHVKWLRT-UHFFFAOYSA-N phenylalanine Natural products OC(=O)C(N)CC1=CC=CC=C1 COLNVLDHVKWLRT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000004633 phorbol derivatives Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000002644 phorbol ester Substances 0.000 description 1
- WTJKGGKOPKCXLL-RRHRGVEJSA-N phosphatidylcholine Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC(=O)OC[C@H](COP([O-])(=O)OCC[N+](C)(C)C)OC(=O)CCCCCCCC=CCCCCCCCC WTJKGGKOPKCXLL-RRHRGVEJSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000004713 phosphodiesters Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 150000008300 phosphoramidites Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 235000011007 phosphoric acid Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 150000003013 phosphoric acid derivatives Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 150000003016 phosphoric acids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 230000026731 phosphorylation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000006366 phosphorylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000000053 physical method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000004962 physiological condition Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000006187 pill Substances 0.000 description 1
- 108700028325 pokeweed antiviral Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229920000771 poly (alkylcyanoacrylate) Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920001606 poly(lactic acid-co-glycolic acid) Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920002627 poly(phosphazenes) Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000058 polyacrylate Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000768 polyamine Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 230000000379 polymerizing effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229920005862 polyol Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 150000003077 polyols Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000004800 polyvinyl chloride Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920000915 polyvinyl chloride Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000002244 precipitate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000003141 primary amines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 230000001566 pro-viral effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- MFDFERRIHVXMIY-UHFFFAOYSA-N procaine Chemical compound CCN(CC)CCOC(=O)C1=CC=C(N)C=C1 MFDFERRIHVXMIY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960004919 procaine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000000750 progressive effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000001236 prokaryotic cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 230000001902 propagating effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003380 propellant Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000000069 prophylactic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000002307 prostate Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 235000019419 proteases Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 230000002685 pulmonary effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000010926 purge Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000011002 quantification Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000000700 radioactive tracer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000003439 radiotherapeutic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000601 reactogenic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002829 reductive effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000037425 regulation of transcription Effects 0.000 description 1
- 101150066583 rep gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 238000011160 research Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000012827 research and development Methods 0.000 description 1
- 210000002345 respiratory system Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 208000023504 respiratory system disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000000717 retained effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000004007 reversed phase HPLC Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002441 reversible effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000003705 ribosome Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- CVHZOJJKTDOEJC-UHFFFAOYSA-N saccharin Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C(=O)NS(=O)(=O)C2=C1 CVHZOJJKTDOEJC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000003345 scintillation counting Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000000926 separation method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000405 serological effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229940076279 serotonin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000035939 shock Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000013605 shuttle vector Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000019491 signal transduction Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000002415 sodium dodecyl sulfate polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012064 sodium phosphate buffer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000003381 solubilizing effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 235000010199 sorbic acid Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000004334 sorbic acid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940075582 sorbic acid Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 125000006850 spacer group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 230000009870 specific binding Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000004611 spectroscopical analysis Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003381 stabilizer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000012289 standard assay Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000007858 starting material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 210000000130 stem cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 230000000707 stereoselective effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001954 sterilising effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000004659 sterilization and disinfection Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000003756 stirring Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229940031000 streptococcus pneumoniae Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 238000010254 subcutaneous injection Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000007929 subcutaneous injection Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000035322 succinylation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000010613 succinylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000004434 sulfur atom Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 230000004083 survival effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000375 suspending agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 208000011580 syndromic disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000006379 syphilis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000001839 systemic circulation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000012385 systemic delivery Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000009885 systemic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000454 talc Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000012222 talc Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229910052623 talc Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 102000055501 telomere Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108091035539 telomere Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 210000003411 telomere Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229960000814 tetanus toxoid Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 239000002562 thickening agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- RTKIYNMVFMVABJ-UHFFFAOYSA-L thimerosal Chemical compound [Na+].CC[Hg]SC1=CC=CC=C1C([O-])=O RTKIYNMVFMVABJ-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- 229940033663 thimerosal Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 238000004809 thin layer chromatography Methods 0.000 description 1
- RYYWUUFWQRZTIU-UHFFFAOYSA-K thiophosphate Chemical compound [O-]P([O-])([O-])=S RYYWUUFWQRZTIU-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 1
- 108060008226 thioredoxin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229940094937 thioredoxin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229960004072 thrombin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000036964 tight binding Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000012090 tissue culture technique Methods 0.000 description 1
- 210000003437 trachea Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 230000005030 transcription termination Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000006276 transfer reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000001131 transforming effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001052 transient effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 101150081616 trpB gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101150111232 trpB-1 gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 201000008827 tuberculosis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- WFKWXMTUELFFGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N tungsten Chemical compound [W] WFKWXMTUELFFGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052721 tungsten Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000010937 tungsten Substances 0.000 description 1
- OUYCCCASQSFEME-UHFFFAOYSA-N tyrosine Natural products OC(=O)C(N)CC1=CC=C(O)C=C1 OUYCCCASQSFEME-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000003668 tyrosines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000011882 ultra-fine particle Substances 0.000 description 1
- 241000701447 unidentified baculovirus Species 0.000 description 1
- 241001529453 unidentified herpesvirus Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000712461 unidentified influenza virus Species 0.000 description 1
- 239000002691 unilamellar liposome Substances 0.000 description 1
- DRTQHJPVMGBUCF-UHFFFAOYSA-N uracil arabinoside Natural products OC1C(O)C(CO)OC1N1C(=O)NC(=O)C=C1 DRTQHJPVMGBUCF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940045145 uridine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 201000005112 urinary bladder cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000001291 vacuum drying Methods 0.000 description 1
- 235000015112 vegetable and seed oil Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000008158 vegetable oil Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000001262 western blot Methods 0.000 description 1
- 210000005253 yeast cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229910052727 yttrium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000011701 zinc Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229910052725 zinc Chemical class 0.000 description 1
Classifications
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G01—MEASURING; TESTING
- G01N—INVESTIGATING OR ANALYSING MATERIALS BY DETERMINING THEIR CHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
- G01N33/00—Investigating or analysing materials by specific methods not covered by groups G01N1/00 - G01N31/00
- G01N33/48—Biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Haemocytometers
- G01N33/50—Chemical analysis of biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Testing involving biospecific ligand binding methods; Immunological testing
- G01N33/53—Immunoassay; Biospecific binding assay; Materials therefor
- G01N33/574—Immunoassay; Biospecific binding assay; Materials therefor for cancer
- G01N33/57484—Immunoassay; Biospecific binding assay; Materials therefor for cancer involving compounds serving as markers for tumor, cancer, neoplasia, e.g. cellular determinants, receptors, heat shock/stress proteins, A-protein, oligosaccharides, metabolites
- G01N33/57492—Immunoassay; Biospecific binding assay; Materials therefor for cancer involving compounds serving as markers for tumor, cancer, neoplasia, e.g. cellular determinants, receptors, heat shock/stress proteins, A-protein, oligosaccharides, metabolites involving compounds localized on the membrane of tumor or cancer cells
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12Q—MEASURING OR TESTING PROCESSES INVOLVING ENZYMES, NUCLEIC ACIDS OR MICROORGANISMS; COMPOSITIONS OR TEST PAPERS THEREFOR; PROCESSES OF PREPARING SUCH COMPOSITIONS; CONDITION-RESPONSIVE CONTROL IN MICROBIOLOGICAL OR ENZYMOLOGICAL PROCESSES
- C12Q1/00—Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions
- C12Q1/68—Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions involving nucleic acids
- C12Q1/6876—Nucleic acid products used in the analysis of nucleic acids, e.g. primers or probes
- C12Q1/6883—Nucleic acid products used in the analysis of nucleic acids, e.g. primers or probes for diseases caused by alterations of genetic material
- C12Q1/6886—Nucleic acid products used in the analysis of nucleic acids, e.g. primers or probes for diseases caused by alterations of genetic material for cancer
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K2239/00—Indexing codes associated with cellular immunotherapy of group A61K39/46
- A61K2239/46—Indexing codes associated with cellular immunotherapy of group A61K39/46 characterised by the cancer treated
- A61K2239/48—Blood cells, e.g. leukemia or lymphoma
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K38/00—Medicinal preparations containing peptides
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K39/00—Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
- A61K39/46—Cellular immunotherapy
- A61K39/461—Cellular immunotherapy characterised by the cell type used
- A61K39/4611—T-cells, e.g. tumor infiltrating lymphocytes [TIL], lymphokine-activated killer cells [LAK] or regulatory T cells [Treg]
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K39/00—Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
- A61K39/46—Cellular immunotherapy
- A61K39/463—Cellular immunotherapy characterised by recombinant expression
- A61K39/4632—T-cell receptors [TCR]; antibody T-cell receptor constructs
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K39/00—Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
- A61K39/46—Cellular immunotherapy
- A61K39/464—Cellular immunotherapy characterised by the antigen targeted or presented
- A61K39/4643—Vertebrate antigens
- A61K39/4644—Cancer antigens
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K47/00—Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
- A61K47/50—Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates
- A61K47/51—Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent
- A61K47/68—Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an antibody, an immunoglobulin or a fragment thereof, e.g. an Fc-fragment
- A61K47/6835—Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an antibody, an immunoglobulin or a fragment thereof, e.g. an Fc-fragment the modifying agent being an antibody or an immunoglobulin bearing at least one antigen-binding site
- A61K47/6851—Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an antibody, an immunoglobulin or a fragment thereof, e.g. an Fc-fragment the modifying agent being an antibody or an immunoglobulin bearing at least one antigen-binding site the antibody targeting a determinant of a tumour cell
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61P—SPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
- A61P35/00—Antineoplastic agents
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61P—SPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
- A61P35/00—Antineoplastic agents
- A61P35/02—Antineoplastic agents specific for leukemia
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61P—SPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
- A61P7/00—Drugs for disorders of the blood or the extracellular fluid
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K14/00—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
- C07K14/435—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans
- C07K14/46—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans from vertebrates
- C07K14/47—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans from vertebrates from mammals
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K14/00—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
- C07K14/435—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans
- C07K14/705—Receptors; Cell surface antigens; Cell surface determinants
- C07K14/70503—Immunoglobulin superfamily
- C07K14/70535—Fc-receptors, e.g. CD16, CD32, CD64 (CD2314/705F)
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G01—MEASURING; TESTING
- G01N—INVESTIGATING OR ANALYSING MATERIALS BY DETERMINING THEIR CHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
- G01N33/00—Investigating or analysing materials by specific methods not covered by groups G01N1/00 - G01N31/00
- G01N33/48—Biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Haemocytometers
- G01N33/50—Chemical analysis of biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Testing involving biospecific ligand binding methods; Immunological testing
- G01N33/53—Immunoassay; Biospecific binding assay; Materials therefor
- G01N33/574—Immunoassay; Biospecific binding assay; Materials therefor for cancer
- G01N33/57407—Specifically defined cancers
- G01N33/57426—Specifically defined cancers leukemia
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K39/00—Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12Q—MEASURING OR TESTING PROCESSES INVOLVING ENZYMES, NUCLEIC ACIDS OR MICROORGANISMS; COMPOSITIONS OR TEST PAPERS THEREFOR; PROCESSES OF PREPARING SUCH COMPOSITIONS; CONDITION-RESPONSIVE CONTROL IN MICROBIOLOGICAL OR ENZYMOLOGICAL PROCESSES
- C12Q2600/00—Oligonucleotides characterized by their use
- C12Q2600/158—Expression markers
Definitions
- the present invention relates generally to the fields of cancer diagnosis and therapy. More particularly, it concerns the surprising discovery of compositions and methods for the detection and im unotherapy of hematological malignancies, and particularly, B cell leukemias, and lymphomas and multiple myelomas.
- the invention provides new, effective methods, compositions and kits for eliciting immune and T-cell response to antigenic polypeptides, and antigenic peptide fragments isolated therefrom, and methods for the use of such compositions for diagnosis, detection, treatment, monitoring, and/or prevention of various types of human hematological malignancies.
- the invention provides polypeptide, peptide, antibody, antigen binding fragment, hybridoma, host cell, vector, and polynucleotide compounds and compositions for use in identification and discrimination between various types of hematological malignancies, and methods for the detection, diagnosis, prognosis, monitoring, and therapy of such conditions in an affected animal.
- Hematological malignancies such as leukemias and lymphomas, are conditions characterized by abnormal growth and maturation of hematopoietic cells.
- Leukemias are generally neoplastic disorders of hematopoietic stem cells, and include adult and pediatric acute myeloid leukemia (AML), chronic myeloid leukemia (CML), acute lymphocytic leukemia (ALL), chronic lymphocytic leukemia (CLL) and secondary leukemia.
- AML acute myeloid leukemia
- CML chronic myeloid leukemia
- ALL acute lymphocytic leukemia
- CLL chronic lymphocytic leukemia
- secondary leukemia secondary leukemia.
- NHL non-Hodgkin's lymphoma
- Hodgkin's disease Hodgkin's disease.
- NHLs are the result of a clonal expansion of B- or T-cells, but the molecular pathogenesis of Hodgkin's disease, including lineage derivation and clonality, remains obscure.
- Other hematological malignancies include myelodysplastic syndromes (MDS), myeloproliferative syndromes (MPS) and myeloma. Hematological malignancies are generally serious disorders, resulting in a variety of symptoms, including bone marrow failure and organ failure.
- NHLs are the sixth most common cause of cancer related deaths in the United States. Only prostate, breast, lung, colorectal and bladder cancer currently exceed lymphoma in annual incidence. In 1995, more than 45,000 new NHLs were diagnosed, and over 21,000 patients died of these diseases. The average age of lymphoma patients is relatively young (42 years), and the resulting number of years of life lost to these diseases renders NHLs fourth in economic impact among cancers in the United States. In the past 15 years, the American Cancer Society reported a 50% increase in the incidence of NHLs, one of the largest increases for any cancer group. Much of this increase has been attributed to the development of lymphomas in younger men who have acquired AIDS. Lymphomas are also the third most common childhood malignancy and account for approximately 10% of cancers in children. The survival rate (all ages) varies from 73% (low risk) to 26% (high risk).
- the present invention addresses the foregoing long-felt need and other deficiencies in the art by identifying new and effective strategies for the identification, detection, screening, diagnosis, prognosis, prophylaxis, therapy, and immunomodulation of one or more hematological malignancies, and in particular, B cell leukemias and lymphomas, and multiple myelomas.
- the present invention is based, in part, upon the surprising and unexpected discovery that certain previously unknown or unidentified human polypeptides, peptides, and antigenic fragments derived therefrom have now been identified that are overexpressed in one or more types of hematological malignancies.
- the genes encoding several of these polypeptides are now identified and obtained in isolated form, and have been characterized using a series of molecular biology methodologies including subtractive library analysis, microarray screening, polynucleotide sequencing, peptide and epitopic identification and characterization, as well as expression profiling, and in vitro whole gene cell priming.
- polypeptides, peptides, and antigenic fragments they encode are now identified and implicated in the complex processes of hematological malignancy disease onset, progression, and/or outcome, and in particular, diseases such as leukemias and lymphomas.
- compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis, prognosis, prophylaxis and/or therapy of one or more of these diseases are useful in the development of particularly advantageous compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis, prognosis, prophylaxis and/or therapy of one or more of these diseases, and particularly those conditions that are characterized by (a) an increased, altered, elevated, or sustained expression of one or more polynucleotides that comprise at least a first sequence region that comprises a nucleic acid sequence as disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs: 11,000 - 11,038 and 11,291-11,292 or (b) an increased, altered, elevated, or sustained biological activity of one or more polypeptides that comprise at least a first sequence region that comprises an amino acid sequence as encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs: 11,039-11,058 and 11293.
- the present invention also provides methods and uses for one or more of the disclosed peptide, polypeptide, antibody, antigen binding fragment, and polynucleotide compositions of the present invention in generating an immune response or in generating a T-cell response in an animal, and in particular in a mammal such as a human.
- the invention also provides methods and uses for one or more of these compositions in the identification, detection, and quantitation of hematological malignancy compositions in clinical samples, isolated cells, whole tissues, and even affected individuals.
- the compositions and methods disclosed herein also may be used in the preparation of one or more diagnostic reagents, assays, medicaments, or therapeutics, for diagnosis and/or therapy of such diseases.
- composition comprising at least a first isolated peptide or polypeptide that comprises an amino acid sequence that is at least about 80%, about 81%, about 82%, about 83%, about 84%, about 85%, about 86%, about 87%, about 88%, about 89%, about 90%, about 91%, about 92%, about 93%, about 94%, about 95%o, about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, or about 99% identical to the amino acid sequence encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs: 11,039-11,058 and 11,293.
- Exemplary preferred sequences are those that comprise at least a first coding region that comprises an amino acid sequence that is at least about 85%, about 86%, about 87%, about 88%, about 89%, about 90%, about 91%, about 92%, about 93%, or about 94% identical to the amino acid sequence as encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs: 11,039-11,058 and 11,293, with those sequences that comprise at least a first coding region that comprises an amino acid sequence that is at least about 95%), about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, or about 99% identical to the amino acid sequence as encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,039-11,058, and 11,293 being examples of particularly preferred sequences in the practice of the present invention.
- peptide and polypeptide compounds and compositions are also provided that comprise, consist essentially of, or consist of the amino acid sequence as encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,039-11,058, and 11,293.
- compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis, prognosis, prophylaxis, treatment, and therapy of B cell leukemia, lymphoma and multiple myeloma include, but are not limited to, those peptide and polypeptide compounds or compositions that comprise at least a first isolated peptide or polypeptide that comprises an amino acid sequence that is at least about 80%, about 81%, about 82%, about 83%, about 84%, about 85%, about 86%, about 87%, about 88%, about 89%, about 90%, about 91%, about 92%, about 93%, about 94%, about 95%, about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, or about 99% identical to the amino acid sequence as encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs: 11,039-11,058, and 11, 293 and those that
- Exemplary peptides of the present invention may be of any suitable length, depending upon the particular application thereof, and encompass those peptides that are about 9, about 10, about 15, about 20, about 25, about 30, about 35, about 40, about 45, about 50, about 55, about 60, about 65, about 70, about 75, about 80, about 85, about 90, about 95, or about 100 or so amino acids in length.
- the peptides of the invention may also encompass any intermediate lengths or integers within the stated ranges.
- Exemplary polypeptides and proteins of the present invention may be of any suitable length, depending upon the particular application thereof, and encompass those polypeptides and proteins that are about 100, about 150, about 200, about 250, about 300, about 350, or about 400 or so amino acids in length. Of course, the polypeptides and proteins of the invention may also encompass any intermediate lengths or integers within the stated ranges.
- the peptides, polypeptides, proteins, antibodies, and antigen binding fragments of the present invention will preferably comprise a sequence of at least about 5, 10, 15, 20, 25,
- polypeptides, proteins, antibodies, and antigen binding fragments of the present invention will even more preferably comprise at least a first isolated coding region that comprises a sequence of at least about 100, 110, 120, 130, 140, 150, 160, 170, 180, 190, or 200 contiguous amino acids from any one of the peptides as encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs: 11,039-11,058, and 11,293.
- polypeptides, proteins, antibodies, and antigen binding fragments of the present invention may comprise at least a first isolated coding region that comprises a substantially longer sequence, such as for example, one of at least about 200, 220, 240, 260, 280, or 300 or more contiguous amino acids from any one of the peptides as encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs:ll,039-l l,058, and 11,293.
- the polypeptides of the invention comprise an amino acid sequence that (a) comprises, (b) consists essentially of, or (c) consists of, the amino acid sequence encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs: 11,039-11,058, and 11,293.
- polypeptides and proteins of the invention preferably comprise an amino acid sequence that is encoded by at least a first nucleic acid segment that comprises an at least 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, or 30 contiguous nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:ll,000-l l,038 and 11,291-11,292.
- polypeptides and proteins of the invention may also preferably comprise an amino acid sequence encoded by at least a first nucleic acid segment that comprises an at least about 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, or 40 contiguous nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,000-11,038, and 11,292-11,292.
- the polypeptides and proteins of the invention may also preferably comprise one or more coding regions that comprise an amino acid sequence encoded by at least a first nucleic acid segment that comprises an at least about 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, or 50 contiguous nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:l l,000-ll,038, and 11,291-11,292.
- polypeptides and proteins of the invention may also preferably comprise one or more coding regions that comprise an amino acid sequence encoded by at least a first nucleic acid segment that comprises an at least about 51, 52, 53, 54, 55, 56, 57, 58, 59, or 60 contiguous nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,000-11,038, ans 11,291-11,292.
- polypeptides and proteins of the invention may also preferably comprise one or more coding regions that comprise an amino acid sequence encoded by at least a first nucleic acid segment that comprises an at least about 70, 80, 90, 100, 110, 120, 130, 140 or 150 contiguous nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,000-11,038, andl 1,291-11,292.
- polypeptides and proteins of the invention may also preferably comprise one or more coding regions that comprise an amino acid sequence encoded by at least a first nucleic acid segment that comprises an at least about 175, 200, 225, 250, 275, 300, 325, 350, 375, or 400 contiguous nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs: 11,000-11,038, and 11,291-11,292.
- polypeptides and proteins of the invention may also preferably comprise one or more coding regions that comprise an amino acid sequence encoded by at least a first nucleic acid segment that comprises an at least about 500, 600, 700, 800, 900, 1000, 1100, 1200, 1300, 1400, or 1500 contiguous nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,000-11,038, and 11,291-11,292.
- composition comprising at least a first isolated polynucleotide that comprises a nucleic acid sequence that is at least about 80%, about 81%>, about 82%, about 83%, about 84%, about 85%, about 86%, about 87%, about 88%, about 89%, about 90%, about 91%, about 92%, about 93%, about 94%, about 95%o, about 96%>, about 97%, about 98%>, or about 99% identical to the nucleic acid sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,000-11,038, and 11,291-11,292.
- Exemplary preferred sequences are those that comprise a nucleic acid sequence that is at least about 85%, about 86%, about 87%, about 88%, about 89%, about 90%, about 91%, about 92%, about 93%), or about 94%> identical to the nucleic acid sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs: 11,000-11,038 and 11,291-11,292, with those sequences that comprise at least a nucleic acid sequence that is at least about 95%, about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, or about 99% identical to the nucleic acid sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:ll,000-ll,038, and 11,291- 11,292 being examples of particularly preferred sequences in the practice of the present invention.
- compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis, prognosis, prophylaxis, treatment, and therapy of B cell leukemias, lymphomas, and multiple myelomas exemplary preferred polynucleotide compositions include those compositions that comprise at least a first isolated nucleic acid segment that comprises a sequence that is at least about 80%, about 81%, about 82%, about 83%, about 84%, about 85%, about 86%, about 87%, about 88%, about 89%, about 90%, about 91%, about 92%, about 93%, about 94%, about 95%, about 96%, about 97%, about 98%, or about 99%) identical to the nucleic acid sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,000-11,038, and 11,291-11,292.
- Such polynucleotides will preferably comprise one or more isolated coding region, each of which may (a) comprise, (b) consist essentially of, or (c) consist of, the nucleic acid sequence of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,000-11,038, and 11,291-11,292.
- Exemplary polynucleotides of the present invention may be of any suitable length, depending upon the particular application thereof, and encompass those polynucleotides that (a) are at least about, or (b) comprise at least a first isolated nucleic acid segment that is at least about 27, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, 100, 110, 120, 120, 140, 150, 160, 170, 180, 190, 200, 210, 220, 230, 240, 250, 260, 270, 280, 290, 300, 320, 340, 360, 380, 400, 420, 440, 460, 480, 500, 520, 540, 560, 580, 600, 625, 650, 675, 700, 750, 800, 850, 900, 950, or 1000 or so nucleic acids in length, as well as longer polynucleotides that (a) are at least about, or (b) comprise at least a first isolated nucleic acid segment that is at least about 1000, 10
- compositions of the present invention may comprise a single polypeptide or polynucleotide, or alternatively, may comprise two or more such hematological malignancy compounds, such as for example, two or more polypeptides, two or more polynucleotides, or even combinations of one or more peptides or polypeptides, along with one or more polynucleotides.
- two or more polypeptides are contemplated for particular applications, the second and/or third and/or fourth, etc.
- isolated peptides and/or polypeptides will preferably comprise an amino acid sequence that is at least about 91%, 93%, 95%, 97%, or 99% identical to the amino acid sequence encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs: 11,039-11,058, and 11,293.
- the polynucleotides of the invention may comprise one or more coding regions that encode a first fusion protein or peptide, such as an adjuvant-coding region fused in correct reading frame to one or more of the disclosed hematological malignancy peptides or polypeptides.
- the fusion protein may comprise a hematological malignancy polypeptide or peptide fused, in correct reading frame, to a detectable protein or peptide, or to an immunostimulant protein or peptide, or other such construct. Fusion proteins such as these are particularly useful in those embodiments relating to diagnosis, detection, and therapy of one or more of the hematological malignancies as discussed herein.
- the invention also provides a composition
- a composition comprising at least a first hybridoma cell line that produces a monoclonal antibody having immunospecificity for one or more of the peptides or polypeptides as disclosed herein, or at least a first monoclonal antibody, or an antigen-binding fragment thereof, that has immunospecificity for such a peptide or polypeptide.
- the antigen binding fragments may comprise a light chain variable region, a heavy-chain variable region, a Fab fragment, a F(ab) 2 fragment, an Fv fragment, an scFv fragment, or an antigen-binding fragment of such an antibody.
- the invention also provides a composition
- a composition comprising at least a first isolated antigen-presenting cell that expresses a peptide or polypeptide as disclosed herein, or a plurality of isolated T cells that specifically react with such a peptide or polypeptide.
- Such pluralities of isolated T cells may be stimulated or expanded by contacting the T cells with one or more peptides or polypeptides as described herein.
- the T cells may be cloned prior to expansion, and may be obtained from bone marrow, a bone marrow fraction, peripheral blood, or a peripheral blood fraction from a healthy mammal, or from a mammal that is afflicted with at least a first hematological malignancy such as leukemia or lymphoma.
- the isolated polypeptides of the invention may be on the order of from 9 to about 1000 amino acids in length, or alternatively, may be on the order of from 50 to about 900 amino acids in length, from 75 to about 800 amino acids in length, from 100 to about 700 amino acids in length, or from 125 to about 600 amino acids in length, or any other such suitable range.
- isolated nucleic acid segments that encode such isolated polypeptides may be on the order of from 27 to about 10,000 nucleotides in length, from 150 to about 8000 nucleotides in length, from 250 to about 6000 nucleotides in length, from 350 to about 4000 nucleotides in length, or from 450 to about 2000 nucleotides in length, or any other such suitable range.
- the nucleic acid segment may be operably positioned under the control of at least a first heterologous, recombinant promoter, such as a tissue-specific, cell-specific, inducible, or otherwise regulated promoter. Such promoters may be further controlled or regulated by the presence of one or more additional enhancers or regulatory regions depending upon the particular cell type in which expression of the polynucleotide is desired.
- the polynucleotides and nucleic acid segments of the invention may also be comprised within a vector, such as a plasmid, or viral vector.
- the polypeptides and polynucleotides of the invention may also be comprised within a host cell, such as a recombinant host cell, or a human host cell such as a blood or bone marrow cell.
- the polynucleotides of the invention may comprise at least a first isolated nucleic acid segment operably attached, in frame, to at least a second isolated nucleic acid segment, such that the polynucleotide encodes a fusion protein in which the first peptide or polypeptide is linked to the second peptide or polypeptide.
- polypeptides of the present invention may comprise a contiguous amino acid of any suitable length, such as for example, those of about 2000, about 1900, about 1850, about 1800, about 1750, about 1700, about 1650, about 1600, about 1550, about 1500, about 1450, about 1400, about 1350, about 1300, about 1250, about 1200, about 1150, about 1100 amino acids, or about 1000 or so amino acids in length.
- polypeptides and peptides of the present invention may comprise slightly shorter contiguous amino acid coding regions, such as for example, those of about 950, about 900, about 850, about 800, about 750, about 700, about 650, about 600, about 550, about 500, about 450, about 400, about 350, about 300, about 250, about 200, about 150, or even about 100 amino acids or so in length.
- polypeptides and peptides of the present invention may comprise even smaller contiguous amino acid coding regions, such as for example, those of about 95, about 90, about 85, about 80, about 75, about 70, about 65, about 60, about 55, about 50, about 45, about 40, about 35, about 30, about 25, about 20, about 15, or even about 9 amino acids or so in length.
- those peptides and polypeptides having intermediate lengths including all integers within the preferred ranges are all contemplated to fall within the scope of the present invention.
- the peptides and polypeptides of the present invention may comprise a sequence of at least about 9, or about 10, or about 11, or about 12, or about 13, or about 14, or about 15, or about 16, or about 17, or about 18, or about 19, or about 20, or about 21, or about 22, or about 23, or about 24, or about 25, or about 26, or about 27, or about 28, or about 29, or about 30, or about 31, or about 32, or about 33, or about 34, or about 35, or about 36, or about 37, or about 38, or about 39, or about 40, or about 41, or about 42, or about 43, or about 44, or about 45, or about 46, or about 47, or about 48, or about 49, or about 50 contiguous amino acids as disclosed in any one or more of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs.l 1,039-11,058, and 11,293 herein.
- the peptides and polypeptides of the present invention may comprise a sequence of at least about 51, or about 52, or about 53, or about 54, or about 55, or about 56, or about 57, or about 58, or about 59, or about 60, or about 61, or about 62, or about 63, or about 64, or about 65, or about 66, or about 67, or about 68, or about 69, or about 70, or about 71, or about 72, or about 73, or about 74, or about 75, or about 76, or about 77, or about 78, or about 79, or about 80, or about 81, or about 82, or about 83, or about 84, or about 85, or about 86, or about 87, or about 88, or about 89, or about 90, about 91, or about 92, or about 93, or about 94, or about 95, or about 96, or about 97, or about 98, or about 99, or 100
- the preferred peptides and polypeptides of the present invention comprise a sequence of at least about 100, 125, 150, 175, 200, 225, 250, 275, 300, 325, 350, 375, or 400 or more contiguous amino acids as disclosed in any one or more of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,039-11,058, and 11,293 herein.
- polypeptides of the invention typically will comprise at least a first contiguous amino acid sequence according to any one of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs:ll,039-ll,058, and 11,293, but may also, optionally comprise at least a second, at least a third, or even at least a fourth or greater contiguous amino acid sequence according to any one of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs:ll,039-ll,058, and 11,293.
- a single polypeptide may contain only a single coding region, or alternatively, a single polypeptide may comprise a plurality of identical or distinctly different contiguous amino acid sequences in accordance with any one of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,039-11,058, and 11,293.
- the polypeptide may comprise a plurality of the same contiguous amino acid sequences, or they may comprise one or more different contiguous amino acid sequences of any of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs:ll,039-l 1,058, and 11,293.
- a single polypeptide can comprise a single contiguous amino acid sequence from one or more of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs: 11,039-11,058, and 11,293, or alternatively, may comprise two or more distinctly different contiguous amino acid sequences from one or more of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs:l l,039-ll,058, and 11,293.
- the polypeptide may comprise 2, 3, 4, or even 5 distinct contiguous amino sequences of any one of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOS: 11,039-11,058 and 11,293.
- a single polypeptide may comprise 2, 3, 4, or even 5 distinct coding regions.
- a polypeptide may comprise at least a first coding region that comprises a first contiguous amino acid sequence of any one of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,039-11,058, and 11,293, and at least a second coding region that comprises a second contiguous amino acid sequence of any one of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs: 11,039-11,058, and 11,293.
- a polypeptide may comprise at least a first coding region that comprises a first contiguous amino acid sequence of any one of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,039-11,058, and 11,293, and at least a second coding region that comprises a second distinctly different peptide or polypeptide, such as for example, an adjuvant or an immunostimulant peptide or polypeptide.
- the two coding regions may be separate on the same polypeptide, or the two coding regions may be operatively attached, each in the correct reading frame, such that a fusion polypeptide is produced, in which the first amino acid sequence of the first coding region is linked to the second amino acid sequence of the second coding region.
- sequence as disclosed in any of SEQ ID NO: 11,000 through SEQ ID NO: 11,004" means any sequence that is disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NO: 11,000, SEQ ID NO:l 1,001, SEQ ID NO:l 1,002, SEQ ID NO:11,003, or SEQ ID NO:11,004.
- sequence as disclosed in any of SEQ ID NOs:25 to 37 means any sequence that is disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NO:25, SEQ ID NO:26, SEQ ID NO:27, SEQ ID NO:28, SEQ ID NO:29, SEQ ID NO:30, SEQ ID NO:31, SEQ ID NO:32, SEQ ID NO:33, SEQ ID NO:34, SEQ ID NO:35, SEQ ED NO:36, or SEQ ID NO:37, and so forth.
- a phrase such as "at least a first sequence from any one of SEQ ID NO:55 to SEQ ID NO:62" is intended to refer to a first sequence that is disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NO:55, SEQ ID NO:56, SEQ ID NO:57, SEQ ID NO:58, SEQ ID NO:59, SEQ ID NO:60, SEQ ID NO.61, or SEQ ID NO:62.
- kits, and compositions of the present invention comprise in an overall and general sense at least one or more particular polynucleotides, polypeptides, and peptides that comprise one or more contiguous sequence regions from one or more of the nucleic acid sequences disclosed herein in SEQ ID NOs:l 1,000-11,038, and 11,291-11,292 or from one or more of the amino acid sequences encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or disclosed in any one of SEQ ID NOs:l 1,039-11,058, and 11,293, and that such peptide, polypeptide and polynucleotide compositions may be used in one or more of the particular methods and uses disclosed herein for the diagnosis, detection, prophylaxis, and therapy of one or more hematological cancers, and in particular, lymphomas of a variety of specific types.
- the peptide and polypeptide compositions may be used to generate a T cell or an immune response in an animal, and that such compositions may also be administered to an animal from which immunospecific antibodies and antigen binding fragments may be isolated or identified that specifically bind to such peptides or polypeptides.
- immunospecific antibodies and antigen binding fragments may be isolated or identified that specifically bind to such peptides or polypeptides.
- polynucleotides identified by the present disclosure may be used to produce such peptides, polypeptides, antibodies, and antigen binding fragments, by recombinant protein production methodologies that are also within the capability of the skilled artisan having benefit of the specific amino acid and nucleic acid sequences provided herein.
- one or more of the disclosed compositions may be used in one or more diagnostic or detection methodologies to identify certain antibodies, peptides, polynucleotides, or polypeptides in a biological sample, in a host cell, or even within the body or tissues of an animal.
- one or more of the disclosed nucleic acid or amino acid compositions may used in the preparation or manufacture of one or more medicaments for use in the diagnosis, detection, prognosis, prophylaxis, or therapy of one or more hematological malignancies in an animal, and particularly those malignant conditions disclosed and claimed herein.
- the methods, kits, and uses, of the present invention preferably employ one or more of the compounds and/or compositions disclosed herein that comprise one or more contiguous nucleotide sequences as may be presented in SEQ ED NOs:l 1,000-11,038, and 11,291-11,292, of the attached sequence listing.
- the methods, kits, and uses, of the present invention may also employ one or more of the compounds and compositions disclosed herein that comprise one or more contiguous amino acid sequences of any of the peptides encoded by any one of the above polynucleotides or presented in any one of SEQ ED NOs:ll,039-ll,058 of the attached sequence listing.
- FIG. 1 illustrates a schematic outline of the microarray chip technology approach used to identify the cDNA targets of the present invention as described Section 5.1.
- FIG. 2 illustrates a schematic outline of the general protocol for in vitro whole gene CD8 + T cell priming procedure used to generate antigen-specific lines and to identify clones of interest.
- FIG. 3 illustrates a schematic outline of the general protocol for in vitro whole gene CD4 + T cell priming procedure used to generate antigen-specific lines and to identify clones of interest.
- FIG. 4 illustrates the panel of probes used to identify cDNAs that are overexpressed in lymphoma cells.
- FIG. 5 illustrates the results of analyzing SEQ ED NO:9611 with the program TSITES.
- FIG. 6 illustrates the presence of Lyl448P-specific serum antibodies in lymphoma patients.
- FIG. 7 diagrammatically illustrates the 18 LY1448P exons present on chromosome 1 and the location of these exons in several splice variants.
- FIG. 8 depicts the Lyl448P splice forms and the exons used in each.
- FIG. 9 diagrammatically depicts the structure of each of the Lyl448P splice forms. 4. DESCRIPTION OF ILLUSTRATIVE EMBODIMENTS
- the present invention is generally directed to compositions and methods for the i munotherapy and diagnosis of Hematological malignancies, such as B cell leukemias and lymphomas and multiple myelomas.
- RNA or DNA and or substituted polynucleotide compositions disclosed herein will be used to transfect an appropriate host cell.
- Technology for introduction of RNAs and DNAs, and vectors comprising them into suitable host cells is well known to those of skill in the art.
- polynucleotides may be used to genetically transform one or more host cells, when therapeutic administration of one or more active peptides, compounds or vaccines is achieved through the expression of one or more polynucleotide constructs that encode one or more therapeutic compounds of interest.
- a bacterial cell, a yeast cell, or an animal cell transformed with one or more of the disclosed expression vectors represent an important aspect of the present invention.
- Such transformed host cells are often desirable for use in the expression of the various DNA gene constructs disclosed herein.
- Such methods are routine to those of skill in the molecular genetic arts.
- various manipulations may be employed for enhancing the expression of the messenger RNA, particularly by using an active promoter, and in particular, a tissue-specific promoter such as those disclosed herein, as well as by employing sequences, which enhance the stability of the messenger RNA in the particular transformed host cell.
- the initiation and translational termination region will involve stop codon(s), a terminator region, and optionally, a polyadenylation signal.
- the construct will involve the transcriptional regulatory region, if any, and the promoter, where the regulatory region may be either 5' or 3' of the promoter, the ribosomal binding site, the initiation codon, the structural gene having an open reading frame in phase with the initiation codon, the stop codon(s), the polyadenylation signal sequence, if any, and the terminator region.
- This sequence as a double strand may be used by itself for transformation of a microorganism or eukaryotic host, but will usually be included with a DNA sequence involving a marker, where the second DNA sequence may be joined to the expression construct during introduction of the DNA into the host.
- the construct will also preferably include a sequence of at least about 30 or about 40 or about 50 base pairs (bp) or so, preferably at least about 60, about 70, about 80, or about 90 to about 100 or so bp, and usually not more than about 500 to about 1000 or so bp of a sequence homologous with a sequence in the host, h this way, the probability of legitimate recombination is enhanced, so that the gene will be integrated into the host and stably maintained by the host.
- the regulatory regions of the expression construct will be in close proximity to (and also operably positioned relative to) the selected therapeutic gene providing for complementation as well as the gene providing for the competitive advantage. Therefore, in the event that the therapeutic gene is lost, the resulting organism will be likely to also lose the gene providing for the competitive advantage, so that it will be unable to compete in the environment with the gene retaining the intact construct.
- the selected therapeutic gene can be introduced between the transcriptional and translational initiation region and the transcriptional and translational termination region, so as to be under the regulatory control of the initiation region.
- This construct may be included in a plasmid, which will include at least one replication system, but may include more than one, where one replication system is employed for cloning during the development of the plasmid and the second replication system is necessary for functioning in the ultimate host, in this case, a mammalian host cell.
- one or more markers may be present, which have been described previously.
- the plasmid will desirably include a sequence homologous with the host genome.
- Genes or other nucleic acid segments, as disclosed herein, can be inserted into host cells using a variety of techniques that are well known in the art. Five general methods for delivering a nucleic segment into cells have been described: (1) chemical methods (Graham and Van Der Eb, 1973); (2) physical methods such as microinjection (Capecchi, 1980), electroporation (U. S. Patent 5,472,869; Wong and Neumann, 1982; Fromm et al, 1985), microprojectiles bombardment (U. S.
- Patent 5,874,265 specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety
- "gene gun” Yang et al, 1990
- viral vectors Eglitis and Anderson, 1988
- receptor-mediated mechanisms Curiel et al, 1991; Wagner et al, 1992
- bacterial- mediated transformation (5) bacterial- mediated transformation.
- the present invention further provides antibodies and antigen-binding fragments thereof, that specifically bind to (or are immunospecific for) at least a first peptide or peptide variant as disclosed herein.
- an antibody or an antigen-binding fragment is said to "specifically bind" to a peptide if it reacts at a detectable level (within, for example, an ELISA) with the peptide, and does not react detectably with unrelated peptides or proteins under similar conditions.
- binding refers to a non-covalent association between two separate molecules such that a "complex" is formed.
- the ability to bind may be evaluated by, for example, determining a binding constant for the formation of the complex.
- the binding constant is the value obtained when the concentration of the complex is divided by the product of the component concentrations.
- two compounds are said to "bind” when the binding constant for complex formation exceeds about 10 3 L/mol.
- the binding constant maybe determined using methods well known in the art.
- a binding agent is an antibody or an antigen-binding fragment thereof.
- Such antibodies may be prepared by any of a variety of techniques known to those of ordinary skill in the art (Harlow and Lane, 1988). In general, antibodies can be produced by cell culture techniques, including the generation of monoclonal antibodies as described herein, or via transfection of antibody genes into suitable bacterial or mammalian cell hosts, in order to allow for the production of recombinant antibodies. In one technique, an immunogen comprising the peptide is initially injected into any of a wide variety of mammals (e.g., mice, rats, rabbits, sheep or goats).
- the peptides of this invention may serve as the immunogen without modification.
- a superior immune response may be elicited if the peptide is joined to a carrier protein, such as bovine serum albumin or keyhole limpet hemocyanin.
- the immunogen is injected into the animal host, preferably according to a predetermined schedule incorporating one or more booster immunizations, and the animals are bled periodically.
- Polyclonal antibodies specific for the peptide may then be purified from such antisera by, for example, affinity chromatography using the peptide coupled to a suitable solid support.
- Monoclonal antibodies specific for the antigenic peptide of interest may be prepared, for example, using the technique of Kohler and Milstein (1976) and improvements thereto. Briefly, these methods involve the preparation of immortal cell lines capable of producing antibodies having the desired specificity (i.e., reactivity with the peptide of interest). Such cell lines may be produced, for example, from spleen cells obtained from an animal immunized as described above. The spleen cells are then immortalized by, for example, fusion with a myeloma cell fusion partner, preferably one that is syngeneic with the immunized animal. A variety of fusion techniques may be employed.
- the spleen cells and myeloma cells may be combined with a nonionic detergent for a few minutes and then plated at low density on a selective medium that supports the growth of hybrid cells, but not myeloma cells.
- a preferred selection technique uses HAT (hypoxanthine, aminopterin, thymidine) selection. After a sufficient time, usually about 1 to 2 weeks, colonies of hybrids are observed. Single colonies are selected and their culture supernatants tested for binding activity against the peptide. Hybridomas having high reactivity and specificity are preferred.
- Monoclonal antibodies may be isolated from the supernatants of growing hybridoma colonies.
- various techniques may be employed to enhance the yield, such as injection of the hybridoma cell line into the peritoneal cavity of a suitable vertebrate host, such as a mouse.
- Monoclonal antibodies may then be harvested from the ascites fluid or the blood.
- Contaminants may be removed from the antibodies by conventional techniques, such as chromatography, gel filtration, precipitation, and extraction.
- the peptides of this invention may be used in the purification process in, for example, an affinity chromatography step.
- the use of antigen-binding fragments of antibodies may be preferred. Such fragments include Fab fragments, which may be prepared using standard techniques.
- immunoglobulins may be purified from rabbit serum by affinity chromatography on Protein A bead columns (Harlow and Lane, 1988) and digested by papain to yield Fab and Fc fragments.
- the Fab and Fc fragments may be separated by affinity chromatography on Protein A bead columns.
- Monoclonal antibodies and fragments thereof may be coupled to one or more therapeutic agents.
- Suitable agents in this regard include radioactive tracers and chemotherapeutic agents, which may be used, for example, to purge autologous bone marrow in vitro).
- Representative therapeutic agents include radionuclides, differentiation inducers,
- radionuclides include Y, I, I, I,
- Preferred drugs include methotrexate, and pyrimidine and purine analogs.
- Preferred differentiation inducers include phorbol esters and butyric acid.
- Preferred toxins include ricin, abrin, diptheria toxin, cholera toxin, gelonin, Pseudomonas exotoxin, Shigella toxin, and pokeweed antiviral protein.
- coupling of radioactive agents may be used to facilitate tracing of metastases or to determine the location of hematological malignancy related-positive tumors.
- a therapeutic agent may be coupled (e.g., covalently bonded) to a suitable monoclonal antibody either directly or indirectly (e.g., via a linker group).
- a direct reaction between an agent and an antibody is possible when each possesses a substituent capable of reacting with the other.
- a nucleophilic group such as an amino or sulfhydryl group
- a carbonyl-containing group such as an anhydride or an acid halide
- an alkyl group containing a good leaving group e.g., a halide
- a linker group can function as a spacer to distance an antibody from an agent in order to avoid interference with binding capabilities.
- a linker group can also serve to increase the chemical reactivity of a substituent on an agent or an antibody, and thus increase the coupling efficiency. An increase in chemical reactivity may also facilitate the use of agents, or functional groups on agents, which otherwise would not be possible.
- a linker group that is cleavable during or upon internalization into a cell.
- a number of different cleavable linker groups have been described.
- the mechanisms for the intracellular release of an agent from these linker groups include cleavage by reduction of a disulfide bond (U. S. Patent No. 4,489,710), by irradiation of a photolabile bond (U. S. Patent No. 4,625,014), by hydrolysis of derivatized amino acid side chains (U. S. Patent No. 4,638,045), by serum complement-mediated hydrolysis (U. S. Patent No. 4,671,958), and acid-catalyzed hydrolysis (U. S. Patent No. 4,569,789).
- immunoconjugates with more than one agent may be prepared in a variety of ways.
- more than one agent may be coupled directly to an antibody molecule, or linkers that provide multiple sites for attachment can be used.
- a carrier can be used.
- a carrier may bear the agents in a variety of ways, including covalent bonding either directly or via a linker group. Suitable carriers include proteins such as albumins (U. S. Patent No. 4,507,234), peptides and polysaccharides such as aminodextran (U. S. Patent No.
- a carrier may also bear an agent by noncovalent bonding or by encapsulation, such as within a liposome vesicle (U. S. Patent No. 4,429,008 and U. S. Patent No. 4,873,088).
- Cairiers specific for radionuclide agents include radiohalogenated small molecules and chelating compounds.
- U. S. Patent No. 4,735,792 discloses representative radiohalogenated small molecules and their synthesis.
- a radionuclide chelate may be formed from chelating compounds that include those containing nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the donor atoms for binding the metal, or metal oxide, radionuclide. For example,
- a variety of routes of administration for the antibodies and immunoconjugates may be used. Typically, administration will be intravenous, intramuscular, subcutaneous or in the bed of a resected tumor. It will be evident that the precise dose of the antibody/ immunoconjugate will vary depending upon the antibody used, the antigen density on the tumor, and the rate of clearance of the antibody. Also provided herein are anti-idiotypic antibodies that mimic an immunogenic portion of hematological malignancy related. Such antibodies may be raised against an antibody, or an antigen-binding fragment thereof, that specifically binds to an immunogenic portion of hematological malignancy related, using well-known techniques.
- Anti-idiotypic antibodies that mimic an immunogenic portion of hematological malignancy related are those antibodies that bind to an antibody, or antigen-binding fragment thereof, that specifically binds to an immunogenic portion of hematological malignancy related, as described herein.
- the intact antibody, antibody multimers, or any one of a variety of functional, antigen-binding regions of the antibody may be used in the present invention.
- exemplary functional regions include scFv, Fv, Fab', Fab and F(ab') 2 fragments of the hematological malignancy related peptide-specific antibodies.
- Techniques for preparing such constructs are well known to those in the art and are further exemplified herein.
- the choice of antibody construct may be influenced by various factors. For example, prolonged half-life can result from the active readsorption of intact antibodies within the kidney, a property of the Fc piece of immunoglobulin.
- IgG based antibodies therefore, are expected to exhibit slower blood clearance than their Fab' counterparts.
- Fab' fragment-based compositions will generally exhibit better tissue penetrating capability.
- Antibody fragments can be obtained by proteolysis of the whole immunoglobulin by the non-specific thiol protease, papain. Papain digestion yields two identical antigen-binding fragments, termed "Fab fragments," each with a single antigen-binding site, and a residual "Fc fragment.”
- Papain should first be activated by reducing the sulfhydryl group in the active site with cysteine, 2-mercaptoethanol or dithiothreitol. Heavy metals in the stock enzyme should be removed by chelation with EDTA (2 mM) to ensure maximum enzyme activity. Enzyme and substrate are normally mixed together in the ratio of 1:100 by weight. After incubation, the reaction can be stopped by irreversible alkylation of the thiol group with iodoacetamide or simply by dialysis. The completeness of the digestion should be monitored by SDS-PAGE and the various fractions separated by Protein A-Sepharose or ion exchange chromatography.
- Pepsin treatment of intact antibodies yields an F(ab') 2 fragment that has two antigen- combining sites and is still capable of cross-linking antigen.
- Digestion of rat IgG by pepsin requires conditions including dialysis in 0.1 M acetate buffer, pH 4.5, and then incubation for four hrs with 1% wt./wt. pepsin; IgGi and IgG a digestion is improved if first dialyzed against 0.1 M formate buffer, pH 2.8, at 4°C, for 16 hrs followed by acetate buffer.
- IgG 2b gives more consistent results with incubation in staphylococcal N8 protease (3% wt./wt.) in 0.1 M sodium phosphate buffer, pH 7.8, for four hrs at 37°C.
- a Fab fragment also contains the constant domain of the light chain and the first constant domain (CHI) of the heavy chain.
- Fab' fragments differ from Fab fragments by the addition of a few residues at the carboxyl terminus of the heavy chain CHI domain including one or more cysteine(s) from the antibody binge region.
- F(ab') 2 antibody fragments were originally produced as pairs of Fab' fragments that have hinge cysteines between them. Other chemical couplings of antibody fragments are also known.
- variable means that certain portions of the variable domains differ extensively in sequence among antibodies, and are used in the binding and specificity of each particular antibody to its particular antigen. However, the variability is not evenly distributed throughout the variable domains of antibodies. It is concentrated in three segments termed “hypervariable regions,” both in the light chain and the heavy chain variable domains.
- variable domains The more highly conserved portions of variable domains are called the framework region (FR).
- the variable domains of native heavy and light chains each comprise four FRs
- FR1, FR2, FR3 and FR4, respectively largely adopting a ⁇ -sheet configuration, connected by three hypervariable regions, which form loops connecting, and in some cases, forming part of, the ⁇ -sheet structure.
- the hypervariable regions in each chain are held together in close proximity by the FRs and, with the hypervariable regions from the other chain, contribute to the formation of the antigen-binding site of antibodies (Kabat et al, 1991, specifically incorporated herein by reference).
- the constant domains are not involved directly in binding an antibody to an antigen, but exhibit various effector functions, such as participation of the antibody in antibody- dependent cellular toxicity.
- hypervariable region refers to the amino acid residues of an antibody that are responsible for antigen-binding.
- the hypervariable region comprises amino acid residues from a “complementarity dete ⁇ nining region” or "CDR" (i.e.
- "Framework" or "FR" residues are those variable domain residues other than the hypervariable region residues as herein defined.
- an "Fv” fragment is the minimum antibody fragment that contains a complete antigen- recognition and binding site. This region consists of a dimer of one heavy chain and one light chain variable domain in tight, con-covalent association. It is in this configuration that three hypervariable regions of each variable domain interact to define an antigen-binding site on the surface of the NH-N L dimer. Collectively, six hypervariable regions confer antigen-binding specificity to the antibody. However, even a single variable domain (or half of an Fv comprising only three hypervariable regions specific for an antigen) has the ability to recognize and bind antigen, although at a lower affinity than the entire binding site.
- Single-chain Fv or “sFv” antibody fragments comprise the V H and V L domains of antibody, wherein these domains are present in a single polypeptide chain.
- the Fv polypeptide further comprises a polypeptide linker between the V H and V L domains that enables the sFv to form the desired structure for antigen binding.
- Diabodies are small antibody fragments with two antigen-binding sites, which fragments comprise a heavy chain variable domain (V H ) connected to a light chain variable domain (N L ) in the same polypeptide chain (N H - V L )- By using a linker that is too short to allow pairing between the two domains on the same chain, the domains are forced to pair with the complementary domains of another chain and create two antigen-binding sites.
- V H heavy chain variable domain
- N L light chain variable domain
- Diabodies are described in European Pat. Appl. No. EP 404,097 and fritl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 93/11161,' each specifically incorporated herein by reference.
- Linear antibodies which can be bispecific or monospecific, comprise a pair of tandem Fd segments (VH-C H 1-V H -C H 1) that form a pair of antigen binding regions, as described in Zapata et al. (1995), specifically incorporated herein by reference.
- Other types of variants are antibodies with improved biological properties relative to the parent antibody from which they are generated.
- Such variants, or second-generation compounds are typically substitutional variants involving one or more substituted hypervariable region residues of a parent antibody.
- a convenient way for generating such substitutional variants is affinity maturation using phage display.
- hypervariable region sites e.g., 6 to 7 sites
- the antibody variants thus generated are displayed in a monovalent fashion from filamentous phage particles as fusions to the gene HI product of Ml 3 packaged within each particle.
- the phage-displayed variants are then screened for their biological activity (e.g., binding affinity) as herein disclosed, h order to identify candidate hypervariable region sites for modification, alanine-scanning mutagenesis can be performed on hypervariable region residues identified as contributing significantly to antigen binding.
- the crystal structure of the antigen-antibody complex be delineated and analyzed to identify contact points between the antibody and target. Such contact residues and neighboring residues are candidates for substitution.
- the panel of variants is subjected to screening, and antibodies with analogues but different or even superior properties in one or more relevant assays are selected for further development.
- Fab' or antigen binding fragment of an antibody with the attendant benefits on tissue penetration, one may derive additional advantages from modifying the fragment to increase its half-life.
- a variety of techniques may be employed, such as manipulation or modification of the antibody molecule itself, and also conjugation to inert carriers.
- Modifications other than conjugation are therefore based upon modifying the structure of the antibody fragment to render it more stable, and/or to reduce the rate of catabolism in the body.
- One mechanism for such modifications is the use of D-amino acids in place of L-amino acids.
- D-amino acids in place of L-amino acids.
- stabilizing modifications include the use of the addition of stabilizing moieties to either the N-terminal or the C-terminal, or both, which is generally used to prolong the half-life of biological molecules. By way of example only, one may wish to modify the termini by acylation or amination.
- Moderate conjugation-type modifications for use with the present invention include incorporating a salvage receptor binding epitope into the antibody fragment. Techniques for achieving this include mutation of the appropriate region of the antibody fragment or incorporating the epitope as a peptide tag that is attached to the antibody fragment. Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 96/32478 is specifically incorporated herein by reference for the purposes of further exemplifying such technology.
- Salvage receptor binding epitopes are typically regions of three or more amino acids from one or two lops of the Fc domain that are transfe ⁇ ed to the analogous position on the antibody fragment.
- the salvage receptor-binding epitopes disclosed in Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 98/45331 are incorporated herein by reference for use with the present invention.
- Immunotherapeutic compositions may also, or alternatively, comprise T cells specific for hematological malignancy related.
- T cells may generally be prepared in vitro or ex vivo, using standard procedures.
- T cells may be present within (or isolated from) bone marrow, peripheral blood or a fraction of bone ma ⁇ ow or peripheral blood of a mammal, such as a patient, using a commercially available cell separation system, such as the IsolexTM System, available from Nexell Therapeutics, Inc. (Irvine, CA; see also U. S. Patent No. 5,240,856; U. S. Patent No. 5,215,926; Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 89/06280; Ml. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 91/16116 and Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 92/07243).
- T cells may be derived from related or unrelated humans, non-human mammals, cell lines or cultures.
- T cells may be stimulated with hematological malignancy related peptide, polynucleotide encoding a hematological malignancy related peptide and/or an antigen- presenting cell (APC) that expresses a hematological malignancy related peptide.
- APC antigen- presenting cell
- Such stimulation is performed under conditions and for a time sufficient to permit the generation of T cells that are specific for the hematological malignancy related peptide.
- a hematological malignancy related peptide or polynucleotide is present within a delivery vehicle, such as a microsphere, to facilitate the generation of antigen-specific T cells.
- T cells which may be isolated from a patient or a related or unrelated donor by routine techniques (such as by Ficoll/Hypaque® density gradient centrifugation of peripheral blood lymphocytes), are incubated with hematological malignancy related peptide.
- T cells may be incubated in vitro for 2-9 days (typically 4 days) at 37°C with hematological malignancy related peptide (e.g., 5 to 25 ⁇ g/ml) or cells synthesizing a comparable amount of hematological malignancy related peptide. It may be desirable to incubate a separate aliquot of a T cell sample in the absence of hematological malignancy related peptide to serve as a control.
- T cells are considered to be specific for a hematological malignancy related peptide if the T cells kill target cells coated with a hematological malignancy related peptide or expressing a gene encoding such a peptide.
- T cell specificity may be evaluated using any of a variety of standard techniques. For example, within a chromium release assay or proliferation assay, a stimulation index of more than two fold increase in lysis and/or proliferation, compared to negative controls, indicates T cell specificity. Such assays may be performed, for example, as described in Chen et al. (1994). Alternatively, detection of the proliferation of T cells may be accomplished by a variety of known techniques.
- T cell proliferation can be detected by measuring an increased rate of DNA synthesis (e.g., by pulse-labeling cultures of T cells with tritiated thymidine and measuring the amount of tritiated thymidine incorporated into DNA).
- Other ways to detect T cell proliferation include measuring increases in interleukin-2 (IL-2) production, Ca 2+ flux, or dye uptake, such as 3-(4,5-dimethylthiazol-2-yl)-2,5-diphenyl-tetrazolium.
- synthesis of lymphokines (such as interferon-gamma) can be measured or the relative number of T cells that can respond to a hematological malignancy related peptide may be quantified.
- hematological malignancy related peptide 200 ng/ml - 100 ⁇ g/ml, preferably 100 ng/ml - 25 ⁇ g/ml
- contact with a hematological malignancy related peptide for 3-7 days should result in at least a two-fold increase in proliferation of the T cells and/or contact as described above for 2-3 hrs should result in activation of the T cells, as measured using standard cytokine assays in which a twofold increase in the level of cytokine release (e.g., TNF or EFN- ⁇ ) is indicative of T cell activation (Coligan et al, 1998).
- hematological malignancy related specific T cells may be expanded using standard techniques.
- the T cells are derived from a patient or a related or unrelated donor and are administered to the patient following stimulation and expansion.
- T cells that have been activated in response to a hematological malignancy related peptide, polynucleotide or hematological malignancy related-expressing APC may be CD4 + and/or CD8 + .
- Specific activation of CD4 + or CD8 + T cells may be detected in a variety of ways. Methods for detecting specific T cell activation include detecting the proliferation of T cells, the production of cytokines (e.g., lymphokines), or the generation of cytolytic activity (i.e., generation of cytotoxic T cells specific for hematological malignancy related).
- cytokines e.g., lymphokines
- cytolytic activity i.e., generation of cytotoxic T cells specific for hematological malignancy related
- a preferred method for detecting specific T cell activation is the detection of the proliferation of T cells.
- a prefe ⁇ ed method for detecting specific T cell activation is the detection of the generation of cytolytic activity.
- CD4 + or CD8 + T cells that proliferate in response to the hematological malignancy related peptide, polynucleotide or APC can be expanded in number either in vitro or in vivo. Proliferation of such T cells in vitro may be accomplished in a variety of ways.
- the T cells can be re-exposed to hematological malignancy related peptide, with or without the addition of T cell growth factors, such as interleukin-2, and/or stimulator cells that synthesize a hematological malignancy related peptide. The addition of stimulator cells is prefe ⁇ ed where generating CD8 + T cell responses.
- T cells can be grown to large numbers in vitro with retention of specificity in response to intermittent restimulation with hematological malignancy related peptide.
- IVS primary in vitro stimulation
- large numbers of lymphocytes e.g., greater than 4 x l0 7
- hematological malignancy related peptide e.g., peptide at 10 ⁇ g/ml
- tetanus toxoid e.g., 5 ⁇ g/ml
- the flasks may then be incubated (e.g., 37°C for 7 days).
- T cells are then harvested and placed in new flasks with 2-3 x 10 7 i ⁇ adiated peripheral blood mononuclear cells, hematological malignancy related peptide (e.g., 10 ⁇ g/ml) is added directly.
- the flasks are incubated at 37°C for 7 days.
- 2-5 units of interleukin-2 (IL-2) may be added.
- the T cells may be placed in wells and stimulated with the individual's own EBV transformed B cells coated with the peptide.
- IL-2 may be added on days 2 and 4 of each cycle. As soon as the cells are shown to be specific cytotoxic T cells, they may be expanded using a 10-day stimulation cycle with higher IL-2 (20 units) on days 2, 4 and 6.
- one or more T cells that proliferate in the presence of hematological malignancy related peptide can be expanded in number by cloning.
- Methods for cloning cells are well known in the art, and include limiting dilution.
- Responder T cells may be purified from the peripheral blood of sensitized patients by density gradient centrifugation and sheep red cell rosetting and established in culture by stimulating with the nominal antigen in the presence of irradiated autologous filler cells.
- hematological malignancy related peptide is used as the antigenic stimulus and autologous peripheral blood lymphocytes (PBL) or lymphoblastoid cell lines (LCL) immortalized by infection with Epstein Ban virus are used as antigen-presenting cells.
- PBL peripheral blood lymphocytes
- LCL lymphoblastoid cell lines
- autologous antigen-presenting cells transfected with an expression vector that produces hematological malignancy related peptide may be used as stimulator cells.
- Established T cell lines may be cloned 2-4 days following antigen stimulation by plating stimulated T cells at a frequency of 0.5 cells per well in 96-well flat- bottom plates with 1 x 10 6 rrradiated PBL or LCL cells and recombinant interleukin-2 (rIL2) (50 U/ml).
- Wells with established clonal growth may be identified at approximately 2-3 weeks after initial plating and restimulated with appropriate antigen in the presence of autologous antigen-presenting cells, then subsequently expanded by the addition of low doses of rIL2 (10 U/ml) 2-3 days following antigen stimulation.
- T cell clones may be maintained in 24-well plates by periodic restimulation with antigen and rIL2 approximately every two weeks. Cloned and/or expanded cells may be administered back to the patient as described, for example, by Chang et al. , (1996).
- allogeneic T-cells may be primed (i.e., sensitized to hematological malignancy related) in vivo and/or in vitro.
- Such priming may be achieved by contacting T cells with a hematological malignancy related peptide, a polynucleotide encoding such a peptide or a cell producing such a peptide under conditions and for a time sufficient to permit the priming of T cells.
- T cells are considered to be primed if, for example, contact with a hematological malignancy related peptide results in proliferation and/or activation of the T cells, as measured by standard proliferation, chromium release and/or cytokine release assays as described herein.
- a stimulation index of more than two fold increase in proliferation or lysis, and more than three fold increase in the level of cytokine, compared to negative controls indicates T-cell specificity.
- Cells primed in vitro may be employed, for example, within bone marrow transplantation or as donor lymphocyte infusion.
- T cells specific for hematological malignancy related can kill cells that express hematological malignancy related protein.
- Introduction of genes encoding T-cell receptor (TCR) chains for hematological malignancy related are used as a means to quantitatively and qualitatively improve responses to hematological malignancy related bearing leukemia and cancer cells.
- Vaccines to increase the number of T cells that can react to hematological malignancy related positive cells are one method of targeting hematological malignancy related bearing cells.
- T cell therapy with T cells specific for hematological malignancy related is another method.
- An alternative method is to introduce the TCR chains specific for hematological malignancy related into T cells or other cells with lytic potential.
- the TCR alpha and beta chains are cloned out from a hematological malignancy related specific T cell line and used for adoptive T cell therapy, such as described in WO 96/30516, incorporated herein by reference.
- peptides, polynucleotides, antibodies and/or T cells may be incorporated into pharmaceutical compositions or immunogenic compositions (i.e., vaccines).
- a pharmaceutical composition may comprise an antigen-presenting cell (e.g., a dendritic cell) transfected with a hematological malignancy related polynucleotide such that the antigen-presenting cell expresses a hematological malignancy related peptide.
- Pharmaceutical compositions comprise one or more such compounds or cells and a physiologically acceptable carrier or excipient.
- Vaccines may comprise one or more such compounds or cells and an immunostimulant, such as an adjuvant or a liposome (into which the compound is incorporated).
- An immunostimulant may be any substance that enhances or potentiates an immune response (antibody- and/or cell-mediated) to an exogenous antigen.
- immunostimulants include adjuvants, biodegradable microspheres (e.g., polylactic galactide) and liposomes (into which the compound is incorporated) (U. S. Patent No. 4,235,877).
- Vaccine preparation is generally described in, for example, Powell and Newman (1995).
- Pharmaceutical compositions and vaccines within the scope of the present invention may also contain other compounds, which may be biologically active or inactive. For example, one or more immunogenic portions of other tumor antigens may be present, either incorporated into a fusion peptide or as a separate compound, within the composition or vaccine.
- compositions and vaccines are designed to elicit T cell responses specific for a hematological malignancy related peptide in a patient, such as a human.
- T cell responses may be favored through the use of relatively short peptides (e.g., comprising less than 23 consecutive amino acid residues of a native hematological malignancy related peptide, preferably 4-16 consecutive residues, more preferably 8-16 consecutive residues and still more preferably 8-10 consecutive residues).
- a vaccine may comprise an immunostimulant that preferentially enhances a T cell response.
- the immunostimulant may enhance the level of a T cell response to a hematological malignancy related peptide by an amount that is proportionally greater than the amount by which an antibody response is enhanced.
- an immunostimulant that preferentially enhances a T cell response may enhance a proliferative T cell response by at least two fold, a lytic response by at least 10%, and/or T cell activation by at least two fold compared to hematological malignancy related-negative control cell lines, while not detectably enhancing an antibody response.
- the amount by which a T cell or antibody response to a hematological malignancy related peptide is enhanced may generally be determined using any representative technique known in the art, such as the techniques provided herein.
- a pharmaceutical composition or vaccine may contain DNA encoding one or more of the peptides as described above, such that the peptide is generated in situ.
- the DNA may be present within any of a variety of delivery systems known to those of ordinary skill in the art, including nucleic acid expression systems, bacterial and viral expression systems and mammalian expression systems. Numerous gene delivery techniques are well known in the art (Rolland, 1998, and references cited therein).
- nucleic acid expression systems contain the necessary DNA, cDNA or RNA sequences for expression in the patient (such as a suitable promoter and terminating signal).
- Bacterial delivery systems involve the administration of a bacterium (such as Bac ⁇ llus-Calmette-Guerrin) that expresses an immunogenic portion of the peptide on its cell surface or secretes such an epitope.
- the DNA may be introduced using a viral expression system (e.g., vaccinia or other pox virus, retrovims, or adenovirus), which may involve the use of a non- pathogenic (defective), replication competent virus (Fisher-Hoch et al, 1989; Flexner et al, 1989; Flexner et al, 1990; U. S. Patent No. 4,603,112, U. S. Patent No. 4,769,330, U. S. Patent No. 5,017,487; Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 89/01973; U. S. Patent No. 4,777,127; Great Britain Patent No.
- a viral expression system e.g., vaccinia or other pox virus, retrovims, or adenovirus
- a viral expression system e.g., vaccinia or other pox virus, retrovims, or adenovirus
- a viral expression system e.g., vaccini
- a vaccine may comprise both a polynucleotide and a peptide component. Such vaccines may provide for an enhanced immune response.
- a pharmaceutical composition or vaccine may comprise an antigen- presenting cell that expresses a hematological malignancy related peptide.
- the antigen-presenting cell is preferably an autologous dendritic cell.
- Such cells may be prepared and transfected using standard techniques (Reeves et al, 1996; Turing et al, 1998; and Nair et al, 1998). Expression of a hematological malignancy related peptide on the surface of an antigen-presenting cell may be confirmed by in vitro stimulation and standard proliferation as well as chromium release assays, as described herein.
- a vaccine may contain phamiaceutically acceptable salts of the polynucleotides and peptides provided herein.
- Such salts may be prepared from pharmaceutically acceptable non-toxic bases, including organic bases (e.g., salts of primary, secondary and tertiary amines and basic amino acids) and inorganic bases (e.g., sodium, potassium, lithium, ammonium, calcium and magnesium salts).
- organic bases e.g., salts of primary, secondary and tertiary amines and basic amino acids
- inorganic bases e.g., sodium, potassium, lithium, ammonium, calcium and magnesium salts.
- pharmaceutically or pharmacologically acceptable refer to molecular entities and compositions that do not produce an adverse, allergic or other significant untoward reaction when administered to an animal, or a human, as appropriate.
- pharmaceutically acceptable carrier includes any and all solvents, dispersion media, coatings, antibacterial and antifungal agents, isotonic and absorption delaying agents and the like.
- the use of such media and agents for pharmaceutical active substances is well known in the art. Except insofar as any conventional media or agent is incompatible with the active ingredient, its use in the therapeutic compositions is contemplated.
- preparations should meet sterility, pyrogenicity, and general safety and purity standards as required by the Food and Drug Administration Office of Biologies standards.
- Supplementary active ingredients can also be incorporated into the compositions. While any suitable carrier known to those of ordinary skill in the art may be employed in the pharmaceutical compositions of this invention, the type of carrier will vary depending on the mode of administration.
- compositions of the present invention may be formulated for any appropriate manner of administration, including for example, topical, oral, nasal, intravenous, intracranial, intraperitoneal, subcutaneous or intramuscular administration.
- the carrier preferably comprises water, saline, alcohol, a fat, a wax or a buffer.
- any of the above carriers or a solid carrier such as mannitol, lactose, starch, magnesium stearate, sodium saccharine, talcum, cellulose, glucose, sucrose, and magnesium carbonate, may be employed.
- Biodegradable microspheres e.g., polylactate polyglycolate
- Suitable biodegradable microspheres are disclosed, for example, in U. S. Patent Nos. 4,897,268; 5,075,109; 5,928,647; 5,811,128; 5,820,883; 5,853,763; 5,814,344 and 5,942,252.
- formulation as a cream or lotion using well-known components, is prefe ⁇ ed.
- compositions may also comprise buffers (e.g., neutral buffered saline or phosphate buffered saline), carbohydrates (e.g., glucose, mannose, sucrose or dextrans), mannitol, proteins, peptides or amino acids such as glycine, antioxidants, bacteriostats, chelating agents such as EDTA or glutathione, adjuvants (e.g., aluminum hydroxide), solutes that render the formulation isotonic, hypotonic or weakly hypertonic with the blood of a recipient, suspending agents, thickening agents and/or preservatives.
- buffers e.g., neutral buffered saline or phosphate buffered saline
- carbohydrates e.g., glucose, mannose, sucrose or dextrans
- mannitol e.g., proteins, peptides or amino acids such as glycine, antioxidants, bacteriostats, chelating agents such as EDTA
- compositions of the present invention may be formulated as a lyophilizate, or formulated with one or more liposomes, microspheres, nanoparticles, or micronized delivery systems using well-known technology.
- immunostimulants such as adjuvants
- Most adjuvants contain a substance designed to protect the antigen from rapid catabolism, such as aluminum hydroxide or mineral oil, and a stimulator of immune responses, such as lipid A, Bortadella pertussis or Mycobacterium tuberculosis derived proteins.
- Suitable adjuvants are commercially available as, for example, alum-based adjuvants (e.g., Alhydrogel, Rehydragel, aluminum phosphate, Algammulin, aluminum hydroxide); oil based adjuvants (Freund's Incomplete Adjuvant and Complete Adjuvant (Difco Laboratories, Detroit, MI), Specol, R BI, TiterMax, Montanide ISA50 or Seppic MONTANIDE ISA 720); nonionic block copolymer-based adjuvants, cytokines (e.g., GM-CSF or Flat3-ligand); Merck Adjuvant 65 (Merck and Company, Inc., Rahway, NJ); AS-2 (SmithKline Beecham, Philadelphia, PA); salts of calcium, iron or zinc; an insoluble suspension of acylated tyrosine; acylated sugars; cationically or anionically derivatized polysaccharides; polyphosphazenes; biodegradable microspheres;
- Cytokines such as GM-CSF or interleukin-2, -7, or - 12, may also be used as adjuvants. Hemocyanins and hemoerythrins may also be used in the invention. The use of hemocyanin from keyhole limpet (KLH) is particularly prefe ⁇ ed, although other molluscan and arthropod hemocyanins and hemoerythrins may be employed. Various polysaccharide adjuvants may also be used. Polyamine varieties of polysaccharides are particularly prefe ⁇ ed, such as chitin and chitosan, including deacetylated chitin. A further prefe ⁇ ed group of adjuvants are the muramyl dipeptide (MDP,
- N-acetylmuramyl-L-alanyl-D-isoglutamine) group of bacterial peptidoglycans derivatives of muramyl dipeptide, such as the amino acid derivative threonyl-MDP, and the fatty acid derivative MTPPE, are also contemplated.
- U. S. Patent No. 4,950,645 describes a lipophilic disaccharide-tripeptide derivative of muramyl dipeptide that is proposed for use in artificial liposomes formed from phosphatidyl choline and phosphatidyl glycerol. It is said to be effective in activating human monocytes and destroying tumor cells, but is non-toxic in generally high doses.
- Patent No. 4,950,645, and Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 91/16347 are also proposed for use in achieving particular aspects of the present invention.
- BCG and BCG-cell wall skeleton may also be used as adjuvants in the invention, with or without trehalose dimycolate.
- Trehalose dimycolate may be used itself.
- Trehalose dimycolate may be prepared as described in U. S. Patent No. 4,579,945.
- Amphipathic and surface-active agents e.g., saponin and derivatives such as QS21
- Nonionic block copolymer surfactants Roshalose et al, 1994; Hunter et al, 1991
- Oligonucleotides as described by Yamamoto et al (1988) are another useful group of adjuvants.
- Quil A and lentinen are also prefe ⁇ ed adjuvants.
- Superantigens are also contemplated for use as adjuvants in the present invention.
- Superantigens are generally bacterial products that stimulate a greater proportion of T lymphocytes than peptide antigens without a requirement for antigen processing (Mooney et. al, 1994).
- Superantigens include Staphylococcus exoproteins, such as the ⁇ , ⁇ , ⁇ and ⁇ enterotoxins from S. aureus and S. epidermidis, and the ⁇ , ⁇ , ⁇ and ⁇ E. coli exotoxins.
- Staphylococcus enterotoxins are known as staphylococcal enterotoxin A
- SEA staphylococcal enterotoxin B
- SEB staphylococcal enterotoxin B
- SEB enterotoxins through E
- SEB Streptococcus pyogenes B
- SEB Clostridium perfringens enterotoxin
- CAP cytoplasmic membrane-associated protein
- One group of adjuvants particularly preferred for use in the invention are the detoxified endotoxins, such as the refined detoxified endotoxin of U. S. Patent No. 4,866,034. These refined detoxified endotoxins are effective in producing adjuvant responses in mammals.
- the detoxified endotoxins may be combined with other adjuvants.
- Combination of detoxified endotoxins with trehalose dimycolate is contemplated, as described in U. S. Patent No. 4,435,386.
- Combinations of detoxified endotoxins with trehalose dimycolate and endotoxic glycolipids is also contemplated (U. S. Patent No. 4,505,899), as is combination of detoxified endotoxins with cell wall skeleton (CWS) or CWS and trehalose dimycolate, as described in U. S. Patent Nos. 4,436,727, 4,436,728 and 4,505,900.
- Combinations of just CWS and trehalose dimycolate, without detoxified endotoxins are also envisioned to be useful, as described in U. S. Patent No. 4,520,019.
- MPL is cu ⁇ ently one prefe ⁇ ed immunopotentiating agent for use herein.
- References that concern the uses of MPL include Tomai et al. (1987), Chen et al. (1991) and Garg and Subbarao (1992), that each concern certain roles of MPL in the reactions of aging mice;
- Elliott et al. (1991) that concerns the D-galactosamine loaded mouse and its enhanced sensitivity to lipopolysaccharide and MPL
- Chase et al. (1986) that relates to bacterial infections;
- Masihi et al. (1988) that describes the effects of MPL and endotoxin on resistance of mice to Toxoplasma gondii.
- Fitzgerald (1991) also reported on the use of MPL to up-regulate the immunogenicty of a syphilis vaccine and to confer significant protection against challenge infection in rabbits.
- MPL is known to be safe for use, as shown in the above model systems.
- MPL generally induces polyclonal B cell activation (Baker et al, 1994), and has been shown to augment antibody production in many systems, for example, in immunologically immature mice (Baker et al, 1988); in aging mice (Tomai and Johnson, 1989); and in nude and Xid mice (Madonna and Vogel, 1986; Myers et al, 1995).
- Antibody production has been shown against erythrocytes (Hraba et al, 1993); T cell dependent and independent antigens; Pnu-immune vaccine (Garg and Subbarao, 1992); isolated tumor-associated antigens (U. S.
- Patent 4,877,611 against syngeneic tumor cells (Livingston et al, 1985; Ravindranath et al, 1994a;b); and against tumor-associated gangliosides (Ravindranath et al, 1994a;b).
- MPL Another useful attribute of MPL is that is augments IgM responses, as shown by Baker et al (1988a), who describe the ability of MPL to increase antibody responses in young mice. This is a particularly useful feature of an adjuvant for use in certain embodiments of the present invention.
- Myers et al. (1995) recently reported on the ability of MPL to induce IgM antibodies, by virtue T cell-independent antibody production.
- MPL was conjugated to the hapten, TNP.
- MPL was proposed for use as a carrier for other haptens, such as peptides.
- MPL also activates and recruits macrophages (Verma et al, 1992). Tomai and Johnson (1989) showed that MPL-stimulated T cells enhance IL-1 secretion by macrophages. MPL is also known to activate superoxide production, lysozyme activity, phagocytosis, and killing of Candida in murine peritoneal macrophages (Chen et al, 1991). The effects of MPL on T cells include the endogenous production of cytotoxic factors, such as TNF, in serum of BCG-primed mice by MPL (Bennett et al, 1988). Kovach et al. (1990) and Elliot et al. (1991) also show that MPL induces TNF activity. MPL is known to act with TNF- ⁇ to induce release of EFN- ⁇ by NK cells. IFN- ⁇ production by T cells in response to MPL was also documented by Tomai and Johnson (1989), and Odean et al. (1990).
- MPL is also known to be a potent T cell adjuvant.
- MPL stimulates proliferation of melanoma-antigen specific CTLs (Mitchell et al, 1988, 1993).
- Baker et al. (1988b) showed that nontoxic MPL inactivated suppressor T cell activity.
- the inactivation of T suppressor cells allows for increased benefit for the animal, as realized by, e.g., increased antibody production.
- Johnson and Tomai (1988) have reported on the possible cellular and molecular mediators of the adjuvant action of MPL.
- MPL is also known to induce aggregation of platelets and to phosphorylate a platelet protein prior to induction of serotonin secretion (Grabarek et al, 1990). This study shows that MPL is involved in protein kinase C activation and signal transduction.
- MPL structure and function of MPL
- Johnson et al. (1990) that describes the structural characterization of MPL homologs obtained from Salmonella minnesota Re595 lipopolysaccharide.
- Johnson et al. (1990) found that three were particularly active, as assessed using human platelet responses.
- the chemical components of the various MPL species were characterized by Johnson et al. (1990). Baker et al.
- lipid A preparations with fatty acyl groups of relatively short chain length (Cio to Q 2 from Pseudomonas aeruginosa and Chromobacterium violaceum) or predominantly long chain length ( 8 from Helicobacter pylori) are less prefe ⁇ ed for use in this invention.
- Baker et al. (1994) also showed that the lipid A proximal inner core region oligosaccharides of some bacterial lipopolysaccharides increase the expression of Ts activity; due mainly to the capacity of such oligosaccharides, which are relatively conserved in structure among gram-negative bacterial, to enlarge or expand upon the population of CD8 Ts generated during the course of a normal antibody response to unrelated microbial antigens.
- the minimal structure required for the expression of the added immunosuppression observed was reported to be a hexasacchari.de containing one 2-keto-3- deoxyoctonate residue, two glucose residues, and three heptose residues to which are attached two pyrophosphorylethanolamine groups (Baker et al, 1994). This information may be considered in utilizing or even designing further adjuvants for use in the invention.
- Tanamoto et al (1994a;b; 1995) described the dissociation of endotoxic activities in a chemically synthesized Lipid A precursor after acetylation or succinylation.
- compounds such as “acetyl 406" and “succinyl 516" are also contemplated for use in the invention.
- Synthetic MPLs form a particularly prefe ⁇ ed group of antigens.
- Brade et al. (1993) described an artificial glycoco ⁇ jugate containing the bisphosphorylated glucosamine disaccharide backbone of lipid A that binds to anti-Lipid A MAbs. This is one candidate for use in certain aspects of the invention.
- U. S. Patent No. 4,987,237 describes MPL derivatives that contain one or more free groups, such as amines, on a side chain attached to the primary hydroxyl groups of the monophosphoryl lipid A nucleus through an ester group.
- the derivatives provide a convenient method for coupling the lipid A through coupling agents to various biologically active materials.
- the immunostimulant properties of lipid A are maintained. All MPL derivatives in accordance with U. S. Patent No. 4,987,237 are envisioned for use in the MPL adjuvant-incorporated cells of this invention.
- the adjuvant composition is preferably designed to induce an immune response predominantly of the Thl type.
- Thl-type cytokines e.g., IFN- ⁇ , TNF , IL-2 and EL- 12
- Th2-type cytokines e.g., IL-4, IL-5, IL-6 and EL- 10.
- a patient will support an immune response that includes Thl- and Th2-type responses.
- Thl-type cytokines will increase to a greater extent than the level of Th2-type cytokines.
- the levels of these cytokines may be readily assessed using standard assays. For a review of the families of cytokines see e.g., Mosmann and Coffman (1989).
- Prefe ⁇ ed adjuvants for use in eliciting a predominantly Thl-type response include, for example, a combination of monophosphoryl lipid A, preferably 3-de-O-acylated monophosphoryl lipid A (3D-MPL), together with an aluminum salt.
- MPL adjuvants are available from Corixa Corporation (Seattle, WA; see e.g., U. S. Patent Nos. 4,436,727; 4,877,611; 4,866,034 and 4,912,094, each of which is specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety).
- CpG-containing oligonucleotides in which the CpG dinucleotide is unmethylated also induce a predominantly Thl response.
- oligonucleotides are well known and are described, for example, in Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 96/02555 and Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 99/33488. hnmunostimulatory DNA sequences are also described, for example, by Sato et al. (1996).
- Another prefe ⁇ ed adjuvant is a saponin, preferably QS21 (Aquila Biopharmaceuticals Inc., Framingham, MA), which may be used alone or in combination with other adjuvants.
- an enhanced system involves the combination of a monophosphoryl lipid A and saponin derivative, such as the combination of QS21 and 3D- MPL (see e.g., Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 94/00153), or a less reactogenic composition where the QS21 is quenched with cholesterol (see e.g., Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 96/33739).
- Other prefe ⁇ ed formulations comprise an oil-in-water emulsion and tocopherol.
- compositions described herein may be administered as part of a sustained release formulation (i.e., a formulation such as a capsule, sponge or gel [composed of polysaccharides, for example] that effects a slow release of compound following administration).
- a sustained release formulation i.e., a formulation such as a capsule, sponge or gel [composed of polysaccharides, for example] that effects a slow release of compound following administration.
- Such formulations may generally be prepared using well-known technology (Coombes et al, 1996) and administered by, for example, oral, rectal or subcutaneous implantation, or by implantation at the desired target site.
- Sustained-release formulations may contain a peptide, polynucleotide or antibody dispersed in a carrier matrix and/or contained within a reservoir s ⁇ ounded by a rate-controlling membrane.
- Carriers for use within such formulations are preferably biocompatible, and may also be biodegradable; preferably the formulation provides a relatively constant level of active component release.
- Such carriers include microparticles of poly(lactide-co-glycolide), as well as polyacrylate, latex, starch, cellulose and dextran.
- Other delayed-release carriers include supramolecular biovectors, which comprise a non-liquid hydrophilic core (e.g., a cross-linked polysaccharide or oligosaccharide) and, optionally, an external layer comprising an amphiphilic compound, such as a phospholipid (U. S. Patent No. 5,151,254; Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No.
- WO 94/20078 Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO/94/23701; and Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 96/06638).
- the amount of active compound contained within a sustained release formulation depends upon the site of implantation, the rate and expected duration of release and the nature of the condition to be treated or prevented.
- APCs antigen-presenting cells
- APCs include dendritic cells, macrophages, B cells, monocytes and other cells that may be engineered to be efficient APCs.
- APCs may, but need not, be genetically modified to increase the capacity for presenting the antigen, to improve activation and/or maintenance of the T cell response, to have anti-tumor effects per se and/or to be immunologically compatible with the receiver (i.e., matched HLA haplotype).
- APCs may generally be isolated from any of a variety of biological fluids and organs, including tumor and peritumoral tissues, and may be autologous, allogeneic, syngeneic or xenogeneic cells.
- Dendritic cells are highly potent APCs (Banchereau and Steinman, 1998) and have been shown to be effective as a physiological adjuvant for eliciting prophylactic or therapeutic antitumor immunity (Timmerman and Levy, 1999).
- dendritic cells may be identified based on their typical shape (stellate in situ, with marked cytoplasmic processes (dendrites) visible in vitro), their ability to take up, process and present antigens with high efficiency and their ability to activate naive T cell responses.
- Dendritic cells may, of course, be engineered to express specific cell- surface receptors or ligands that are not commonly found on dendritic cells in vivo or ex vivo, and such modified dendritic cells are contemplated by the present invention.
- secreted vesicles antigen-loaded dendritic cells termed exosomes
- Dendritic cells and progenitors may be obtained from peripheral blood, bone marrow, tumor-infiltrating cells, peritumoral tissues-infiltrating cells, lymph nodes, spleen, skin, umbilical cord blood or any other suitable tissue or fluid.
- dendritic cells may be differentiated ex vivo by adding a combination of cytokines such as GM-CSF, IL-4, EL- 13 and/or TNF ⁇ to cultures of monocytes harvested from peripheral blood.
- cytokines such as GM-CSF, IL-4, EL- 13 and/or TNF ⁇
- CD34 positive cells harvested from peripheral blood, umbilical cord blood or bone marrow may be differentiated into dendritic cells by adding to the culture medium combinations of GM-CSF, IL-3, TNF ⁇ , CD40 ligand, LPS, flt3 ligand and/or other com ⁇ ound(s) that induce differentiation, maturation and proliferation of dendritic cells.
- Dendritic cells are conveniently categorized as “immature” and “mature” cells, which allows a simple way to discriminate between two well characterized phenotypes. However, this nomenclature should not be construed to exclude all possible intermediate stages of differentiation. Immature dendritic cells are characterized as APC with a high capacity for antigen uptake and processing, which co ⁇ elates with the high expression of Fc ⁇ receptor and mannose receptor.
- the mature phenotype is typically characterized by a lower expression of these markers, but a high expression of cell surface molecules responsible for T cell activation such as class I and class II MHC, adhesion molecules (e.g., CD54 and CD11) and costimulatory molecules (e.g., CD40, CD80, CD86 and 4- IBB).
- cell surface molecules responsible for T cell activation such as class I and class II MHC, adhesion molecules (e.g., CD54 and CD11) and costimulatory molecules (e.g., CD40, CD80, CD86 and 4- IBB).
- APCs may generally be transfected with a polynucleotide encoding a hematological malignancy related peptide, such that the peptide, or an immunogenic portion thereof, is expressed on the cell surface. Such transfection may take place ex vivo, and a composition or vaccine comprising such transfected cells may then be used for therapeutic purposes, as described herein. Alternatively, a gene delivery vehicle that targets a dendritic or other antigen-presenting cell may be administered to a patient, resulting in transfection that occurs in vivo. In vivo and ex vivo transfection of dendritic cells, for example, may generally be performed using any methods known in the art, such as those described in Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No.
- Antigen loading of dendritic cells may be achieved by incubating dendritic cells or progenitor cells with the hematological malignancy related peptide, DNA (naked or within a plasmid vector) or RNA; or with antigen-expressing recombinant bacterium or viruses (e.g., vaccinia, fowlpox, adenovirus or lentivirus vectors). Prior to loading, the peptide may be covalently conjugated to an immuno logical partner that provides T cell help (e.g., a carrier molecule).
- an immuno logical partner that provides T cell help
- a dendritic cell may be pulsed with a non-conjugated immunological partner, separately or in the presence of the peptide.
- Combined therapeutics is also contemplated, and the same type of underlying pharmaceutical compositions may be employed for both single and combined medicaments.
- Vaccines and pharmaceutical compositions may be presented in unit-dose or multi-dose containers, such as sealed ampoules or vials. Such containers are preferably hermetically sealed to preserve sterility of the formulation until use.
- formulations may be stored as suspensions, solutions or emulsions in oily or aqueous vehicles.
- a vaccine or pharmaceutical composition may be stored in a freeze-dried condition requiring only the addition of a sterile liquid carrier immediately prior to use.
- the present invention further provides methods for detecting a malignant disease associated with one or more of the polypeptide or polynucleotide compositions disclosed herein, and for monitoring the effectiveness of an immunization or therapy for such a disease.
- a patient may be tested for the level of T cells specific for one or more of such compositions.
- a biological sample comprising CD4 + and/or CD8 + T cells isolated from a patient is incubated with one or more of the polypeptide or polynucleotide compositions disclosed herein, and/or an APC that expresses one or more of such peptides or polypeptides, and the presence or absence of specific activation of the T cells is detected, as described herein.
- Suitable biological samples include, but are not limited to, isolated T cells.
- T cells may be isolated from a patient by routine techniques (such as by Ficoll/Hypaque density gradient centrifugation of peripheral blood lymphocytes).
- T cells may be incubated in vitro for 2-9 days (typically 4 days) at 37°C with one or more of the disclosed peptide, polypeptide or polynucleotide compositions (e.g., 5-25 ⁇ g/ml). It may be desirable to incubate another aliquot of a T cell sample in the absence of the composition to serve as a control.
- activation is preferably detected by evaluating proliferation of the T cells.
- CD8 + T cells activation is preferably detected by evaluating cytolytic activity.
- a level of proliferation that is at least two fold greater and/or a level of cytolytic activity that is at least 20% greater than in disease-free patients indicates the presence of a malignant disease associated with expression or one or more of the disclosed polypeptide or polynucleotide compositions. Further co ⁇ elation may be made, using methods well known in the art, between the level of proliferation and/or cytolytic activity and the predicted response to therapy. In particular, patients that display a higher antibody, proliferative and/or lytic response may be expected to show a greater response to therapy.
- a biological sample obtained from a patient is tested for the level of antibody specific for one or more of the hematological malignancy-related peptides or polypeptide s disclosed herein.
- the biological sample is incubated with hematological malignancy-related peptide or polypeptide, or a polynucleotide encoding such a peptide or polypeptide, and/or an APC that expresses such a peptide or polypeptide under conditions and for a time sufficient to allow immunocomplexes to form. Immunocomplexes formed between the selected peptide or polypeptide and antibodies in the biological sample that specifically bind to the selected peptide or polypeptide are then detected.
- a biological sample for use within such methods may be any sample obtained from a patient that would be expected to contain antibodies. Suitable biological samples include blood, sera, ascites, bone marrow, pleural effusion, and cerebrospinal fluid.
- the biological sample is incubated with the selected peptide or polypeptide in a reaction mixture under conditions and for a time sufficient to permit immunocomplexes to form between the selected peptide or polypeptide and antibodies that are immunospecific for such a peptide or polypeptide.
- a biological sample and a selected peptide or polypeptide peptide may be incubated at 4°C for 24-48 hrs.
- Detection of immunocomplexes formed between the selected peptide or polypeptide and antibodies present in the biological sample may be accomplished by a variety of known techniques, such as radioimmunoassays (RIA) and enzyme linked immunosorbent assays (ELISA). Suitable assays are well known in the art and are amply described in the scientific and patent literature (Harlow and Lane, 1988). Assays that may be used include, but are not limited to, the double monoclonal antibody sandwich immunoassay technique (U. S. Patent No.
- the selected peptide or polypeptide may either be labeled or unlabeled.
- Unlabeled polypeptide peptide may be used in agglutination assays or in combination with labeled detection reagents that bind to the immunocomplexes (e.g., anti- immunoglobulin, protein G, Protein A or a lectin and secondary antibodies, or antigen- binding fragments thereof, capable of binding to the antibodies that specifically bind to the selected hematological malignancy-related peptide or polypeptide).
- the reporter group may be any suitable reporter group known in the art, including radioisotopes, fluorescent groups, luminescent groups, enzymes, biotin and dye particles.
- unlabeled peptide or polypeptide is immobilized on a solid support.
- the solid support may be any material known to those of ordinary skill in the art to which the peptide may be attached.
- the solid support may be a test well in a microtiter plate or a nitrocellulose or other suitable membrane.
- the support may be a bead or disc, such as glass, fiberglass, latex or a plastic material such as polystyrene or polyvinylchlori.de.
- the support may also be a magnetic particle or a fiber optic sensor, such as those disclosed, for example, in U. S. Patent No. 5,359,681.
- the peptide may be immobilized on the solid support using a variety of techniques known to those of skill in the art, which are amply described in the patent and scientific literature.
- immobilization refers to both noncovalent association, such as adsorption, and covalent attachment (which may be a direct linkage between the antigen and functional groups on the support or may be a linkage by way of a cross-linking agent). Immobilization by adsorption to a well in a microtiter plate or to a membrane is prefe ⁇ ed. In such cases, adsorption may be achieved by contacting the selected peptide or polypeptide, in a suitable buffer, with the solid support for a suitable amount of time.
- the contact time varies with temperature, but is typically between about 1 hour and about 1 day.
- contacting a well of a plastic microtiter plate (such as polystyrene or polyvinylchloride) with an amount of peptide ranging from about 10 ng to about 10 ⁇ g, and preferably about 100 ng to about 1 ⁇ g, is sufficient to immobilize an adequate amount of peptide.
- any suitable blocking agent known to those of ordinary skill in the art such as bovine serum albumin, TweenTM 20TM (Sigma Chemical Co., St. Louis, MO), heat- inactivated normal goat serum (NGS), or BLOTTO (buffered solution of nonfat dry milk which also contains a preservative, salts, and an antifoaming agent) may be used.
- the support is then incubated with a biological sample suspected of containing specific antibody.
- the sample can be applied neat, or, more often, it can be diluted, usually in a buffered solution which contains a small amount (0.1%>-5.0% > by weight) of protein, such as BSA,
- an appropriate contact time is a period of time that is sufficient to detect the presence of antibody or an antigen binding fragment that is immunospecific for the selected peptide or polypeptide within a sample containing such an antibody or binding fragment thereof.
- the contact time is sufficient to achieve a level of binding that is at least about 95% of that achieved at equilibrium between bound and unbound antibody or antibody fragment.
- the time necessary to achieve equilibrium may be readily determined by assaying the level of binding that occurs over a period of time. At room temperature, an incubation time of about 30 min is generally sufficient.
- Unbound sample may then be removed by washing the solid support with an appropriate buffer, such as PBS containing 0.1 %> TweenTM 20.
- a detection reagent that binds to the immunocomplexes and that comprises at least a first detectable label or "reporter” molecule may then be added.
- the detection reagent is incubated with the immunocomplex for an amount of time sufficient to detect the bound antibody or antigen binding fragment thereof.
- An appropriate amount of time may generally be determined by assaying the level of binding that occurs over a period of time.
- Unbound label or detection reagent is then removed and bound label or detection reagent is detected using a suitable assay or analytical instrument.
- the method employed for detecting the reporter group depends upon the nature of the reporter group.
- Radioactive labels scintillation counting or autoradiographic methods are generally appropriate.
- Spectroscopic methods may be used to detect dyes, luminescent or chemiluminescent moieties and various chromogens, fluorescent labels and such like.
- Biotin may be detected using avidin, coupled to a different reporter group (commonly a radioactive or fluorescent group or an enzyme).
- Enzyme reporter groups e.g., horseradish peroxidase, ⁇ -galactosidase, alkaline phosphatase and glucose oxidase
- substrate generally for a specific period of time
- a level of bound detection reagent that is at least two fold greater than background indicates the presence of a malignant disease associated with expression of the selected peptide or polypeptide.
- methods for monitoring the effectiveness of an immunization or therapy involve monitoring changes in the level of antibodies or T cells specific for the selected peptide or polypeptide in a sample, or in an animal such as a human patient.
- Methods in wliich antibody levels are monitored may comprise the steps of: (a) incubating a first biological sample, obtained from a patient prior to a therapy or immunization, with a selected peptide or polypeptide, wherein the incubation is performed under conditions and for a time sufficient to allow immunocomplexes to form; (b) detecting immunocomplexes formed between the selected peptide or polypeptide and antibodies or antigen binding fragments in the biological sample that specifically bind to the selected peptide or polypeptide; (c) repeating steps (a) and (b) using a second biological sample taken from the patient at later time, such as for example, following a given therapy or immunization; and (d) comparing the number of immunocomplexes detected in the first and second biological samples.
- a polynucleotide encoding the selected peptide or polypeptide, or an APC expressing the selected peptide or polypeptide may be employed in place of the selected peptide or polypeptide itself.
- immunocomplexes between the selected peptide or polypeptide encoded by a polynucleotide, or expressed by the APC, and antibodies and/or antigen binding fragments in the biological sample are detected.
- Methods in which T cell activation and/or the number of hematological malignancy polypeptide-specific precursors are monitored may comprise the steps of: (a) incubating a first biological sample comprising CD4 + and/or CD8 + cells (e.g., bone ma ⁇ ow, peripheral blood or a fraction thereof), obtained from a patient prior to a therapy or immunization, with a hematological malignancy peptide or polypeptide, wherein the incubation is performed under conditions and for a time sufficient to allow specific activation, proliferation and/or lysis of T cells; (b) detecting an amount of activation, proliferation and/or lysis of the T cells;
- a first biological sample comprising CD4 + and/or CD8 + cells (e.g., bone ma ⁇ ow, peripheral blood or a fraction thereof), obtained from a patient prior to a therapy or immunization, with a hematological malignancy peptide or polypeptide, wherein the incubation is performed under conditions and for a time sufficient
- a biological sample for use within such methods may be any sample obtained from a patient that would be expected to contain antibodies, CD4 + T cells and/or CD8 + T cells. Suitable biological samples include blood, sera, ascites, bone marrow, pleural effusion and cerebrospinal fluid.
- a first biological sample may be obtained prior to initiation of therapy or immunization or part way through a therapy or vaccination regime.
- the second biological sample should be obtained in a similar manner, but at a time following additional therapy or immunization.
- the second biological sample may be obtained at the completion of, or part way through, therapy or immunization, provided that at least a portion of therapy or immunization takes place between the isolation of the first and second biological samples.
- the present invention concerns formulation of one or more of the polynucleotide, polypeptide, peptide, antibody, or antigen binding fragment compositions disclosed herein in pharmaceutically acceptable solutions for administration to a cell or an animal, either alone, or in combination with one or more other modalities of anti-cancer therapy, or in combination with one or more diagnostic or therapeutic agents.
- the nucleic acid segment, RNA, or DNA compositions disclosed herein may be administered in combination with other agents as well, such as, e.g., proteins or peptides or various pharmaceutically-active agents.
- agents such as, e.g., proteins or peptides or various pharmaceutically-active agents.
- the composition comprises at least one of the genetic expression constructs disclosed herein, there is virtually no limit to other components that may also be included, given that the additional agents do not cause a significant adverse effect upon contact with the target cells or host tissues.
- the RNA- or DNA-derived compositions may thus be delivered along with various other agents as required in the particular instance.
- Such RNA or DNA compositions may be purified from host cells or other biological sources, or alternatively may be chemically synthesized as described herein.
- compositions may comprise substituted or derivatized RNA or DNA compositions.
- Such compositions may include one or more therapeutic gene constructs, either alone, or in combination with one or more modified peptide or nucleic acid substituent derivatives, and/or other anticancer therapeutics.
- compositions described herein are well-known to those of skill in the art, as is the development of suitable dosing and treatment regimens for using the particular compositions described herein in a variety of treatment regimens, including e.g., oral, intravenous, intranasal, transdermal, intraprostatic, intratumoral, and/or intramuscular administration and formulation.
- compositions disclosed herein may be administered parenterally, intravenously, intramuscularly, or even intraperitoneally as described in U. S. Patent 5,543,158, U. S. Patent 5,641,515 and U. S. Patent 5,399,363 (each specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety).
- Solutions of the active compounds as free-base or pharmacologically acceptable salts may be prepared in water suitably mixed with a surfactant, such as hydroxypropylcellulose.
- Dispersions may also be prepared in glycerol, liquid polyethylene glycols, and mixtures thereof and in oils. Under ordinary conditions of storage and use, these preparations contain a preservative to prevent the growth of microorganisms.
- the pharmaceutical forms suitable for injectable use include sterile aqueous solutions or dispersions and sterile powders for the extemporaneous preparation of sterile injectable solutions or dispersions (U. S. Patent 5,466,468, specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety), h all cases the form must be sterile and must be fluid to the extent that easy syringability exists. It must be stable under the conditions of manufacture and storage and must be preserved against the contaminating action of microorganisms, such as bacteria and fungi.
- the carrier can be a solvent or dispersion medium containing, for example, water, ethanol, polyol (e.g., glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like), suitable mixtures thereof, and/or vegetable oils.
- polyol e.g., glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like
- suitable mixtures thereof e.g., vegetable oils
- vegetable oils e.g., glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like
- suitable mixtures thereof e.g., glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like
- vegetable oils e.g., glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like
- Proper fluidity may be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating, such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion
- isotonic agents for example, sugars or sodium chloride.
- Prolonged absorption of the injectable compositions can be brought about by the use in the compositions of agents delaying absorption, for example, aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
- aqueous solutions For parenteral administration in an aqueous solution, for example, the solution should be suitably buffered if necessary and the liquid diluent first rendered isotonic with sufficient saline or glucose.
- aqueous solutions are especially suitable for intravenous, intramuscular, subcutaneous and intraperitoneal administration.
- sterile aqueous media that can be employed will be known to those of skill in the art in light of the present disclosure.
- one dosage may be dissolved in 1 ml of isotonic NaCl solution and either added to 1000 ml of hypodermoclysis fluid or injected at the proposed site of infusion, (see for example, Hoover, 1975). Some variation in dosage will necessarily occur depending on the condition of the subject being treated. The person responsible for administration will, in any event, determine the appropriate dose for the individual subject.
- preparations should meet sterility, pyrogenicity, and general safety and purity standards as required by FDA Office of Biologies standards.
- Sterile injectable solutions may be prepared by incorporating the gene therapy constructs in the required amount in the appropriate solvent with several of the other ingredients enumerated above, as required, followed by filtered sterilization.
- dispersions are prepared by incorporating the various sterilized active ingredients into a sterile vehicle which contains the basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above, hi the case of sterile powders for the preparation of sterile injectable solutions, the prefe ⁇ ed methods of preparation are vacuum-drying and freeze-drying techniques which yield a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile- filtered solution thereof.
- compositions disclosed herein may be formulated in a neutral or salt form.
- Pharmaceutically-acceptable salts include the acid addition salts and which are formed with inorganic acids such as, for example, hydrochloric or phosphoric acids, or such organic acids as acetic, oxalic, tartaric, mandelic, and the like. Salts formed with the free carboxyl groups can also be derived from inorganic bases such as, for example, sodium, potassium, ammonium, calcium, or ferric hydroxides, and such organic bases as isopropylamine, trimethylamine, histidine, procaine and the like.
- solutions Upon formulation, solutions will be administered in a manner compatible with the dosage formulation and in such amount as is therapeutically effective.
- the formulations are easily administered in a variety of dosage forms such as injectable solutions, drug release capsules and the like.
- carrier includes any and all solvents, dispersion media, vehicles, coatings, diluents, antibacterial and antifungal agents, isotonic and absorption delaying agents, buffers, carrier solutions, suspensions, colloids, and the like.
- carrier includes any and all solvents, dispersion media, vehicles, coatings, diluents, antibacterial and antifungal agents, isotonic and absorption delaying agents, buffers, carrier solutions, suspensions, colloids, and the like.
- the use of such media and agents for pharmaceutical active substances is well known in the art. Except insofar as any conventional media or agent is incompatible with the active ingredient, its use in the therapeutic compositions is contemplated. Supplementary active ingredients can also be incorporated into the compositions.
- Nasal solutions are usually aqueous solutions designed for administration to the nasal passages in drops or sprays. Nasal solutions are prepared so that they are similar in many respects to nasal secretions, so that normal ciliary action is maintained. Thus, the aqueous nasal solutions usually are isotonic and slightly buffered to maintain a pH of from about 5.5 to about 6.5.
- antimicrobial preservatives similar to those used in ophthalmic preparations, and appropriate drug stabilizers, if required, may be included in the formulation.
- Inhalations and inhalants are pharmaceutical preparations designed for delivering a drug or compound into the respiratory tree of a patient.
- a vapor or mist is administered and reaches the affected area, often to give relief from symptoms of bronchial and nasal congestion.
- this route can also be employed to deliver agents into the systemic circulation.
- Inhalations may be administered by the nasal or oral respiratory routes.
- the administration of inhalation solutions is only effective if the droplets are sufficiently fine and uniform in size so that the mist reaches the bronchioles.
- inhalations also known as inhalations, and sometimes called insufflations
- insufflations consists of finely powdered or liquid drugs that are carried into the respiratory passages by the use of special delivery systems, such as pharmaceutical aerosols, that hold a solution or suspension of the drug in a liquefied gas propellant.
- pharmaceutical aerosols When released through a suitable valve and oral adapter, a metered does of the inhalation is propelled into the respiratory tract of the patient.
- Particle size is of importance in the administration of this type of preparation. It has been reported that the optimum particle size for penetration into the pulmonary cavity is of the order of about 0.5 to about 7 ⁇ m. Fine mists are produced by pressurized aerosols and hence their use in considered advantageous.
- the inventors contemplate the use of liposomes, nanocapsules, microparticles, microspheres, lipid particles, vesicles, and the like, for the introduction of the polynucleotide compositions of the present invention into suitable host cells.
- the polynucleotide compositions of the present invention may be formulated for delivery either encapsulated in a lipid particle, a liposome, a vesicle, a nanosphere, or a nanoparticle or the like.
- Such formulations may be prefe ⁇ ed for the introduction of pharmaceutically acceptable formulations of the nucleic acids disclosed herein.
- liposomes The formation and use of liposomes is generally known to those of skill in the art (see for example, Couvreur et al, 1977; Couvreur, 1988; Lasic, 1998; which describes the use of liposomes and nanocapsules in the targeted antibiotic therapy for intracellular bacterial infections and diseases). Recently, liposomes were developed with improved serum stability and circulation half-Uves (Gabizon and
- Liposomes have been used successfully with a number of cell types that are normally resistant to transfection by other procedures including T cell suspensions, primary hepatocyte cultures and PC12 cells (Renneisen et al, 1990; Muller et al, 1990). In addition, liposomes are free of the DNA length constraints that are typical of viral-based delivery systems.
- Liposomes have been used effectively to introduce genes, drugs (Heath and Martin, 1986; Heath etal, 1986; Balazsovits et al, 1989; Fresta and Puglisi, 1996), radiotherapeutic agents (Pikul et al, 1987), enzymes (hnaizumi et al, 1990a; hnaizumi et al, 1990b), viruses (Faller and Baltimore, 1984), transcription factors and allosteric effectors (Nicolau and Gersonde, 1979) into a variety of cultured cell lines and animals, h addition, several successful clinical trails examining the effectiveness of liposome-mediated drug delivery have been completed (Lopez-Berestein et al, 1985a; 1985b; Coune, 1988; Sculier et al, 1988). Furthermore, several studies suggest that the use of liposomes is not associated with autoimmune responses, toxicity or gonadal localization after systemic delivery (Mori and Fukatsu, 1992).
- Liposomes are formed from phospholipids that are dispersed in an aqueous medium and spontaneously form multilamellar concentric bilayer vesicles (also termed multilamellar vesicles (MLVs).
- MLVs generally have diameters of from 25 nm to 4 ⁇ m. Sonication of MLVs results in the formation of small unilamellar vesicles (SUVs) with diameters in the range of 200 to 500 A, containing an aqueous solution in the core.
- SUVs small unilamellar vesicles
- Liposomes bear resemblance to cellular membranes and are contemplated for use in connection with the present invention as carriers for the peptide compositions. They are widely suitable as both water- and lipid-soluble substances can be entrapped, i.e. in the aqueous spaces and within the bilayer itself, respectively. It is possible that the drug-bearing liposomes may even be employed for site-specific delivery of active agents by selectively modifying the liposomal formulation. hi addition to the teachings of Couvreur et al. (1977; 1988), the following information may be utilized in generating liposomal formulations. Phospholipids can form a variety of structures other than liposomes when dispersed in water, depending on the molar ratio of lipid to water.
- the liposome is the preferred structure.
- the physical characteristics of liposomes depend on pH, ionic strength and the presence of divalent cations. Liposomes can show low permeability to ionic and polar substances, but at elevated temperatures undergo a phase transition which markedly alters their permeability.
- the phase transition involves a change from a closely packed, ordered structure, known as the gel state, to a loosely packed, less-ordered structure, known as the fluid state. This occurs at a characteristic phase-transition temperature and results in an increase in permeability to ions, sugars, and drugs.
- the invention provides for pharmaceutically acceptable nanocapsule formulations of the polynucleotide compositions of the present invention.
- Nanocapsules can generally entrap compounds in a stable and reproducible way (Henry-Michelland et al, 1987; Quintanar-Gue ⁇ ero et al, 1998; Douglas et al, 1987).
- ultrafine particles sized around 0.1 ⁇ m
- Biodegradable polyalkyl-cyanoacrylate nanoparticles that meet these requirements are contemplated for use in the present invention, and such particles may be are easily made, as described (Couvreur et al, 1980; 1988; Ober Muhlen et al, 1998; Zambaux et al. 1998; Pinto-Alphandry et al, 1995 and U. S. Patent 5,145,684, specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety).
- methods of polynucleotide delivery to a target cell using either nanoparticles or nanospheres are also particularly contemplated to be useful in formulating the disclosed compositions for administration to an animal, and to a human in particular.
- the invention also provides one or more of the hematological malignancy-related compositions formulated with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients, carriers, diluents, adjuvants, and/or other components for use in the preparation of medicaments, or diagnostic reagents, as well as various kits comprising one or more of such compositions, medicaments, or formulations intended for adrninistration to an animal in need thereof, or for use in one or more diagnostic assays for identifying polynucleotides, polypeptides, and/or antibodies that are specific for one or more hematological malignancy-related compounds as described herein, h addition to the disclosed epitopes, antibodies and antigen binding fragments, antibody- or antigen binding fragment-encoding polynucleotides or additional anticancer agents, polynucleotides, peptides, antigens, or other therapeutic compounds as may be employed in the formulation of particular compositions and formulations disclosed herein, and particularly in the preparation of anticancer agents or anti
- prefe ⁇ ed animals for administration of the pharmaceutical compositions disclosed herein include mammals, and particularly humans.
- Other prefe ⁇ ed animals include primates, sheep, goats, bovines, equines, porcines, lupines, canines, and felines, as well as any other mammalian species commonly considered pets, livestock, or commercially relevant animal species.
- compositions and formulations may include partially or significantly purified polypeptide, polynucleotide, or antibody or antigen binding fragment compositions, either alone, or in combination with one or more additional active ingredients, anticancer agents, vaccines, adjuvants, or other therapeutics which may be obtained from natural or recombinant sources, or which may be obtainable naturally or either chemically synthesized, or alternatively produced in vitro from recombinant host cells expressing one or more nucleic acid segments that encode one or more such additional active ingredients, carriers, adjuvants, cofactors, or other therapeutic compound.
- kits comprising one or more such reagents for use in a variety of diagnostic assays, including for example, immunoassays such as ELISA and "sandwich"-type immunoassays.
- diagnostic assays including for example, immunoassays such as ELISA and "sandwich"-type immunoassays.
- kits may preferably include at least a first peptide, or a first antibody or antigen binding fragment of the invention, a functional fragment thereof, or a cocktail thereof, and means for signal generation.
- the kit's components may be pre-attached to a solid support, or may be applied to the surface of a solid support when the kit is used.
- the signal generating means may come pre-associated with an antibody of the invention or may require combination with one or more components, e.g., buffers, antibody- enzyme conjugates, enzyme substrates, or the like, prior to use.
- Kits may also include additional reagents, e.g., blocking reagents for reducing nonspecific binding to the solid phase surface, washing reagents, enzyme substrates, and the like.
- the solid phase surface may be in the form of microtiter plates, microspheres, or other materials suitable for immobilizing proteins, peptides, or polypeptides.
- an enzyme that catalyzes the formation of a chemiluminescent or chromogenic product or the reduction of a chemilummescent or chromogemc substrate is a component of the signal generating means.
- Such enzymes are well known in the art.
- kits are useful in the detection, monitoring and diagnosis of conditions characterized by over-expression or inappropriate expression of hematological malignancy- related peptides, polypeptides, antibodies, and/or polynucleotides, as well as hybridomas, host cells, and vectors comprising one or more such compositions as disclosed herein.
- kits of the present invention may also be prepared that comprise at least one of the antibody, peptide, antigen binding fragment, hybridoma, vector, vaccine, polynucleotide, or cellular compositions disclosed herein and instructions for using the composition as a diagnostic reagent or therapeutic agent.
- Containers for use in such kits may typically comprise at least one vial, test tube, flask, bottle, syringe or other suitable container, into which one or more of the diagnostic and/or therapeutic composition(s) maybe placed, and preferably suitably aliquoted. Where a second therapeutic agent is also provided, the kit may also contain a second distinct container into which this second diagnostic and/or therapeutic composition may be placed.
- kits of the present invention will also typically include a means for containing the vial(s) in close confinement for commercial sale, such as, e.g., injection or blow-molded plastic containers into which the desired vial(s) are retained.
- the labeling agent may be provided either in the same container as the diagnostic or therapeutic composition itself, or may alternatively be placed in a second distinct container means into which this second composition may be placed and suitably aliquoted.
- the detection reagent and the label may be prepared in a single container means, and in most cases, the kit will also typically include a means for containing the vial(s) in close confinement for commercial sale and/or convenient packaging and delivery.
- DNA segment and “polynucleotide” refer to a DNA molecule that has been isolated free of total genomic DNA of a particular species. Therefore, a DNA segment encoding a polypeptide refers to a DNA segment that contains one or more coding sequences yet is substantially isolated away from, or purified free from, total genomic DNA of the species from which the DNA segment is obtained. Included within the terms “DNA segment” and “polynucleotide” are DNA segments and smaller fragments of such segments, and also recombinant vectors, including, for example, plasmids, cosmids, phagemids, phage, viruses, and the like.
- the DNA segments of this invention can include genomic sequences, extra-genomic and plasmid-encoded sequences and smaller engineered gene segments that express, or may be adapted to express, proteins, polypeptides, peptides and the like. Such segments may be naturally isolated, or modified synthetically by the hand of man. "Isolated,” as used herein, means that a polynucleotide is substantially away from other coding sequences, and that the DNA segment does not contain large portions of unrelated coding DNA, such as large chromosomal fragments or other functional genes or polypeptide coding regions. Of course, this refers to the DNA segment as originally isolated, and does not exclude genes or coding regions later added to the segment by the hand of man.
- polynucleotides may be single-stranded (coding or antisense) or double-stranded, and may be DNA (genomic, cDNA or synthetic) or RNA molecules.
- RNA molecules include HnRNA molecules, which contain introns and co ⁇ espond to a DNA molecule in a one-to-one manner, and R A molecules, which do not contain introns. Additional coding or non-coding sequences may, but need not, be present within a polynucleotide of the present invention, and a polynucleotide may, but need not, be linked to other molecules and/or support materials.
- Polynucleotides may comprise a native sequence (i.e., an endogenous sequence that encodes a hematological malignancy-related tumor protein or a portion thereof) or may comprise a variant, or a biological or antigenic functional equivalent of such a sequence.
- Polynucleotide variants may contain one or more substitutions, additions, deletions and/or insertions, as further described below, preferably such that the immunogenicity of the encoded polypeptide is not diminished, relative to a native tumor protein. The effect on the immunogenicity of the encoded polypeptide may generally be assessed as described herein.
- variants also encompasses homologous genes of xenogenic origin.
- two sequences are said to be “identical” if the sequence of nucleotides or amino acids in the two sequences is the same when aligned for maximum conespondence, as described below. Comparisons between two sequences are typically performed by comparing the sequences over a comparison window to identify and compare local regions of sequence similarity.
- a “comparison window” as used herein refers to a segment of at least about 20 contiguous positions, usually 30 to about 75, 40 to about 50, in which a sequence may be compared to a reference sequence of the same number of contiguous positions after the two sequences are optimally aligned.
- Optimal alignment of sequences for comparison may be conducted using the Megalign program in the Lasergene suite of bioinformatics software (DNASTAR, Inc., Madison, WE), using default parameters.
- This program embodies several alignment schemes described in the following references: Dayhoff, M.O. (1978) A model of evolutionary change in proteins - Matrices for detecting distant relationships. In Dayhoff, M.O. (ed.) Atlas of Protein Sequence and Structure, National Biomedical Research Foundation, Washington DC Vol. 5, Suppl. 3, pp. 345-358; Hein J. (1990) Unified Approach to Alignment and Phylogenes pp. 626-645 Methods in Enzymology vol.
- optimal alignment of sequences for comparison may be conducted by the local identity algorithm of Smith and Waterman (1981) Add. APL. Math 2:482, by the identity alignment algorithm of Needleman and Wunsch (1970) J. Mol Biol. 48:443, by the search for similarity methods of Pearson and Lipman (1988) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 85: 2444, by computerized implementations of these algorithms (GAP, BESTFIT, BLAST, FASTA, and TFASTA in the Wisconsin Genetics Software Package, Genetics Computer Group (GCG), 575 Science Dr., Madison, WI), or by inspection.
- BLAST and BLAST 2.0 are described in Altschul et al (1977) Nucl Acids Res. 25:3389-3402 and Altschul et al. (1990) J. Mol. Biol. 215:403-410, respectively.
- BLAST and BLAST 2.0 can be used, for example with the parameters described herein, to determine percent sequence identity for the polynucleotides and polypeptides of the invention.
- Software for performing BLAST analyses is publicly available through the National Center for Biotechnology Information.
- cumulative scores can be calculated using, for nucleotide sequences, the parameters M (reward score for a pair of matching residues; always >0) and N (penalty score for mismatching residues; always ⁇ 0).
- M forward score for a pair of matching residues; always >0
- N penalty score for mismatching residues; always ⁇ 0
- a scoring matrix can be used to calculate the cumulative score. Extension of the word hits in each direction are halted when: the cumulative alignment score falls off by the quantity X from its maximum achieved value; the cumulative score goes to zero or below, due to the accumulation of one or more negative-scoring residue alignments; or the end of either sequence is reached.
- the BLAST algorithm parameters W, T and X determine the sensitivity and speed of the alignment.
- the "percentage of sequence identity” is determined by comparing two optimally aligned sequences over a window of comparison of at least 20 positions, wherein the portion of the polynucleotide or polypeptide sequence in the comparison window may comprise additions or deletions (i.e., gaps) of 20 percent or less, usually 5 to 15 percent, or 10 to 12 percent, as compared to the reference sequences (wliich does not comprise additions or deletions) for optimal alignment of the two sequences.
- additions or deletions i.e., gaps
- the percentage is calculated by determining the number of positions at which the identical nucleic acid bases or amino acid residue occurs in both sequences to yield the number of matched positions, dividing the number of matched positions by the total number of positions in the reference sequence (i.e., the window size) and multiplying the results by 100 to yield the percentage of sequence identity.
- the present invention encompasses polynucleotide and polypeptide sequences having substantial identity to the sequences disclosed herein, for example those comprising at least 50% sequence identity, preferably at least 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, or 99% or higher, sequence identity compared to a polynucleotide or polypeptide sequence of this invention using the methods described herein, (e.g., BLAST analysis using standard parameters, as described below).
- BLAST analysis using standard parameters, as described below.
- the present invention provides isolated polynucleotides and polypeptides comprising various lengths of contiguous stretches of sequence identical to or complementary to one or more of the sequences disclosed herein.
- polynucleotides are provided by this invention that comprise at least about 15, 20, 30, 40, 50, 75, 100, 150, 200, 300, 400, 500 or 1000 or more contiguous nucleotides of one or more of the sequences disclosed herein as well as all intermediate lengths there between.
- intermediate lengths means any length between the quoted values, such as 16, 17, 18, 19, etc.; 21, 22, 23, etc.; 30, 31, 32, etc.; 50, 51, 52, 53, etc.; 100, 101, 102, 103, etc.; 150, 151, 152, 153, etc.; including all integers through 200-500; 500-1,000, and the like.
- polynucleotides of the present invention may be combined with other DNA sequences, such as promoters, polyadenylation signals, additional restriction enzyme sites, multiple cloning sites, other coding segments, and the like, such that their overall length may vary considerably. It is therefore contemplated that a nucleic acid fragment of almost any length may be employed, with the total length preferably being limited by the ease of preparation and use in the intended recombinant DNA protocol.
- illustrative DNA segments with total lengths of about 10,000, about 5000, about 3000, about 2,000, about 1,000, about 500, about 200, about 100, about 50 base pairs in length, and the like, (including all intermediate lengths) are contemplated to be useful in many implementations of this invention.
- the present invention is directed to polynucleotides that are capable of hybridizing under moderately stringent conditions to a polynucleotide sequence provided herein, or a fragment thereof, or a complementary sequence thereof.
- Hybridization techniques are well known in the art of molecular biology.
- suitable moderately stringent conditions for testing the hybridization of a polynucleotide of this invention with other polynucleotides include prewashing in a solution of 5 X SSC, 0.5% SDS, 1.0 mM EDTA (pH 8.0); hybridizing at 50°C-65°C, 5 X SSC, overnight; followed by washing twice at 65°C for 20 minutes with each of 2X, 0.5X and 0.2X SSC containing 0.1% SDS.
- nucleotide sequences that encode a polypeptide as described herein. Some of these polynucleotides bear minimal homology to the nucleotide sequence of any native gene. Nonetheless, polynucleotides that vary due to differences in codon usage are specifically contemplated by the present invention. Further, alleles of the genes comprising the polynucleotide sequences provided herein are within the scope of the present invention. Alleles are endogenous genes that are altered as a result of one or more mutations, such as deletions, additions and/or substitutions of nucleotides. The resulting mRNA and protein may, but need not, have an altered structure or function. Alleles may be identified using standard techniques (such as hybridization, amplification and/or database sequence comparison).
- the polynucleotide sequences provided herein can be advantageously used as probes or primers for nucleic acid hybridization.
- nucleic acid segments that comprise a sequence region of at least about 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45, 50, 55, 60, 65, 70, 75, 80, 85, 90, or 95 nucleotide long contiguous sequence that has the same sequence as, or is complementary to, at least a 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45, 50, 55, 60, 65, 70, 75, 80, 85, 90, or 95 nucleotide long contiguous sequence the disclosed polynucleotides will find particular utility in a variety of hybridization embodiments.
- nucleic acid probes to specifically hybridize to a sequence of interest will enable them to be of use in detecting the presence of complementary sequences in a given sample.
- sequence information for the preparation of mutant species primers, or primers, for use in preparing other genetic constructions, and for identifying and characterizing full-length polynucleotides and full, or substantially full-length cDNAs, mRNAs, and such like.
- Polynucleotide molecules having sequence regions consisting of contiguous nucleotide stretches identical or complementary to one or more polynucleotide sequences as disclosed herein, are particularly contemplated as hybridization probes for use in, e.g., Southern hybridization analyses and Northern blotting. This would allow a gene product, or fragment thereof, to be analyzed, both in diverse cell types and also in various bacterial cells. The total size of fragment, as well as the size of the complementary stretch(es), will ultimately depend on the intended use or application of the particular nucleic acid segment.
- Smaller fragments will generally find use in hybridization embodiments, wherein the length of the contiguous complementary region may be varied, such as between about 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45, 50, 55, 60 or so and up to and including larger contiguous complementary sequences, including those of about 70, 80, 90, 100, 120, 140, 160, 180, or 200 or so nucleotides in length may also be used, according to the given desired goal, and the particular length of the complementary sequences one wishes to detect by hybridization analysis.
- hybridization probe of about between about 20 and about 500 nucleotides in length allows the formation of a duplex molecule that is both stable and selective.
- Molecules having contiguous complementary sequences over stretches greater than about 20 or so bases in length are generally prefened, though, in order to increase stability and selectivity of the hybrid, and thereby improve the quality and degree of specific hybrid molecules obtained.
- Hybridization probes may be selected from any portion of any of the sequences disclosed herein. All that is required is to review the disclosed sequences, or to any contiguous portion of such a sequence, from about 15 to 30 nucleotides in length up to and including the full length sequence, that one wishes to utilize as a probe or primer.
- the choice of probe and primer sequences may be governed by various factors. For example, one may wish to employ primers from towards the termini of the total sequence.
- Small polynucleotide segments or fragments may be readily prepared by, for example, directly synthesizing the fragment by chemical means, as is commonly practiced using an automated ohgonucleotide synthesizer. Also, fragments may be obtained by application of nucleic acid reproduction technology, such as the PCRTM technology of U. S. Patent 4,683,202 (incorporated herein by reference), by introducing selected sequences into recombinant vectors for recombinant production, and by other recombinant DNA techniques generally known to those of skill in the art of molecular biology.
- the nucleotide sequences of the invention may be used for their ability to selectively form duplex molecules with complementary stretches of the entire gene or gene fragments of interest.
- relatively stringent conditions e.g., one will select relatively low salt and/or high temperature conditions, such as provided by a salt concentration of from about 0.02 M to about 0.15 M salt at temperatures of from about 50°C to about 70°C.
- Such selective conditions tolerate little, if any, mismatch between the probe and the template or target strand, and would be particularly suitable for isolating related sequences.
- Polynucleotides may be identified, prepared and/or manipulated using any of a variety of well established techniques.
- a polynucleotide maybe identified, as described in more detail below, by screening a microarray of cDNAs for tumor-associated expression (i.e., expression that is at least two fold greater in a tumor than in normal tissue, as determined using a representative assay provided herein). Such screens may be performed, for example, using a Synteni microarray (Palo Alto, CA) according to the manufacturer's instructions (and essentially as described by Schena et al, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 95:10614-10619, 1996 and Heller et al, Proc. Natl Acad. Sci.
- polynucleotides may be amplified from cDNA prepared from cells expressing the proteins described herein, such as hematological malignancy-related tumor cells. Such polynucleotides may be amplified via polymerase chain reaction (PCR).
- PCR polymerase chain reaction
- sequence-specific primers may be designed based on the sequences provided herein, and may be purchased or synthesized.
- An amplified portion of a polynucleotide of the present invention may be used to isolate a full length gene from a suitable library (e.g., a hematological malignancy-related tumor cDNA library) using well known techniques.
- a library cDNA or genomic
- a library is screened using one or more polynucleotide probes or primers suitable for amplification.
- a library is size-selected to include larger molecules. Random primed libraries may also be prefened for identifying 5' and upstream regions of genes. Genomic libraries are prefened for obtaining introns and extending 5' sequences.
- a partial sequence may be labeled (e.g., by nick-translation or end-labeling with 32 P) using well known techniques.
- a bacterial or bacteriophage library is then generally screened by hybridizing filters containing denatured bacterial colonies (or lawns containing phage plaques) with the labeled probe (see Sambrook et al, Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratories, Cold Spring Harbor, NY, 1989). Hybridizing colonies or plaques are selected and expanded, and the DNA is isolated for further analysis.
- cDNA clones may be analyzed to determine the amount of additional sequence by, for example, PCR using a primer from the partial sequence and a primer from the vector.
- Restriction maps and partial sequences may be generated to identify one or more overlapping clones.
- the complete sequence may then be determined using standard techniques, which may involve generating a series of deletion clones.
- the resulting overlapping sequences can then assembled into a single contiguous sequence.
- a full length cDNA molecule can be generated by ligating suitable fragments, using well known techniques.
- amplification techniques for obtaining a full length coding sequence from a partial cDNA sequence.
- amplification is generally performed via PCR. Any of a variety of commercially available kits may be used to perform the amplification step. Primers may be designed using, for example, software or algorithms or formulas well known in the art.
- amplification technique is inverse PCR (see Triglia et al, Nucl. Acids Res. 16: 8186, 1988), which uses restriction enzymes to generate a fragment in the known region of the gene. The fragment is then circularized by intramolecular ligation and used as a template for PCR with divergent primers derived from the known region.
- sequences adjacent to a partial sequence may be retrieved by amplification with a primer to a linker sequence and a primer specific to a known region.
- the amplified sequences are typically subjected to a second round of amplification with the same linker primer and a second primer specific to the known region.
- RACE Rapid amplification of cDNA ends
- This technique involves the use of an internal primer and an external primer, wliich hybridizes to a polyA region or vector sequence, to identify sequences that are 5' and 3' of a known sequence. Additional techniques include capture PCR (Lagerstrom et al, PCR Methods Applic. 7:111-19, 1991) and walking PCR (Parker et al, Nucl Acids. Res. 19:3055-60, 1991). Other methods employing amplification may also be employed to obtain a full length cDNA sequence.
- EST expressed sequence tag
- Searches for overlapping ESTs may generally be performed using well known programs (e.g., NCBI BLAST searches), and such ESTs may be used to generate a contiguous full length sequence.
- Full length DNA sequences may also be obtained by analysis of genomic fragments.
- polynucleotide sequences or fragments thereof which encode polypeptides of the invention, or fusion proteins or functional equivalents thereof may be used in recombinant DNA molecules to direct expression of a polypeptide in appropriate host cells. Due to the inherent degeneracy of the genetic code, other DNA sequences that encode substantially the same or a functionally equivalent amino acid sequence may be produced and these sequences may be used to clone and express a given polypeptide.
- codons prefened by a particular prokaryotic or eukaryotic host can be selected to increase the rate of protein expression or to produce a recombinant RNA transcript having desirable properties, such as a half-life which is longer than that of a transcript generated from the naturally occurring sequence.
- polynucleotide sequences of the present invention can be engineered using methods generally known in the art in order to alter polypeptide encoding sequences for a variety of reasons, including but not limited to, alterations which modify the cloning, processing, and/or expression of the gene product.
- DNA shuffling by random fragmentation and PCR reassembly of gene fragments and synthetic oligonucleotides may be used to engineer the nucleotide sequences.
- site-directed mutagenesis may be used to insert new restriction sites, alter glycosylation patterns, change codon preference, produce splice variants, or introduce mutations, and so forth.
- natural, modified, or recombinant nucleic acid sequences may be ligated to a heterologous sequence to encode a fusion protein.
- a heterologous sequence For example, to screen peptide libraries for inhibitors of polypeptide activity, it may be useful to encode a chimeric protein that can be recognized by a commercially available antibody.
- a fusion protein may also be engineered to contain a cleavage site located between the polypeptide-encoding sequence and the heterologous protein sequence, so that the polypeptide may be cleaved and purified away from the heterologous moiety.
- Sequences encoding a desired polypeptide may be synthesized, in whole or in part, using chemical methods well known in the art (see Caruthers, M. H.
- the protein itself may be produced using chemical methods to synthesize the amino acid sequence of a polypeptide, or a portion thereof.
- peptide synthesis can be performed using various sohd-phase techniques (Roberge, J. Y. et al. (1995) Science 269:202-204) and automated synthesis may be achieved, for example, using the ABI 431 A Peptide Synthesizer (Perkin Elmer, Palo Alto, CA).
- a newly synthesized peptide may be substantially purified by preparative high performance liquid " chromatography (e.g., Creighton, T. (1983) Proteins, Structures and Molecular Principles, WH Freeman and Co., New York, N.Y.) or other comparable techniques available in the art.
- the composition of the synthetic peptides may be confirmed by amino acid analysis or sequencing (e.g., the Edman degradation procedure). Additionally, the amino acid sequence of a polypeptide, or any part thereof, may be altered during direct synthesis and/or combined using chemical methods with sequences from other proteins, or any part thereof, to produce a variant polypeptide.
- the nucleotide sequences encoding the polypeptide, or functional equivalents may be inserted into appropriate expression vector, i.e., a vector which contains the necessary elements for the transcription and translation of the inserted coding sequence.
- appropriate expression vector i.e., a vector which contains the necessary elements for the transcription and translation of the inserted coding sequence.
- Methods which are well known to those skilled in the art may be used to construct expression vectors containing sequences encoding a polypeptide of interest and appropriate transcriptional and translational control elements. These methods include in vitro recombinant DNA techniques, synthetic techniques, and in vivo genetic recombination. Such techniques are described in Sambrook, J. et al. (1989) Molecular Cloning, A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Press, Plainview, N.Y., and Ausubel, F. M. et al. (1989) Cu ⁇ ent Protocols in Molecular Biology, John Wiley & Sons, New York. N.Y.
- a variety of expression vector/host systems may be utilized to contain and express polynucleotide sequences. These include, but are not limited to, microorganisms such as bacteria transformed with recombinant bacteriophage, plasmid, or cosmid DNA expression vectors; yeast transformed with yeast expression vectors; insect cell systems infected with virus expression vectors (e.g., baculo virus); plant cell systems transformed with virus expression vectors (e.g., cauliflower mosaic virus, CaMV; tobacco mosaic virus, TMV) or with bacterial expression vectors (e.g., Ti or pBR322 plasmids); or animal cell systems.
- microorganisms such as bacteria transformed with recombinant bacteriophage, plasmid, or cosmid DNA expression vectors
- yeast transformed with yeast expression vectors insect cell systems infected with virus expression vectors (e.g., baculo virus)
- plant cell systems transformed with virus expression vectors e.g., cauliflower mosaic virus, CaMV; tobacco mosaic
- control elements or "regulatory sequences” present in an expression vector are those non-translated regions of the vector— enhancers, promoters, 5' and 3' untranslated regions—which interact with host cellular proteins to carry out transcription and translation. Such elements may vary in their strength and specificity. Depending on the vector system and host utilized, any number of suitable transcription and translation elements, including constitutive and inducible promoters, may be used.
- inducible promoters such as the hybrid lacZ promoter of the PBLUESCRIPT phagemid (Stratagene, La Jolla, Calif.) or PSPORT1 plasmid (Gibco BRL, Gaithersburg, MD) and the like may be used, hi mammalian cell systems, promoters from mammalian genes or from mammalian viruses are generally prefe ⁇ ed. If it is necessary to generate a cell line that contains multiple copies of the sequence encoding a polypeptide, vectors based on SV40 or EBV may be advantageously used with an appropriate selectable marker.
- inducible promoters such as the hybrid lacZ promoter of the PBLUESCRIPT phagemid (Stratagene, La Jolla, Calif.) or PSPORT1 plasmid (Gibco BRL, Gaithersburg, MD) and the like may be used, hi mammalian cell systems, promoters from mammalian genes or from mammalian viruses are generally prefe ⁇ ed
- a number of expression vectors may be selected depending upon the use intended for the expressed polypeptide. For example, when large quantities are needed, for example for the induction of antibodies, vectors which direct high level expression of fusion proteins that are readily purified may be used.
- Such vectors include, but are not limited to, the multifunctional E. coli cloning and expression vectors such as BLUES CREPT (Stratagene), in which the sequence encoding the polypeptide of interest maybe ligated into the vector in frame with sequences for the ammo-terminal Met and the subsequent 7 residues of .beta.-galactosidase so that a hybrid protein is produced; pIN vectors (Van Heeke, G. and S. M.
- pGEX Vectors may also be used to express foreign polypeptides as fusion proteins with glutathione S-transferase (GST).
- GST glutathione S-transferase
- fusion proteins are soluble and can easily be purified from lysed cells by adsorption to glutathione-agarose beads followed by elution in the presence of free glutathione.
- Proteins made in such systems may be designed to include heparin, thrombin, or factor XA protease cleavage sites so that the cloned polypeptide of interest can be released from the GST moiety at will.
- plant promoters such as the small subunit of RUBISCO or heat shock promoters may be used (Coruzzi, G. et al. (1984) EMBO J. 5: 1671-1680; Broglie, R. et al. (1984) Science 224:838-843; and Winter, j. et al. (1991) Results Probl Cell Differ. 77:85-105).
- These constructs can be introduced into plant cells by direct DNA transformation or pathogen-mediated transfection. Such techniques are described in a number of generally available reviews (see, for example, Hobbs, S. or Murry, L. E. in McGraw Hill Yearbook of Science and Technology (1992) McGraw Hill, New York, NY.; pp. 191-196).
- An insect system may also be used to express a polypeptide of interest.
- Autographa californica nuclear polyhedrosis virus (AcNPV) is used as a vector to express foreign genes in Spodoptera frugiperda cells or in Trichoplusia larvae.
- the sequences encoding the polypeptide may be cloned into a non-essential region of the virus, such as the polyhedrin gene, and placed under control of the polyhedrin promoter. Successful insertion of the polypeptide-encoding sequence will render the polyhedrin gene inactive and produce recombinant virus lacking coat protein.
- the recombinant viruses may then be used to infect, for example, S.
- frugiperda cells or Trichoplusia larvae in which the polypeptide of interest maybe expressed (Engelhard, E. K. et al. (1994) Proc. Natl Acad. Sci. 91 :3224-3227).
- a number of viral-based expression systems are generally available.
- sequences encoding a polypeptide of interest may be ligated into an adenovirus transcription/translation complex consisting of the late promoter and tripartite leader sequence.
- Insertion in a non- essential El or E3 region of the viral genome may be used to obtain a viable virus which is capable of expressing the polypeptide in infected host cells (Logan, J. and Shenk, T. (1984) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 81:3655-3659).
- transcription enhancers such as the Rous sarcoma virus (RSV) enhancer, may be used to increase expression in mammalian host cells.
- RSV Rous sarcoma virus
- Specific initiation signals may also be used to achieve more efficient translation of sequences encoding a polypeptide of interest. Such signals include the ATG initiation codon and adjacent sequences, h cases where sequences encoding the polypeptide, its initiation codon, and upstream sequences are inserted into the appropriate expression vector, no additional transcriptional or translational control signals may be needed. However, in cases where only coding sequence, or a portion thereof, is inserted, exogenous translational control signals including the ATG initiation codon should be provided. Furthermore, the initiation codon should be in the conect reading frame to ensure translation of the entire insert. Exogenous translational elements and initiation codons may be of various origins, both natural and synthetic. The efficiency of expression may be enhanced by the inclusion of enhancers which are appropriate for the particular cell system which is used, such as those described in the literature (Scharf, D. et al (1994) Results Probl Cell Differ. 20:125-162).
- a host cell strain may be chosen for its ability to modulate the expression of the inserted sequences or to process the expressed protein in the desired fashion.
- modifications of the polypeptide include, but are not limited to, acetylation, carboxylation. glycosylation, phosphorylation, lipidation, and acylation.
- Post-translational processing which cleaves a "prepro" form of the protein may also be used to facilitate conect insertion, folding and/or function.
- Different host cells such as CHO, HeLa, MDCK, HEK293, and WI38, which have specific cellular machinery and characteristic mechanisms for such post-translational activities, may be chosen to ensure the conect modification and processing of the foreign protein.
- cell lines which stably express a polynucleotide of interest may be transformed using expression vectors which may contain viral origins of replication and/or endogenous expression elements and a selectable marker gene on the same or on a separate vector. Following the introduction of the vector, cells may be allowed to grow for 1-2 days in an enriched media before they are switched to selective media.
- the purpose of the selectable marker is to confer resistance to selection, and its presence allows growth and recovery of cells which successfully express the introduced sequences.
- Resistant clones of stably transformed cells may be proliferated using tissue culture techniques appropriate to the cell type.
- any number of selection systems may be used to recover transformed cell lines. These include, but are not limited to, the herpes simplex virus thymidine kinase (Wigler, M. et al. (1977) Cell 11:223-32) and adenine phosphoribosylfransferase (Lowy, I. et al. (1990) Cell 22:817-23) genes which can be employed in tk.sup.- or apr sup.- cells, respectively. Also, antimetabolite, antibiotic or herbicide resistance can be used as the basis for selection; for example, dhfr which confers resistance to methotrexate (Wigler, M. et al. (1980) Proc. Natl.
- npt which confers resistance to the aminoglycosides, neomycin and G- 418 (Colbere-Garapin, F. et al (1981) J Mol. Biol. 150:1-14); and als or pat, which confer resistance to chlorsulfuron and phosphinotricin acetyltransferase, respectively (Murry, supra). Additional selectable genes have been described, for example, trpB, which allows cells to utilize indole in place of tryptophan, or hisD, which allows cells to utilize histinol in place of histidine (Hartman, S. C. and R. C. Mulligan (1988) Proc. Natl.
- telomere sequence encoding a polypeptide is inserted within a marker gene sequence
- recombinant cells containing sequences can be identified by the absence of marker gene function.
- a marker gene can be placed in tandem with a polypeptide-encoding sequence under the control of a single promoter. Expression of the marker gene in response to induction or selection usually indicates expression of the tandem gene as well.
- host cells which contain and express a desired polynucleotide sequence may be identified by a variety of procedures known to those of skill in the art. These procedures include, but are not limited to, DNA-DNA or DNA-RNA hybridizations and protein bioassay or immunoassay techniques which include membrane, solution, or chip based technologies for the detection and/or quantification of nucleic acid or protein.
- a variety of protocols for detecting and measuring the expression of polynucleotide- encoded products, using either polyclonal or monoclonal antibodies specific for the product are known in the art. Examples include enzyme-linked immunosorbent assay (ELISA), radioirnmunoassay (RIA), and fluorescence activated cell sorting (FACS).
- ELISA enzyme-linked immunosorbent assay
- RIA radioirnmunoassay
- FACS fluorescence activated cell sorting
- a two-site, monoclonal-based immunoassay utilizing monoclonal antibodies reactive to two non-interfering epitopes on a given polypeptide may be prefened for some applications, but a competitive binding assay may also be employed. These and other assays are described, among other places, in Hampton, R. et al. (1990; Serological Methods, a Laboratory Manual, APS Press, St Paul. Minn.) and Maddox, D. E. et al. (1983; J
- Means for producing labeled hybridization or PCR probes for detecting sequences related to polynucleotides include oligolabeling, nick translation, end-labeling or PCR amplification using a labeled nucleotide.
- the sequences, or any portions thereof may be cloned into a vector for the production of an mRNA probe.
- Such vectors are known in the art, are commercially available, and may be used to synthesize RNA probes in vitro by addition of an appropriate RNA polymerase such as T7, T3, or SP6 and labeled nucleotides.
- reporter molecules or labels include radionuclides, enzymes, fluorescent, chemiluminescent, or chromogemc agents as well as substrates, cofactors, inhibitors, magnetic particles, and the like.
- Host cells transformed with a polynucleotide sequence of interest may be cultured under conditions suitable for the expression and recovery of the protein from cell culture.
- the protein produced by a recombinant cell may be secreted or contained intracellularly depending on the sequence and/or the vector used.
- expression vectors containing polynucleotides of the invention may be designed to contain signal sequences which direct secretion of the encoded polypeptide through a prokaryotic or eukaryotic cell membrane.
- Other recombinant constructions may be used to join sequences encoding a polypeptide of interest to nucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide domain which will facilitate purification of soluble proteins.
- Such purification facilitating domains include, but are not limited to, metal chelating peptides such as histidine-tryptophan modules that allow purification on immobilized metals, protein A domains that allow purification on immobilized immunoglobulin, and the domain utilized in the FLAGS extension/affinity purification system (Immunex Corp., Seattle, Wash.).
- metal chelating peptides such as histidine-tryptophan modules that allow purification on immobilized metals
- protein A domains that allow purification on immobilized immunoglobulin
- the domain utilized in the FLAGS extension/affinity purification system Immunex Corp., Seattle, Wash.
- the inclusion of cleavable linker sequences such as those specific for Factor XA or enterokinase (frivitrogen. San Diego, Calif.) between the purification domain and the encoded polypeptide may be used to facilitate purification.
- One such expression vector provides for expression of a fusion protein containing a polypeptide of interest and a nucleic acid encoding 6 histidine residues preceding a thioredoxin or an enterokinase cleavage site.
- the histidine residues facilitate purification on IMIAC (immobilized metal ion affinity chromatography) as described in Porath, J. et al. (1992, Prot. Exp. Purif. 3:263-281) while the enterokinase cleavage site provides a means for purifying the desired polypeptide from the fusion protein.
- IMIAC immobilized metal ion affinity chromatography
- polypeptides of the invention may be produced by direct peptide synthesis using solid-phase techniques (Merrifield J. (1963) J. Am. Chem. Soc. 55:2149-2154). Protein synthesis may be performed using manual techniques or by automation. Automated synthesis may be achieved, for example, using Applied Biosystems 431 A Peptide Synthesizer (Perkin Elmer). Alternatively, various fragments may be chemically synthesized separately and combined using chemical methods to produce the full length molecule.
- Site-specific mutagenesis is a technique useful in the preparation of individual peptides, or biologically functional equivalent polypeptides, through specific mutagenesis of the underlying polynucleotides that encode them.
- the technique well-known to those of skill in the art, further provides a ready ability to prepare and test sequence variants, for example, incorporating one or more of the foregoing considerations, by introducing one or more nucleotide sequence changes into the DNA.
- Site-specific mutagenesis allows the production of mutants through the use of specific ohgonucleotide sequences which encode the DNA sequence of the desired mutation, as well as a sufficient number of adjacent nucleotides, to provide a primer sequence of sufficient size and sequence complexity to form a stable duplex on both sides of the deletion junction being traversed. Mutations may be employed in a selected polynucleotide sequence to improve, alter, decrease, modify, or otherwise change the properties of the polynucleotide itself, and/or alter the properties, activity, composition, stability, or primary sequence of the encoded polypeptide.
- the inventors contemplate the mutagenesis of the disclosed polynucleotide sequences to alter one or more properties of the encoded polypeptide, such as the antigenicity of a polypeptide vaccine.
- the techniques of site- specific mutagenesis are well-known in the art, and are widely used to create variants of both polypeptides and polynucleotides.
- site-specific mutagenesis is often used to alter a specific portion of a DNA molecule, hi such embodiments, a primer comprising typically about 14 to about 25 nucleotides or so in length is employed, with about 5 to about 10 residues on both sides of the junction of the sequence being altered.
- site-specific mutagenesis techniques have often employed a phage vector that exists in both a single stranded and double stranded form.
- Typical vectors useful in site-directed mutagenesis include vectors such as the Ml 3 phage. These phage are readily commercially-available and their use is generally well-known to those skilled in the art.
- Double-stranded plasmids are also routinely employed in site directed mutagenesis that eliminates the step of transferring the gene of interest from a plasmid to a phage.
- site-directed mutagenesis in accordance herewith is performed by first obtaining a single-stranded vector or melting apart of two strands of a double-stranded vector that includes within its sequence a DNA sequence that encodes the desired peptide.
- An ohgonucleotide primer bearing the desired mutated sequence is prepared, generally synthetically. This primer is then annealed with the single-stranded vector, and subjected to DNA polymerizing enzymes such as E. coli polymerase I Klenow fragment, in order to complete the synthesis of the mutation-bearing strand.
- DNA polymerizing enzymes such as E. coli polymerase I Klenow fragment
- This heteroduplex vector is then used to transform appropriate cells, such as E. coli cells, and clones are selected which include recombinant vectors bearing the mutated sequence arrangement.
- appropriate cells such as E. coli cells
- clones are selected which include recombinant vectors bearing the mutated sequence arrangement.
- sequence variants of the selected peptide-encoding DNA segments using site-directed mutagenesis provides a means of producing potentially useful species and is not meant to be limiting as there are other ways in which sequence variants of peptides and the DNA sequences encoding them may be obtained.
- recombinant vectors encoding the desired peptide sequence may be treated with mutagenic agents, such as hydroxylamine, to obtain sequence variants.
- the term "ohgonucleotide directed mutagenesis procedure” refers to template-dependent processes and vector-mediated propagation which result in an increase in the concentration of a specific nucleic acid molecule relative to its initial concentration, or in an increase in the concentration of a detectable signal, such as amphfication.
- the term “ohgonucleotide directed mutagenesis procedure” is intended to refer to a process that involves the template-dependent extension of a primer molecule.
- template dependent process refers to nucleic acid synthesis of an RNA or a DNA molecule wherein the sequence of the newly synthesized strand of nucleic acid is dictated by the well-known rules of complementary base pairing (see, for example, Watson, 1987).
- vector mediated methodologies involve the introduction of the nucleic acid fragment into a DNA or RNA vector, the clonal amplification of the vector, and the recovery of the amplified nucleic acid fragment. Examples of such methodologies are provided by U. S. Patent No. 4,237,224, specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
- PCRTM polymerase chain reaction
- the primers will bind to the target and the polymerase will cause the primers to be extended along the target sequence by adding on nucleotides.
- the extended primers will dissociate from the target to form reaction products, excess primers will bind to the target and to the reaction product and the process is repeated.
- reverse transcription and PCRTM amplification procedure may be performed in order to quantify the amount of mRNA amplified. Polymerase chain reaction methodologies are well known in the art.
- LCR ligase chain reaction
- Qbeta Replicase described in PCT Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. PCT/US 87/00880, incorporated herein by reference in its entirety, may also be used as still another amplification method in the present invention, i this method, a replicative sequence of RNA that has a region complementary to that of a target is added to a sample in the presence of an RNA polymerase. The polymerase will copy the replicative sequence that can then be detected.
- 5 '-[ ⁇ -thio] triphosphates in one strand of a restriction site may also be useful in the amplification of nucleic acids in the present invention.
- Strand Displacement Amplification is another method of carrying out isothermal amplification of nucleic acids which involves multiple rounds of strand displacement and synthesis, i.e. nick translation.
- a similar method, called Repair Chain Reaction (RCR) is another method of amplification which may be useful in the present invention and is involves annealing several probes throughout a region targeted for amplification, followed by a repair reaction in which only two of the four bases are present. The other two bases can be added as biotinylated derivatives for easy detection.
- RCR Repair Chain Reaction
- Sequences can also be detected using a cyclic probe reaction (CPR).
- CPR cyclic probe reaction
- a probe having a 3' and 5' sequences of non-target DNA and an internal or “middle" sequence of the target protein specific RNA is hybridized to DNA which is present in a sample.
- the reaction is treated with RNaseH, and the products of the probe are identified as distinctive products by generating a signal that is released after digestion.
- the original template is annealed to another cycling probe and the reaction is repeated.
- CPR involves amplifying a signal generated by hybridization of a probe to a target gene specific expressed nucleic acid.
- modified primers are used in a PCR-like, template and enzyme dependent synthesis.
- the primers may be modified by labeling with a capture moiety (e.g., biotin) and/or a detector moiety (e.g., enzyme).
- a capture moiety e.g., biotin
- a detector moiety e.g., enzyme
- an excess of labeled probes is added to a sample, hi the presence of the target sequence, the probe binds and is cleaved catalytically. After cleavage, the target sequence is released intact to be bound by excess probe. Cleavage of the labeled probe signals the presence of the target sequence.
- nucleic acid amplification procedures include transcription-based amphfication systems (TAS) (Kwoh et al, 1989; PCT Ml. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 88/10315, incorporated herein by reference in its entirety), including nucleic acid sequence based amplification (NASBA) and 3SR.
- TAS transcription-based amphfication systems
- NASBA nucleic acid sequence based amplification
- 3SR nucleic acid sequence based amplification
- the nucleic acids can be prepared for amplification by standard phenol/chloroform extraction, heat denaturation of a sample, treatment with lysis buffer and minispin columns for isolation of DNA and RNA or guanidinium chloride extraction of RNA.
- amplification techniques involve annealing a primer that has sequences specific to the target sequence.
- DNA/RNA hybrids are digested with RNase H while double stranded DNA molecules are heat-denatured again. In either case the single stranded DNA is made fully double stranded by addition of second target-specific primer, followed by polymerization.
- the double stranded DNA molecules are then multiply transcribed by a polymerase such as T7 or SP6.
- a polymerase such as T7 or SP6.
- the RNAs are reverse transcribed into DNA, and transcribed once again with a polymerase such as T7 or SP6.
- the resulting products whether truncated or complete, indicate target-specific sequences.
- ssRNA single-stranded RNA
- dsDNA double-stranded DNA
- the ssRNA is a first template for a first primer ohgonucleotide, which is elongated by reverse transcriptase (RNA-dependent DNA polymerase).
- RNA-dependent DNA polymerase reverse transcriptase
- the RNA is then removed from resulting DNA:RNA duplex by the action of ribonuclease H (RNase H, an RNase specific for RNA in a duplex with either DNA or RNA).
- RNase H ribonuclease H
- the resultant ssDNA is a second template for a second primer, which also includes the sequences of an RNA polymerase promoter (exemplified by T7 RNA polymerase) 5' to its homology to its template.
- This primer is then extended by DNA polymerase (exemplified by the large "Klenow" fragment of E. coli DNA polymerase I), resulting as a double-stranded DNA (“dsDNA”) molecule, having a sequence identical to that of the original RNA between the primers and having additionally, at one end, a promoter sequence.
- This promoter sequence can be used by the appropriate RNA polymerase to make many RNA copies of the DNA. These copies can then re-enter the cycle leading to very swift amplification. With proper choice of enzymes, this amplification can be done isothermally without addition of enzymes at each cycle. Because of the cyclical nature of this process, the starting sequence can be chosen to be in the form of either DNA or RNA.
- Methods based on ligation of two (or more) oligonucleotides in the presence of nucleic acid having the sequence of the resulting "di-oligonucleotide", thereby amplifying the di-oligonucleotide may also be used in the amplification of DNA sequences of the present invention.
- genetic constructs comprising one or more of the polynucleotides of the invention are introduced into cells in vivo. This may be achieved using any of a variety or well known approaches, several of which are outlined below for the purpose of illustration.
- adenovirus expression vector is meant to include those constructs containing adenovirus sequences sufficient to (a) support packaging of the construct and (b) to express a polynucleotide that has been cloned therein in a sense or antisense orientation.
- expression does not require that the gene product be synthesized.
- the expression vector comprises a genetically engineered form of an adenovirus.
- retrovirus the adenoviral infection of host cells does not result in chromosomal integration because adenoviral DNA can replicate in an episomal manner without potential genotoxicity.
- adenoviruses are structurally stable, and no genome reanangement has been detected after extensive amplification. Adenovirus can infect virtually all epithelial cells regardless of their cell cycle stage. So far, adenoviral infection appears to be linked only to mild disease such as acute respiratory disease in humans.
- Adenovirus is particularly suitable for use as a gene transfer vector because of its midsized genome, ease of manipulation, high titer, wide target-cell range and high infectivity. Both ends of the viral genome contain 100-200 base pair inverted repeats (ITRs), which are cis elements necessary for viral DNA replication and packaging.
- ITRs inverted repeats
- the early (E) and late (L) regions of the genome contain different transcription units that are divided by the onset of viral DNA replication.
- the El region (E1A and E1B) encodes proteins responsible for the regulation of transcription of the viral genome and a few cellular genes. The expression of the E2 region (E2A and E2B) results in the synthesis of the proteins for viral DNA replication.
- MLP major late promoter
- TPL 5'-tripartite leader
- recombinant adenovirus is generated from homologous recombination between shuttle vector and provirus vector. Due to the possible recombination between two proviral vectors, wild-type adenovirus may be generated from this process. Therefore, it is critical to isolate a single clone of virus from an individual plaque and examine its genomic structure.
- adenovirus vectors which are replication deficient, depend on a unique helper cell line, designated 293, which was transformed from human embryonic kidney cells by Ad5 DNA fragments and constitutively expresses El proteins (Graham et al, 1977). Since the E3 region is dispensable from the adenovirus genome (Jones and Shenk, 1978), the cunent adenovirus vectors, with the help of 293 cells, carry foreign DNA in either the El, the D3 or both regions (Graham and Prevec, 1991). h nature, adenovirus can package approximately 105% of the wild-type genome (Ghosh-Choudhury et al, 1987), providing capacity for about 2 extra kB of DNA.
- the maximum capacity of the cunent adenovirus vector is under 7.5 kB, or about 15% of the total length of the vector. More than 80%) of the adenovirus viral genome remains in the vector backbone and is the source of vector- borne cytotoxicity. Also, the replication deficiency of the El-deleted virus is incomplete. For example, leakage of viral gene expression has been observed with the cu ⁇ ently available vectors at high multiplicities of infection (MOT) (Mulligan, 1993).
- MOT multiplicities of infection
- Helper cell lines may be derived from human cells such as human embryonic kidney cells, muscle cells, hematopoietic cells or other human embryonic mesenchymal or epithelial cells.
- the helper cells may be derived from the cells of other mammalian species that are permissive for human adenovirus. Such cells include, e.g., Nero cells or other monkey embryonic mesenchymal or epithelial cells.
- the cu ⁇ ently prefened helper cell line is 293.
- Racher et al (1995) disclosed improved methods for culturing 293 cells and propagating adenovirus.
- natural cell aggregates are grown by inoculating individual cells into 1 liter siliconized spinner flasks (Techne, Cambridge, UK) containing 100- 200 ml of medium. Following stirring at 40 rpm, the cell viability is estimated with trypan blue.
- Fibra-Cel microcarriers (Bibby Sterlin, Stone, UK) (5 g/1) is employed as follows.
- the adenovirus may be of any of the 42 different known serotypes or subgroups A-F.
- Adenovirus type 5 of subgroup C is the prefened starting material in order to obtain a conditional replication-defective adenovirus vector for use in the present invention, since Adenovirus type 5 is a human adenovirus about which a great deal of biochemical and genetic information is known, and it has historically been used for most constructions employing adenovirus as a vector.
- the typical vector according to the present invention is replication defective and will not have an adenovirus El region.
- the position of insertion of the construct within the adenovirus sequences is not critical to the invention.
- the polynucleotide encoding the gene of interest may also be inserted in lieu of the deleted E3 region in E3 replacement vectors as described by Karlsson et al. (1986) or in the E4 region where a helper cell line or helper virus complements the E4 defect.
- Adenovirus is easy to grow and manipulate and exhibits broad host range in vitro and in vivo. This group of viruses can be obtained in high titers, e.g., 10 9 -10 ⁇ plaque-forming units per ml, and they are highly infective. The life cycle of adenovirus does not require integration into the host cell genome. The foreign genes delivered by adenovirus vectors are episomal and, therefore, have low genotoxicity to host cells. No side effects have been reported in studies of vaccination with wild-type adenovirus (Couch et al, 1963; Top et al, 1971), demonstrating their safety and therapeutic potential as in vivo gene transfer vectors. Adenovirus vectors have been used in eukaryotic gene expression (Levrero et al, 1991;
- the refroviruses are a group of single-stranded RNA viruses characterized by an ability to convert their RNA to double-stranded DNA in infected cells by a process of reverse- transcription (Coffin, 1990).
- the resulting DNA then stably integrates into cellular chromosomes as a provirus and directs synthesis of viral proteins.
- the integration results in the retention of the viral gene sequences in the recipient cell and its descendants.
- the retroviral genome contains three genes, gag, pol, and env that code for capsid proteins, polymerase enzyme, and envelope components, respectively.
- a sequence found upstream from the gag gene contains a signal for packaging of the genome into virions.
- Two long terminal repeat (LTR) sequences are present at the 5' and 3' ends of the viral genome. These contain strong promoter and enhancer sequences and are also required for integration in the host cell genome (Coffin, 1990).
- a nucleic acid encoding one or more ohgonucleotide or polynucleotide sequences of interest is inserted into the viral genome in the place of certain viral sequences to produce a virus that is replication-defective, hi order to produce virions, a packaging cell line containing the gag, pol, and env genes but without the LTR and packaging components is constructed (Mann et al, 1983).
- Retroviral vectors are able to infect a broad variety of cell types. However, integration and stable expression require the division of host cells (Paskind et al, 1975).
- AAV (Ridgeway, 1988; Hermonat and Muzycska, 1984) is a parovirus, discovered as a contamination of adenoviral stocks. It is a ubiquitous virus (antibodies are present in 85% of the US human population) that has not been linked to any disease. It is also classified as a dependoviras, because its replications is dependent on the presence of a helper virus, such as adenovirus. Five serotypes have been isolated, of which AAV-2 is the best characterized.
- AAV has a single-stranded linear DNA that is encapsidated into capsid proteins VP1, VP2 and VP3 to form an icosahedral virion of 20 to 24 nm in diameter (Muzyczka and McLaughlin, 1988).
- the AAV DNA is approximately 4.7 kilobases long. It contains two open reading frames and is flanked by two ITRs. There are two major genes in the AAV genome: rep and cap. The rep gene codes for proteins responsible for viral replications, whereas cap codes for capsid protein VP1-3. Each ITR forms a T-shaped hairpin structure. These terminal repeats are the only essential cis components of the AAV for chromosomal integration. Therefore, the AAV can be used as a vector with all viral coding sequences removed and replaced by the cassette of genes for delivery. Three viral promoters have been identified and named p5, pl9, and p40, according to their map position.
- AAV is also a good choice of delivery vehicles due to its safety. There is a relatively complicated rescue mechanism: not only wild type adenovirus but also AAV genes are required to mobilize rAAV. Likewise, AAV is not pathogenic and not associated with any disease. The removal of viral coding sequences minimizes immune reactions to viral gene expression, and therefore, rAAV does not evoke an inflammatory response.
- viral vectors may be employed as expression constructs in the present invention for the delivery of ohgonucleotide or polynucleotide sequences to a host cell.
- Vectors derived from viruses such as vaccinia virus (Ridgeway, 1988; Coupar et al, 1988), lentivirases, polio virases and herpes viruses may be employed. They offer several attractive features for various mammalian cells (Friedmann, 1989; Ridgeway, 1988; Coupar et al, 1988; Horwich et al, 1990).
- the expression construct In order to effect expression of the ohgonucleotide or polynucleotide sequences of the present invention, the expression construct must be delivered into a cell. This delivery may be accomplished in vitro, as in laboratory procedures for transforming cells lines, or in vivo or ex vivo, as in the treatment of certain disease states. As described above, one prefened mechanism for delivery is via viral infection where the expression construct is encapsulated in an infectious viral particle.
- the nucleic acid encoding the desired ohgonucleotide or polynucleotide sequences may be positioned and expressed at different sites, hi certain embodiments, the nucleic acid encoding the construct may be stably integrated into the genome of the cell. This integration may be in the specific location and orientation via homologous recombination (gene replacement) or it may be integrated in a random, non-specific location (gene augmentation), h yet further embodiments, the nucleic acid may be stably maintained in the cell as a separate, episomal segment of DNA. Such nucleic acid segments or "episomes" encode sequences sufficient to permit maintenance and replication independent of or in synchronization with the host cell cycle. How the expression construct is delivered to a cell and where in the cell the nucleic acid remains is dependent on the type of expression construct employed.
- the expression construct comprising one or more ohgonucleotide or polynucleotide sequences may simply consist of naked recombinant DNA or plasmids. Transfer of the construct may be performed by any of the methods mentioned above which physically or chemically permeabihze the cell membrane. This is particularly applicable for transfer in vitro but it may be applied to in vivo use as well. Dubensky et al. (1984) successfully injected polyomavirus DNA in the form of calcium phosphate precipitates into liver and spleen of adult and newborn mice demonstrating active viral replication and acute infection.
- Benvenisty and Reshef (1986) also demonstrated that direct intraperitoneal injection of calcium phosphate-precipitated plasmids results in expression of the transfected genes. It is envisioned that DNA encoding a gene of interest may also be transfe ⁇ ed in a similar manner in vivo and express the gene product.
- Another embodiment of the invention for transferring a naked DNA expression construct into cells may involve particle bombardment. This method depends on the ability to accelerate DNA-coated microprojectiles to a high velocity allowing them to pierce cell membranes and enter cells without killing them (Klein et al, 1987). Several devices for accelerating small particles have been developed. One such device relies on a high voltage discharge to generate an electrical cunent, which in turn provides the motive force (Yang et al, 1990). The microprojectiles used have consisted of biologically inert substances such as tungsten or gold beads.
- Selected organs including the liver, skin, and muscle tissue of rats and mice have been bombarded in vivo (Yang et al, 1990; Zelenin et al, 1991). This may require surgical exposure of the tissue or cells, to eliminate any intervening tissue between the gun and the target organ, i. e. ex vivo treatment. Again, DNA encoding a particular gene may be delivered via this method and still be incorporated by the present invention.
- the end result of the flow of genetic information is the synthesis of protein.
- DNA is transcribed by polymerases into messenger RNA and translated on the ribosome to yield a folded, functional protein.
- the native DNA segment coding for a polypeptide described herein, as all such mammalian DNA strands, has two strands: a sense strand and an antisense strand held together by hydrogen bonding.
- the messenger RNA coding for polypeptide has the same nucleotide sequence as the sense DNA strand except that the DNA thymidine is replaced by uridine.
- synthetic antisense nucleotide sequences will bind to a mRNA and inhibit expression of the protein encoded by that mRNA.
- antisense oligonucleotides to mRNA is thus one mechanism to shut down protein synthesis, and, consequently, represents a powerful and targeted therapeutic approach.
- the synthesis of polygalactauronase and the muscarine type 2 acetylcholine receptor are inhibited by antisense oligonucleotides directed to their respective mRNA sequences (U. S. Patent 5,739,119 and U. S. Patent 5,759,829, each specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety).
- antisense inhibition have been demonstrated with the nuclear protein cyclin, the multiple drug resistance gene (MDG1), ICAM-1, E-selectin, STK-1, striatal GABA A receptor and human EGF (Jaskulski et al, 1988; Vasanthakumar and Ahmed, 1989; Peris et al, 1998; U. S. Patent 5,801,154; U. S. Patent 5,789,573; U. S. Patent 5,718,709 and U. S. Patent 5,610,288, each specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety).
- Antisense constructs have also been described that inhibit and can be used to treat a variety of abnormal cellular proliferations, e.g. cancer (U. S. Patent 5,747,470; U. S. Patent 5,591,317 and U. S. Patent 5,783,683, each specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety).
- the invention provides ohgonucleotide sequences that comprise all, or a portion of, any sequence that is capable of specifically binding to polynucleotide sequence described herein, or a complement thereof.
- the antisense oligonucleotides comprise DNA or derivatives thereof.
- the oligonucleotides comprise DNA or derivatives thereof.
- oligonucleotides comprise RNA or derivatives thereof.
- the oligonucleotides are modified DNAs comprising a phosphorothioated modified backbone.
- the ohgonucleotide sequences comprise peptide nucleic acids or derivatives thereof.
- prefened compositions comprise a sequence region that is complementary, and more preferably substantially-complementary, and even more preferably, completely complementary to one or more portions of polynucleotides disclosed herein.
- antisense compositions specific for a given gene sequence is based upon analysis of the chosen target sequence (i.e. in these illustrative examples the rat and human sequences) and determination of secondary structure, T m , binding energy, relative stability, and antisense compositions were selected based upon their relative inability to form dimers, hairpins, or other secondary structures that would reduce or prohibit specific binding to the target mRNA in a host cell.
- Highly prefened target regions of the mRNA are those which are at or near the AUG translation initiation codon, and those sequences which were substantially complementary to 5' regions of the mRNA.
- MPG short peptide vector
- the use of an antisense delivery method employing a short peptide vector, termed MPG (27 residues), is also contemplated.
- the MPG peptide contains a hydrophobic domain derived from the fusion sequence of HEV gp41 and a hydrophilic domain from the nuclear localization sequence of SV40 T-antigen (Morris et al, 1997). It has been demonstrated that several molecules of the MPG peptide coat the antisense oligonucleotides and can be delivered into cultured mammalian cells in less than 1 hour with relatively high efficiency (90%). Further, the interaction with MPG strongly increases both the stability of the ohgonucleotide to nuclease and the ability to cross the plasma membrane (Morris et al, 1997). 4.17 RIBOZYMES
- Ribozymes are RNA-protein complexes that cleave nucleic acids in a site-specific fashion. Ribozymes have specific catalytic domains that possess endonuclease activity (Kim and Cech, 1987; Gerlach et al, 1987; Forster and Symons, 1987).
- ribozymes accelerate phosphoester transfer reactions with a high degree of specificity, often cleaving only one of several phosphoesters in an ohgonucleotide substrate (Cech et al, 1981; Michel and Westhof, 1990; Reinhold-Hurek and Shub, 1992).
- This specificity has been attributed to the requirement that the substrate bind via specific base-pairing interactions to the internal guide sequence ("IGS") of the ribozyme prior to chemical reaction.
- IGS internal guide sequence
- Ribozyme catalysis has primarily been observed as part of sequence-specific cleavage/ligation reactions involving nucleic acids (Joyce, 1989; Cech et al, 1981).
- U. S. Patent No. 5,354,855 reports that certain ribozymes can act as endonucleases with a sequence specificity greater than that of known ribonucleases and approaching that of the DNA restriction enzymes.
- sequence- specific ribozyme-mediated inhibition of gene expression may be particularly suited to therapeutic applications (Scanlon et al, 1991; Sarver et al, 1990).
- ribozymes elicited genetic changes in some cells lines to which they were applied; the altered genes included the oncogenes H-r ⁇ .s, e-fos and genes of HEV. Most of this work involved the modification of a target mRNA, based on a specific mutant codon that is cleaved by a specific ribozyme.
- enzymatic nucleic acids act by first binding to a target RNA. Such binding occurs through the target binding portion of a enzymatic nucleic acid which is held in close proximity to an enzymatic portion of the molecule that acts to cleave the target RNA. Thus, the enzymatic nucleic acid first recognizes and then binds a target RNA through complementary base-pairing, and once bound to the conect site, acts enzymatically to cut the target RNA.
- RNA Strategic cleavage of such a target RNA will destroy its ability to direct synthesis of an encoded protein. After an enzymatic nucleic acid has bound and cleaved its RNA target, it is released from that RNA to search for another target and can repeatedly bind and cleave new targets.
- the enzymatic nature of a ribozyme is advantageous over many technologies, such as antisense technology (where a nucleic acid molecule simply binds to a nucleic acid target to block its translation) since the concentration of ribozyme necessary to affect a therapeutic treatment is lower than that of an antisense ohgonucleotide. This advantage reflects the ability of the ribozyme to act enzymatically.
- a single ribozyme molecule is able to cleave many molecules of target RNA.
- the ribozyme is a highly specific inhibitor, with the specificity of inhibition depending not only on the base pairing mechanism of binding to the target RNA, but also on the mechanism of target RNA cleavage.
- Single mismatches, or base- substitutions, near the site of cleavage can completely eliminate catalytic activity of a ribozyme. Similar mismatches in antisense molecules do not prevent their action (Woolf et al, 1992).
- the specificity of action of a ribozyme is greater than that of an antisense ohgonucleotide binding the same RNA site.
- the enzymatic nucleic acid molecule may be formed in a hammerhead, hairpin, a hepatitis ⁇ virus, group I intron or RNaseP RNA (in association with an RNA guide sequence) or Neurospora VS RNA motif.
- hammerhead motifs are described by Rossi et al. (1992).
- hairpin motifs are described by Hampel et al. (Eur. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. EP 0360257), Hampel and Tritz (1989), Hampel et al. (1990) and U. S. Patent 5,631,359 (specifically incorporated herein by reference).
- hepatitis ⁇ virus motif is described by Pe ⁇ otta and Been (1992); an example of the RNaseP motif is described by Guerrier-Takada et al. (1983); Neurospora VS RNA ribozyme motif is described by Collins (Saville and Collins, 1990; Saville and Collins, 1991; Collins and Olive, 1993); and an example of the Group I intron is described in (U. S. Patent 4,987,071, specifically incorporated herein by reference).
- an enzymatic nucleic acid molecule of this invention has a specific substrate binding site which is complementary to one or more of the target gene RNA regions, and that it have nucleotide sequences within or sunounding that substrate binding site which impart an RNA cleaving activity to the molecule.
- the ribozyme constructs need not be limited to specific motifs mentioned herein. h certain embodiments, it may be important to produce enzymatic cleaving agents which exhibit a high degree of specificity for the RNA of a desired target, such as one of the sequences disclosed herein.
- the enzymatic nucleic acid molecule is preferably targeted to a highly conserved sequence region of a target mRNA.
- Such enzymatic nucleic acid molecules can be delivered exogenously to specific cells as required.
- the ribozymes can be expressed from DNA or RNA vectors that are delivered to specific cells.
- Small enzymatic nucleic acid motifs e.g., of the hammerhead or the hairpin structure
- the simple structure of these molecules increases the ability of the enzymatic nucleic acid to invade targeted regions of the mRNA structure.
- catalytic RNA molecules can be expressed within cells from eukaryotic promoters (e.g., Scanlon et al, 1991; Kashani-Sabet et al, 1992; Dropulic et al, 1992; Weerasinghe et al, 1991; Ojwang et al, 1992; Chen et al, 1992; Sarver et al, 1990).
- eukaryotic promoters e.g., Scanlon et al, 1991; Kashani-Sabet et al, 1992; Dropulic et al, 1992; Weerasinghe et al, 1991; Ojwang et al, 1992; Chen et al, 1992; Sarver et al, 1990.
- any ribozyme can be expressed in eukaryotic cells from the appropriate DNA vector.
- the activity of such ribozymes can be augmented by their release from the primary transcript by a second ribozyme (Int. Pat. App
- Ribozymes may be added directly, or can be complexed with cationic lipids, lipid complexes, packaged within liposomes, or otherwise delivered to target cells.
- the RNA or RNA complexes can be locally administered to relevant tissues ex vivo, or in vivo through injection, aerosol inhalation, infusion pump or stent, with or without their incorporation in biopolymers.
- Ribozymes maybe designed as described in Int. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 93/23569 and frit. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 94/02595, each specifically incorporated herein by reference) and synthesized to be tested in vitro and in vivo, as described. Such ribozymes can also be optimized for delivery. While specific examples are provided, those in the art will recognize that equivalent RNA targets in other species can be utilized when necessary.
- Hammerhead or hairpin ribozymes may be individually analyzed by computer folding (Jaeger et al, 1989) to assess whether the ribozyme sequences fold into the appropriate secondary structure. Those ribozymes with unfavorable intramolecular interactions between the binding arms and the catalytic core are eliminated from consideration. Varying binding arm lengths can be chosen to optimize activity. Generally, at least 5 or so bases on each arm are able to bind to, or otherwise interact with, the target RNA.
- Ribozymes of the hammerhead or hairpin motif may be designed to anneal to various sites in the mRNA message, and can be chemically synthesized.
- the method of synthesis used follows the procedure for normal RNA synthesis as described in Usman et al. (1987) and in
- Ribozymes may be modified extensively to enhance stability by modification with nuclease resistant groups, for example, 2'-amino, 2'-C-allyl, 2'-flouro, 2'-o-methyl, 2'-H (for a review see e.g., Usman and Cedergren, 1992). Ribozymes may be purified by gel electrophoresis using general methods or by high pressure liquid chromatography and resuspended in water. Ribozyme activity can be optimized by altering the length of the ribozyme binding arms, or chemically synthesizing ribozymes with modifications that prevent their degradation by serum ribonucleases (see e.g., Int. Pat. Appl. Publ. No.
- Ribozymes may be administered to cells by a variety of methods known to those familiar to the art, including, but not restricted to, encapsulation in liposomes, by iontophoresis, or by incorporation into other vehicles, such as hydrogels, cyclodextrins, biodegradable nanocapsules, and bioadhesive microspheres.
- ribozymes may be directly delivered ex vivo to cells or tissues with or without the aforementioned vehicles.
- the RNA/vehicle combination may be locally delivered by direct inhalation, by direct injection or by use of a catheter, infusion pump or stent.
- routes of delivery include, but are not limited to, intravascular, intramuscular, subcutaneous or joint injection, aerosol inhalation, oral (tablet or pill form), topical, systemic, ocular, intraperitoneal and/or intrathecal delivery. More detailed descriptions of ribozyme delivery and administration are provided in t. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 94/02595 and Int. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 93/23569, each specifically incorporated herein by reference.
- RNA polymerase I RNA polymerase I
- RNA polymerase II RNA polymerase II
- pol HI RNA polymerase HI
- Transcripts from pol Et or pol III promoters will be expressed at high levels in all cells; the levels of a given pol EE promoter in a given cell type will depend on the nature of the gene regulatory sequences (enhancers, silencers, etc.) present nearby.
- Prokaryotic RNA polymerase promoters may also be used, providing that the prokaryotic RNA polymerase enzyme is expressed in the appropriate cells (Elroy-Stein and Moss, 1990; Gao and Huang, 1993; Lieber et al, 1993; Zhou et al, 1990). Ribozymes expressed from such promoters can function in mammalian cells (e.g. Kashani-Saber et al, 1992; Ojwang et al, 1992; Chen et al, 1992; Yu et al, 1993; L'Huillier et al, 1992; Lisziewicz et al, 1993).
- transcription units can be incorporated into a variety of vectors for introduction into mammalian cells, including but not restricted to, plasmid DNA vectors, viral DNA vectors (such as adenovirus or adeno-associated vectors), or viral RNA vectors (such as retroviral, semliki forest virus, Sindbis virus vectors).
- plasmid DNA vectors such as adenovirus or adeno-associated vectors
- viral RNA vectors such as retroviral, semliki forest virus, Sindbis virus vectors.
- Ribozymes may be used as diagnostic tools to examine genetic drift and mutations within diseased cells. They can also be used to assess levels of the target RNA molecule. The close relationship between ribozyme activity and the structure of the target RNA allows the detection of mutations in any region of the molecule which alters the base-pairing and three- dimensional structure of the target RNA. By using multiple ribozymes, one may map nucleotide changes which are important to RNA structure and function in vitro, as well as in cells and tissues. Cleavage of target RNAs with ribozymes may be used to inhibit gene expression and define the role (essentially) of specified gene products in the progression of disease, i this manner, other genetic targets may be defined as important mediators of the disease.
- ribozymes targeted to different genes, ribozymes coupled with known small molecule inhibitors, or intermittent treatment with combinations of ribozymes and or other chemical or biological molecules.
- Other in vitro uses of ribozymes are well known in the art, and include detection of the presence of mRNA associated with an EL-5 related condition. Such RNA is detected by determining the presence of a cleavage product after treatment with a ribozyme using standard methodology.
- PNA peptide nucleic acids
- PNA is a DNA mimic in which the nucleobases are attached to a pseudopeptide backbone (Good and Nielsen, 1997).
- PNA is able to be utilized in a number methods that traditionally have used RNA or DNA. Often PNA sequences perform better in techniques than the conesponding RNA or DNA sequences and have utilities that are not inherent to RNA or DNA.
- a review of PNA including methods of making, characteristics of, and methods of using, is provided by Corey (1997) and is incorporated herein by reference.
- PNAs have 2-aminoethyl-glycine linkages replacing the normal phosphodiester backbone of DNA (Nielsen et al, 1991; Hanvey et al, 1992; Hyrup and Nielsen, 1996; Neilsen, 1996).
- PNAs are neutral molecules
- PNAs are achiral, which avoids the need to develop a stereoselective synthesis
- PNA synthesis uses standard Boc (Dueholm et al, 1994) or Fmoc (Thomson et al, 1995) protocols for sohd-phase peptide synthesis, although other methods, including a modified Merrifield method, have been used (Christensen et al, 1995).
- PNA monomers or ready-made oligomers are commercially available from PerSeptive Biosystems (Framingham, MA). PNA syntheses by either Boc or Fmoc protocols are straightforward using manual or automated protocols (Norton et al, 1995). The manual protocol lends itself to the production of chemically modified PNAs or the simultaneous synthesis of families of closely related PNAs.
- PNAs can incorporate any combination of nucleotide bases
- the presence of adjacent purines can lead to deletions of one or more residues in the product, hi expectation of this difficulty, it is suggested that, in producing PNAs with adjacent purines, one should repeat the coupling of residues likely to be added inefficiently. This should be followed by the purification of PNAs by reverse-phase high- pressure liquid chromatography (Norton et al, 1995) providing yields and purity of product similar to those observed during the synthesis of peptides.
- Modifications of PNAs for a given application may be accomplished by coupling amino acids during solid-phase synthesis or by attaching compounds that contain a carboxylic acid group to the exposed N-terminal amine.
- PNAs can be modified after synthesis by coupling to an introduced lysine or cysteine. The ease with which PNAs can be modified facilitates optimization for better solubility or for specific functional requirements. Once synthesized, the identity of PNAs and their derivatives can be confirmed by mass spectrometry.
- PNAs lack 3' to 5' polarity and can bind in either parallel or anti-parallel fashion, with the anti-parallel mode being prefened (Egholm et al, 1993).
- Hybridization of DNA oligonucleotides to DNA and RNA is destabilized by electrostatic repulsion between the negatively charged phosphate backbones of the complementary strands.
- the absence of charge repulsion in PNA-DNA or PNA- RNA duplexes increases the melting temperature (E m ) and reduces the dependence of T m on the concentration of mono- or divalent cations (Nielsen et al, 1991).
- E m melting temperature
- T m concentration of mono- or divalent cations
- a single mismatch within a 16 bp PNA-DNA duplex can reduce the T m by up to 15°C (Egholm et al, 1993).
- This high level of discrimination has allowed the development of several PNA-based strategies for the analysis of point mutations (Wang et al, 1996; Carlsson et al, 1996; Thiede et al, 1996; Webb and Hurskainen, 1996; Perry-O'Keefe et al, 1996).
- High-affinity binding provides clear advantages for molecular recognition and the development of new applications for PNAs.
- 11-13 nucleotide PNAs inhibit the activity of telomerase, a ribonucleo-protein that extends telomere ends using an essential RNA template, while the analogous DNA oligomers do not (Norton et al, 1996).
- Neutral PNAs are more hydrophobic than analogous DNA oligomers, and this can lead to difficulty solubilizing them at neutral pH, especially if the PNAs have a high purine content or if they have the potential to form secondary structures. Their solubility can be enhanced by attaching one or more positive charges to the PNA termini (Nielsen et al, 1991).
- Rose uses capillary gel elecfrophoresis to determine binding of PNAs to their complementary ohgonucleotide, measuring the relative binding kinetics and stoichiometry. Similar types of measurements were made by Jensen et al. using BIAcoreTM technology.
- PNAs include use in DNA strand invasion (Nielsen et al, 1991), antisense inhibition (Hanvey et al, 1992), mutational analysis (Orum et al, 1993), enhancers of transcription (Mollegaard et al, 1994), nucleic acid purification (Orum et al, 1995), isolation of transcriptionally active genes (Boffa et al, 1995), blocking of transcription factor binding (Nickers et al, 1995), genome cleavage (Veselkov et al, 1996), biosensors (Wang et al, 1996), in situ hybridization (Thisted et al, 1996), and in a alternative to Southern blotting (Perry- O'Keefe, 1996).
- a polypeptide of the invention will be an isolated polypeptide (or an epitope, variant, or active fragment thereof) derived from a mammalian species.
- the polypeptide is encoded by a polynucleotide sequence disclosed herein or a sequence which hybridizes under moderately stringent conditions to a polynucleotide sequence disclosed herein.
- the polypeptide may be defined as a polypeptide which comprises a contiguous amino acid sequence from an amino acid sequence disclosed herein, or which polypeptide comprises an entire amino acid sequence disclosed herein.
- a polypeptide composition is also understood to comprise one or more polypeptides that are immunologically reactive with antibodies generated against a polypeptide of the invention, particularly a polypeptide having the amino acid sequence encoded by the disclosed polynucleotides, or to active fragments, or to variants or biological functional equivalents thereof.
- a polypeptide composition of the present invention is understood to comprise one or more polypeptides that are capable of eliciting antibodies that are immunologically reactive with one or more polypeptides encoded by one or more contiguous nucleic acid sequences disclosed in this application, or to active fragments, or to variants thereof, or to one or more nucleic acid sequences which hybridize to one or more of these sequences under conditions of moderate to high stringency.
- an active fragment of a polypeptide includes a whole or a portion of a polypeptide which is modified by conventional techniques, e.g., mutagenesis, or by addition, deletion, or substitution, but which active fragment exhibits substantially the same structure function, antigenicity, etc., as a polypeptide as described herein.
- the polypeptides of the invention will comprise at least an immunogenic portion of a hematological malignancy-related tumor protein or a variant thereof, as described herein.
- a "hematological malignancy-related tumor protein” is a protein that is expressed by hematological malignancy-related tumor cells. Proteins that are hematological malignancy-related tumor proteins also react detectably within an immunoassay (such as an ELISA) with antisera from a patient with hematological malignancy.
- Polypeptides as described herein may be of any length. Additional sequences derived from the native protein and/or heterologous sequences may be present, and such sequences may (but need not) possess further immunogenic or antigenic properties.
- immunogenic portion is a portion of a protein that is recognized
- Such immunogenic portions generally comprise at least 5 amino acid residues, more preferably at least 10, and still more preferably at least 20 amino acid residues of a hematological malignancy-related tumor protein or a variant thereof.
- Certain prefe ⁇ ed immunogenic portions include peptides in which an N-terminal leader sequence and/or transmembrane domain have been deleted.
- Other prefened immunogenic portions may contain a small N- and/or C-terminal deletion (e.g., 1-30 amino acids, preferably 5-15 amino acids), relative to the mature protein.
- Immunogenic portions may generally be identified using well known techniques, such as those summarized in Paul, Fundamental Immunology, 3rd ed., 243-247 (Raven Press, 1993) and references cited therein. Such techniques include screening polypeptides for the ability to react with antigen-specific antibodies, antisera and/or T-cell lines or clones.
- antisera and antibodies are "antigen-specific” if they specifically bind to an antigen (i.e., they react with the protein in an ELISA or other immunoassay, and do not react detectably with unrelated proteins).
- antisera and antibodies may be prepared as described herein, and using well known techniques.
- An immunogenic portion of a native hematological malignancy- related tumor protein is a portion that reacts with such antisera and/or T-cells at a level that is not substantially less than the reactivity of the full length polypeptide (e.g., in an ELISA and/or T-cell reactivity assay). Such immunogenic portions may react within such assays at a level that is similar to or greater than the reactivity of the full length polypeptide.
- Such screens may generally be performed using methods well known to those of ordinary skill in the art, such as those described in Harlow and Lane, Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, 1988.
- a polypeptide may be immobilized on a sohd support and contacted with patient sera to allow binding of antibodies within the sera to the immobilized polypeptide. Unbound sera may then be removed and bound antibodies detected using, for example, 125 I-labeled Protein A.
- a composition may comprise a variant of a native hematological malignancy-related tumor protein.
- a polypeptide "variant,” as used herein, is a polypeptide that differs from a native hematological malignancy-related tumor protein in one or more substitutions, deletions, additions and/or insertions, such that the immunogenicity of the polypeptide is not substantially diminished, h other words, the ability of a variant to react with antigen-specific antisera may be enhanced or unchanged, relative to the native protein, or may be diminished by less than 50%>, and preferably less than 20%>, relative to the native protein.
- variants may generally be identified by modifying one of the above polypeptide sequences and evaluating the reactivity of the modified polypeptide with antigen-specific antibodies or antisera as described herein.
- Prefened variants include those in which one or more portions, such as an N-terminal leader sequence or transmembrane domain, have been removed.
- Other prefened variants include variants in which a small portion (e.g., 1-30 amino acids, preferably 5-15 amino acids) has been removed from the N- and/or C-terminal of the mature protein.
- Polypeptide variants encompassed by the present invention include those exhibiting at least about 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, or 99% or more identity (determined as described above) to the polypeptides disclosed herein.
- a variant contains conservative substitutions.
- a "conservative substitution” is one in which an amino acid is substituted for another amino acid that has similar properties, such that one skilled in the art of peptide chemistry would expect the secondary structure and hydropathic nature of the polypeptide to be substantially unchanged.
- Amino acid substitutions may generally be made on the basis of similarity in polarity, charge, solubility, hydrophobicity, hydrophilicity and or the amphipathic nature of the residues.
- negatively charged amino acids include aspartic acid and glutamic acid
- positively charged amino acids include lysine and arginine
- amino acids with uncharged polar head groups having similar hydrophilicity values include leucine, isoleucine and valine; glycine and alanine; asparagine and glutamine; and serine, threonine, phenylalanine and tyrosine.
- variants may also, or alternatively, contain nonconservative changes, h a prefened embodiment, variant polypeptides differ from a native sequence by substitution, deletion or addition of five amino acids or fewer. Variants may also (or alternatively) be modified by, for example, the deletion or addition of amino acids that have minimal influence on the immunogenicity, secondary structure and hydropathic nature of the polypeptide.
- polypeptides may comprise a signal (or leader) sequence at the N- terminal end of the protein, which co-translationally or post-translationally directs transfer of the protein.
- the polypeptide may also be conjugated to a linker or other sequence for ease of synthesis, purification or identification of the polypeptide (e.g., poly-His), or to enhance binding of the polypeptide to a solid support.
- a polypeptide may be conjugated to an immunoglobulin Fc region.
- Polypeptides may be prepared using any of a variety of well known techniques. Recombinant polypeptides encoded by DNA sequences as described above may be readily prepared from the DNA sequences using any of a variety of expression vectors known to those of ordinary skill in the art. Expression may be achieved in any appropriate host cell that has been transformed or transfected with an expression vector containing a DNA molecule that encodes a recombinant polypeptide. Suitable host cells include prokaryotes, yeast, and higher eukaryotic cells, such as mammalian cells and plant cells. Preferably, the host cells employed are E. coli, yeast or a mammalian cell line such as COS or CHO.
- Supernatants from suitable host/vector systems which secrete recombinant protein or polypeptide into culture media may be first concentrated using a commercially available filter. Following concentration, the concentrate may be applied to a suitable purification matrix such as an affinity matrix or an ion exchange resin. Finally, one or more reverse phase HPLC steps can be employed to further purify a recombinant polypeptide.
- a suitable purification matrix such as an affinity matrix or an ion exchange resin.
- Portions and other variants having less than about 100 amino acids, and generally less than about 50 amino acids may also be generated by synthetic means, using techniques well known to those of ordinary skill in the art.
- polypeptides may be synthesized using any of the commercially available solid-phase techniques, such as the Merrifield solid- phase synthesis method, where amino acids are sequentially added to a growing amino acid chain. See Merrifield, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 55:2149-2146, 1963.
- Equipment for automated synthesis of polypeptides is commercially available from suppliers such as Perkin Elmer/ Applied BioSystems Division (Foster City, CA), and may be operated according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- a polypeptide may be a fusion protein that comprises multiple polypeptides as described herein, or that comprises at least one polypeptide as described herein and an unrelated sequence, such as a known tumor protein.
- a fusion partner may, for example, assist in providing T helper epitopes (an immunological fusion partner), preferably T helper epitopes recognized by humans, or may assist in expressing the protein (an expression enhancer) at higher yields than the native recombinant protein.
- Certain prefened fusion partners are both immunological and expression enhancing fusion partners.
- Other fusion partners may be selected so as to increase the solubility of the protein or to enable the protein to be targeted to desired intracellular compartments.
- Still further fusion partners include affinity tags, which facilitate purification of the protein.
- Fusion proteins may generally be prepared using standard techniques, including chemical conjugation.
- a fusion protein is expressed as a recombinant protein, allowing the production of increased levels, relative to a non-fused protein, in an expression system.
- DNA sequences encoding the polypeptide components may be assembled separately, and ligated into an appropriate expression vector.
- the 3' end of the DNA sequence encoding one polypeptide component is ligated, with or without a peptide linker, to the 5' end of a DNA sequence encoding the second polypeptide component so that the reading frames of the sequences are in phase. This permits translation into a single fusion protein that retains the biological activity of both component polypeptides.
- a peptide linker sequence may be employed to separate the first and second polypeptide components by a distance sufficient to ensure that each polypeptide folds into its secondary and tertiary structures.
- Such a peptide linker sequence is incorporated into the fusion protein using standard techniques well known in the art.
- Suitable peptide linker sequences may be chosen based on the following factors: (1) their ability to adopt a flexible extended conformation; (2) their inability to adopt a secondary structure that could interact with functional epitopes on the first and second polypeptides; and (3) the lack of hydrophobic or charged residues that might react with the polypeptide functional epitopes.
- Prefened peptide linker sequences contain Gly, Asn and Ser residues.
- linker sequences which may be usefully employed as linkers include those disclosed in Maratea et al, Gene 40:39-46, 1985; Murphy et al, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 53:8258-8262, 1986; U.S. Patent No. 4,935,233 and U.S. Patent No. 4,751,180.
- the linker sequence may generally be from 1 to about 50 amino acids in length. Linker sequences are not required when the first and second polypeptides have non-essential N-terminal amino acid regions that can be used to separate the functional domains and prevent steric interference.
- the ligated DNA sequences are operably linked to suitable transcriptional or translational regulatory elements.
- the regulatory elements responsible for expression of DNA are located only 5' to the DNA sequence encoding the first polypeptides.
- stop codons required to end translation and transcription termination signals are only present 3' to the DNA sequence encoding the second polypeptide.
- Fusion proteins are also provided. Such proteins comprise a polypeptide as described herein together with an unrelated immunogenic protein. Preferably the immunogenic protein is capable of eliciting a recall response. Examples of such proteins include tetanus, tuberculosis and hepatitis proteins (see, for example, Stoute et al New Engl J. Med., 335:86-91, 1997).
- an immunological fusion partner is derived from protein D, a surface protein of the gram-negative bacterium Haemopbilus influenza B (WO 91/18926).
- a protein D derivative comprises approximately the first third of the protein (e.g., the first N-teiminal 100-110 amino acids), and a protein D derivative may be lipidated.
- the first 109 residues of a Lipoprotein D fusion partner is included on the N-terminus to provide the polypeptide with additional exogenous T-cell epitopes and to increase the expression level in E. coli (thus functioning as an expression enhancer).
- the lipid tail ensures optimal presentation of the antigen to antigen presenting cells.
- Other fusion partners include the non-structural protein from influenzae virus, NS1 (hemagglutinin). Typically, the N-terminal 81 amino acids are used, although different fragments that include T-helper epitopes maybe used.
- the immunological fusion partner is the protein known as LYTA, or a portion thereof (preferably a C-termhial portion).
- LYTA is derived from Streptococcus pneumoniae, which synthesizes an N-acetyl-L-alanine amidase known as amidase LYTA (encoded by the LytA gene; Gene 43:265-292, 1986).
- LYTA is an autolysin that specifically degrades certain bonds in the peptidoglycan backbone.
- the C-terminal domain of the LYTA protein is responsible for the affinity to the choline or to some choline analogues such as DEAE. This property has been exploited for the development of E.
- coli C-LYTA expressing plasmids useful for expression of fusion proteins. Purification of hybrid proteins containing the C-LYTA fragment at the amino terminus has been described (see Biotechnology 70:795-798, 1992). Within a prefened embodiment, a repeat portion of LYTA may be incorporated into a fusion protein. A repeat portion is found in the C-terminal region starting at residue 178. A particularly prefened repeat portion incorporates residues 188-305. hi general, polypeptides (including fusion proteins) and polynucleotides as described herein are isolated. An "isolated" polypeptide or polynucleotide is one that is removed from its original environment.
- a naturally-occurring protein is isolated if it is separated from some or all of the coexisting materials in the natural system.
- polypeptides are at least about 90% pure, more preferably at least about 95%> pure and most preferably at least about 99% pure.
- a polynucleotide is considered to be isolated if, for example, it is cloned into a vector that is not a part of the natural environment.
- the present invention further employs agents, such as antibodies and antigen-binding fragments thereof, that specifically bind to a hematological malignancy-related antigen.
- agents such as antibodies and antigen-binding fragments thereof, that specifically bind to a hematological malignancy-related antigen.
- an antibody, or antigen-binding fragment thereof is said to "specifically bind" to a hematological malignancy-related antigen if it reacts at a detectable level (within, for example, an ELISA) with , and does not react detectably with unrelated proteins under similar conditions.
- binding refers to a noncovalent association between two separate molecules such that a complex is formed.
- the ability to bind may be evaluated by, for example, determining a binding constant for the formation of the complex.
- the binding constant is the value obtained when the concentration of the complex is divided by the product of the component concentrations.
- two compounds are said to "bind,” in the context of the present invention, when the binding constant for complex formation exceeds about 10 3 L/mol.
- the binding constant maybe determined using methods well known in the art.
- Binding agents may be further capable of differentiating between patients with and without a hematological malignancy. Such binding agents generate a signal indicating the presence of a hematological malignancy in at least about 20% of patients with the disease, and will generate a negative signal indicating the absence of the disease in at least about 90%> of individuals without the disease.
- biological samples e.g., blood, sera, urine and/or tumor biopsies
- a hematological malignancy as determined using standard clinical tests
- a binding agent may be a ribosome, with or without a peptide component, an RNA molecule or a polypeptide.
- a binding agent is an antibody or an antigen-binding fragment thereof.
- Antibodies may be prepared by any of a variety of techniques known to those of ordinary skill in the art. See, e.g., Harlow and Lane, Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, 1988.
- antibodies can be produced by cell culture techniques, including the generation of monoclonal antibodies as described herein, or via transfection of antibody genes into suitable bacterial or mammalian cell hosts, in order to allow for the production of recombinant antibodies.
- an immunogen comprising the polypeptide is initially injected into any of a wide variety of mammals (e.g., mice, rats, rabbits, sheep or goats).
- the polypeptides of this invention may serve as the immunogen without modification.
- a superior immune response may be elicited if the polypeptide is joined to a carrier protein, such as bovine serum albumin or keyhole limpet hemocyanin.
- the immunogen is injected into the animal host, preferably according to a predetermined schedule incorporating one or more booster immunizations, and the animals are bled periodically.
- Polyclonal antibodies specific for the polypeptide may then be purified from such antisera by, for example, affinity chromatography using the polypeptide coupled to a suitable sohd support.
- Monoclonal antibodies specific for an antigenic polypeptide of interest maybe prepared, for example, using the technique of Kohler and Milstein, Eur. J. Immunol 6:511-519, 1976, and improvements thereto. Briefly, these methods involve the preparation of immortal cell lines capable of producing antibodies havmg the desired specificity (i.e., reactivity with the polypeptide of interest). Such cell lines may be produced, for example, from spleen cells obtained from an animal immunized as described above. The spleen cells are then immortalized by, for example, fusion with a myeloma cell fusion partner, preferably one that is syngeneic with the immunized animal. A variety of fusion techniques may be employed.
- the spleen cells and myeloma cells may be combined with a nonionic detergent for a few minutes and then plated at low density on a selective medium that supports the growth of hybrid cells, but not myeloma cells.
- a prefened selection technique uses HAT (hypoxanthine, aminopterin, thymidine) selection. After a sufficient time, usually about 1 to 2 weeks, colonies of hybrids are observed. Single colonies are selected and their culture supernatants tested for binding activity against the polypeptide. Hybridomas having high reactivity and specificity are prefe ⁇ ed.
- Monoclonal antibodies may be isolated from the supernatants of growing hybridoma colonies, hi addition, various techniques may be employed to enhance the yield, such as injection of the hybridoma cell line into the peritoneal cavity of a suitable vertebrate host, such as a mouse. Monoclonal antibodies may then be harvested from the ascites fluid or the blood. Contaminants may be removed from the antibodies by conventional techniques, such as chromatography, gel filtration, precipitation, and extraction. The polypeptides of this invention may be used in the purification process in, for example, an affinity chromatography step. Within certain embodiments, the use of antigen-binding fragments of antibodies may be prefened. Such fragments include Fab fragments, which may be prepared using standard techniques.
- immunoglobulins may be purified from rabbit senrm by affinity chromatography on Protein A bead columns (Harlow and Lane, Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, 1988) and digested by papain to yield Fab and Fc fragments.
- the Fab and Fc fragments may be separated by affinity chromatography on protein A bead columns.
- Monoclonal antibodies, and fragments thereof, of the present invention may be coupled to one or more therapeutic agents, such as radionuclides, differentiation inducers, drugs, toxins, and derivatives thereof.
- radionuclides include 90 Y, 123 I, 125 I, 131 I, 186 Re, 188 Re, 211 At, and 212 Bi.
- Prefened drags include methotrexate, and pyrimidine and purine analogs.
- Prefened differentiation inducers include phorbol esters and butyric acid.
- Prefened toxins include ricin, abrin, diptheria toxin, cholera toxin, gelonin, Pseudomonas exotoxin, Shigella toxin, and pokeweed antiviral protein.
- an antibody or fragment thereof is preferably coupled to a cytotoxic agent, such as a radioactive or chemotherapeutic moiety.
- a therapeutic agent may be coupled (e.g., covalently bonded) to a suitable monoclonal antibody either directly or indirectly (e.g., via a linker group).
- a direct reaction between an agent and an antibody is possible when each possesses a substituent capable of reacting with the other.
- a nucleophilic group such as an amino or sulfhydryl group
- on one may be capable of reacting with a carbonyl-containing group, such as an anhydride or an acid halide, or with an alkyl group containing a good leaving group (e.g., a halide) on the other.
- a linker group can function as a spacer to distance an antibody from an agent in order to avoid interference with binding capabilities.
- a linker group can also serve to increase the chemical reactivity of a substituent on an agent or an antibody, and thus increase the coupling efficiency. An increase in chemical reactivity may also facilitate the use of agents, or functional groups on agents, which otherwise would not be possible.
- linker group may be employed as the linker group. Coupling may be effected, for example, through amino groups, carboxyl groups, sulfhydryl groups or oxidized carbohydrate residues. There are numerous references describing such methodology, e.g., U. S. Patent No. 4,671,958. Where a therapeutic agent is more potent when free from the antibody portion of the immunoconjugates of the present invention, it may be desirable to use a linker group which is cleavable during or upon internalization into a cell.
- cleavable linker groups A number of different cleavable linker groups have been described.
- the mechanisms for the intracellular release of an agent from these linker groups include cleavage by reduction of a disulfide bond (e.g., U. S. Patent No. 4,489,710), by inadiation of a photolabile bond (e.g., U. S. Patent No. 4,625,014), by hydrolysis of derivatized amino acid side chains (e.g., U. S. Patent No. 4,638,045), by serum complement-mediated hydrolysis (e.g., U. S. Patent No. 4,671,958), and acid-catalyzed hydrolysis (e.g., U. S. Patent No. 4,569,789).
- immunoconjugates with more than one agent may be prepared in a variety of ways. For example, more than one agent may be coupled directly to an antibody molecule, or linkers which provide multiple sites for attachment can be used. Alternatively, a carrier can be used.
- a carrier may bear the agents in a variety of ways, including covalent bonding either directly or via a linker group.
- Suitable carriers include proteins such as albumins (e.g., U. S. Patent No. 4,507,234), peptides and polysaccharides such as aminodextran (e.g., U. S. Patent No. 4,699,784).
- a carrier may also bear an agent by noncovalent bonding or by encapsulation, such as within a liposome vesicle (e.g., U. S. Patent Nos. 4,429,008 and 4,873,088).
- Carriers specific for radionuclide agents include radiohalogenated small molecules and chelating compounds. For example, U. S. Patent No.
- a radionuclide chelate may be formed from chelating compounds that include those containing nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the donor atoms for binding the metal, or metal oxide, radionuclide.
- U. S. Patent No. 4,673,562 discloses representative chelating compounds and their synthesis.
- a variety of routes of administration for the antibodies and immunoconjugates may be used. Typically, administration will be intravenous, intramuscular, subcutaneous or in the bed of a resected tumor. It will be evident that the precise dose of the antibody/immunoconjugate will vary depending upon the antibody used, the antigen density on the tumor, and the rate of clearance of the antibody.
- vaccines are provided.
- the vaccines will generally comprise one or more pharmaceutical compositions, such as those discussed above, in combination with an immunostimulant.
- An immunostimulant may be any substance that enhances or potentiates an immune response (antibody and/or cell-mediated) to an exogenous antigen.
- immunostimulants include adjuvants, biodegradable microspheres (e.g., polylactic galactide) and liposomes (into which the compound is incorporated; -see e.g., Fullerton, U.S. Patent No. 4,235,877).
- Vaccine preparation is generally described in, for example, M.F. Powell and M.J.
- compositions and vaccines within the scope of the present invention may also contain other compounds, which may be biologically active or inactive.
- one or more immunogenic portions of other tumor antigens may be present, either incorporated into a fusion polypeptide or as a separate compound, within the composition or vaccine.
- Illustrative vaccines may contain DNA encoding one or more of the polypeptides as described above, such that the polypeptide is generated in situ.
- the DNA may be present within any of a variety of delivery systems known to those of ordinary skill in the art, including nucleic acid expression systems, bacteria and viral expression systems. Numerous gene delivery techniques are well known in the art, such as those described by Rolland, Crit. Rev. Therap. Drug Carrier Systems 75:143-198, 1998, and references cited therein. Appropriate nucleic acid expression systems contain the necessary DNA sequences for expression in the patient (such as a suitable promoter and terminating signal).
- Bacterial delivery systems involve the administration of a bacterium (such as Bacillus-Calmette-Guerrin) that expresses an immunogenic portion of the polypeptide on its cell surface or secretes such an epitope.
- a bacterium such as Bacillus-Calmette-Guerrin
- the DNA may be introduced using a viral expression system (e.g., vaccinia or other pox virus, retrovirus, or adenovirus), which may involve the use of a non-pathogenic (defective), replication competent virus.
- vaccinia or other pox virus, retrovirus, or adenovirus e.g., vaccinia or other pox virus, retrovirus, or adenovirus
- Suitable systems are disclosed, for example, in Fisher-Hoch et al, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 86:311-321, 1989; Flexner et al, Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci.
- a vaccine may comprise both a polynucleotide and a polypeptide component. Such vaccines may provide for an enhanced immune response.
- a vaccine may contain pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the polynucleotides and polypeptides provided herein.
- Such salts may be prepared from pharmaceutically acceptable non-toxic bases, including organic bases (e.g., salts of primary, secondary and tertiary amines and basic amino acids) and inorganic bases (e.g., sodium, potassium, lithium, ammonium, calcium and magnesium salts).
- compositions of the present invention may be formulated for any appropriate manner of administration, including for example, topical, oral, nasal, intravenous, infracranial, intraperitoneal, subcutaneous or intramuscular administration.
- parenteral administration such as subcutaneous injection
- the carrier preferably comprises water, saline, alcohol, a fat, a wax or a buffer.
- any of the above carriers or a solid carrier such as mannitol, lactose, starch, magnesium stearate, sodium saccharine, talcum, cellulose, glucose, sucrose, and magnesium carbonate, may be employed.
- Biodegradable microspheres may also be employed as carriers for the pharmaceutical compositions of this invention.
- Suitable biodegradable microspheres are disclosed, for example, in U.S. Patent Nos. 4,897,268; 5,075,109; 5,928,647; 5,811,128; 5,820,883; 5,853,763; 5,814,344 and 5,942,252.
- One may also employ a carrier comprising the particulate-protein complexes described in U.S. Patent No. 5,928,647, which are capable of inducing a class I-restricted cytotoxic T lymphocyte responses in a host.
- compositions may also comprise buffers (e.g., neutral buffered saline or phosphate buffered saline), carbohydrates (e.g., glucose, mannose, sucrose or dextrans), mannitol, proteins, polypeptides or amino acids such as glycine, antioxidants, bacteriostats, chelating agents such as EDTA or glutathione, adjuvants (e.g., aluminum hydroxide), solutes that render the formulation isotonic, hypotonic or weakly hypertonic with the blood of a recipient, suspending agents, thickening agents and/or preservatives.
- buffers e.g., neutral buffered saline or phosphate buffered saline
- carbohydrates e.g., glucose, mannose, sucrose or dextrans
- mannitol proteins
- proteins polypeptides or amino acids
- proteins e.glycine
- antioxidants e.g., g., bacteriostats,
- Compounds may also be encapsulated within liposomes using well known technology. Any of a variety of immunostimulants may be employed in the vaccines of this invention.
- an adjuvant may be included. Most adjuvants contain a substance designed to protect the antigen from rapid catabolism, such as aluminum hydroxide or mineral oil, and a stimulator of immune responses, such as lipid A, Bortadella pertussis or Mycobacterium tuberculosis derived proteins.
- Suitable adjuvants are commercially available as, for example, Freund's Incomplete Adjuvant and Complete Adjuvant (Difco Laboratories, Detroit, MI); Merck Adjuvant 65 (Merck and Company, Enc, Rahway, NJ); AS-2 (SmithKline Beecham, Philadelphia, PA); aluminum salts such as aluminum hydroxide gel (alum) or aluminum phosphate; salts of calcium, iron or zinc; an insoluble suspension of acylated tyrosine; acylated sugars; cationically or anionically derivatized polysaccharides; polyphosphazenes; biodegradable microspheres; monophosphoryl lipid A and quil A. Cytokines, such as GM-CSF or interleukin-2, -7, or -12, may also be used as adjuvants.
- Cytokines such as GM-CSF or interleukin-2, -7, or -12, may also be used as adjuvants.
- the adjuvant composition is preferably designed to induce an immune response predominantly of the Thl type.
- High levels of Thl-type cytokines e.g., IFN- ⁇ , TNF ⁇ , IL-2 and EL-12
- Th2-type cytokines e.g., TL-4
- IL-5, IL-6 and IL-10) tend to favor the induction of humoral immune responses.
- a patient will support an immune response that includes Thl- and Th2-type responses.
- Thl-type cytokines will increase to a greater extent than the level of Th2-type cytokines.
- the levels of these cytokines may be readily assessed using standard assays. For a review of the families of cytokines, see Mosmann and Coffman, Ann.
- Prefe ⁇ ed adjuvants for use in eliciting a predominantly Thl-type response include, for example, a combination of monophosphoryl lipid A, preferably 3-de-O-acylated monophosphoryl lipid A (3D-MPL), together with an aluminum salt.
- MPL adjuvants are available from Corixa Corporation (Seattle, WA; see US Patent Nos. 4,436,727; 4,877,611;
- CpG-containing oligonucleotides in which the CpG dinucleotide is unmethylated also induce a predominantly Thl response.
- Such oligonucleotides are well known and are described, for example, in WO 96/02555, WO 99/33488 and U.S. Patent Nos. 6,008,200 and 5,856,462.
- hnmunostimulatory DNA sequences are also described, for example, by Sato et al, Science 273:352, 1996.
- Another prefened adjuvant is a saponin, preferably QS21 (Aquila Biopharmaceuticals Inc., Framingham, MA), which may be used alone or in combination with other adjuvants.
- an enhanced system involves the combination of a monophosphoryl lipid A and saponin derivative, such as the combination of QS21 and 3D- MPL as described in WO 94/00153, or a less reactogenic composition where the QS21 is quenched with cholesterol, as described in WO 96/33739.
- Other prefened formulations comprise an oil-in-water emulsion and tocopherol.
- a particularly potent adjuvant formulation involving QS21, 3D-MPL and tocopherol in an oil-in-water emulsion is described in WO 95/17210.
- prefe ⁇ ed adjuvants include Montanide ISA 720 (Seppic, France), SAF (Chiron, California, United States), ISCOMS (CSL), MF-59 (Chiron), the SBAS series of adjuvants (e.g., SBAS-2 or SBAS-4, available from SmithKline Beecham, Rixensart, Belgium), Detox (Corixa, Hamilton, MT), RC-529 (Corixa, Hamilton, MT) and other aminoalkyl glucosaminide 4-phosphates (AGPs), such as those described in pending U.S. Patent Application Serial Nos. 08/853,826 and 09/074,720, the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entireties.
- compositions described herein may be administered as part of a sustained release formulation (i.e., a formulation such as a capsule, sponge or gel (composed of polysaccharides, for example) that effects a slow release of compound following administration).
- sustained release formulations i.e., a formulation such as a capsule, sponge or gel (composed of polysaccharides, for example) that effects a slow release of compound following administration.
- Such formulations may generally be prepared using well known technology (see, e.g., Coombes et al , Vaccine 14: 1429- 1438, 1996) and administered by, for example, oral, rectal or subcutaneous implantation, or by implantation at the desired target site.
- Sustained-release formulations may contain a polypeptide, polynucleotide or antibody dispersed in a carrier matrix and/or contained within a reservoir su ⁇ ounded by a rate controlling membrane.
- Carriers for use within such formulations are biocompatible, and may also be biodegradable; preferably the formulation provides a relatively constant level of active component release.
- Such carriers include microparticles of poly(lactide-co-glycolide), polyacrylate, latex, starch, cellulose, dextran and the like.
- Other delayed-release carriers include supramolecular biovectors, which comprise a non-hquid hydrophilic core (e.g., a cross- linked polysaccharide or oligosaccharide) and, optionally, an external layer comprising an amphiphihc compound, such as a phosphohpid (see e.g., U.S. Patent No.
- APCs antigen presenting cells
- Such cells may, but need not, be genetically modified to increase the capacity for presenting the antigen, to improve activation and/or maintenance of the T cell response, to have anti-tumor effects per se and/or to be immunologically compatible with the receiver (i.e., matched HLA haplotype).
- APCs may generally be isolated from any of a variety of biological fluids and organs, including tumor and peritumoral tissues, and may be autologous, allogeneic, syngeneic or xenogeneic cells. Certain prefened embodiments of the present invention use dendritic cells or progenitors thereof as antigen-presenting cells.
- Dendritic cells are highly potent APCs (Banchereau and Steinman, Nature 392:245-251, 1998) and have been shown to be effective as a physiological adjuvant for eliciting prophylactic or therapeutic antitumor immunity (see Timmerman and Levy, Ann. Rev. Med. 50:507-529, 1999).
- dendritic cells may be identified based on their typical shape (stellate in situ, with marked cytoplasmic processes (dendrites) visible in vitro), their ability to take up, process and present antigens with high efficiency and their ability to activate na ⁇ ve T cell responses.
- Dendritic cells may, of course, be engineered to express specific cell-surface receptors or ligands that are not commonly found on dendritic cells in vivo or ex vivo, and such modified dendritic cells are contemplated by the present invention.
- secreted vesicles antigen-loaded dendritic cells called exosomes
- exosomes antigen-loaded dendritic cells
- Dendritic cells and progenitors may be obtained from peripheral blood, bone ma ⁇ ow, tumor-infiltrating cells, peritumoral tissues-infiltrating cells, lymph nodes, spleen, skin, umbilical cord blood or any other suitable tissue or fluid.
- dendritic cells may be differentiated ex vivo by adding a combination of cytokines such as GM-CSF, EL-4, IL-13 and/or TNF ⁇ to cultures of monocytes harvested from peripheral blood.
- CD34 positive cells harvested from peripheral blood, umbilical cord blood or bone ma ⁇ ow may be differentiated into dendritic cells by adding to the culture medium combinations of GM-CSF, IL-3, TNF ⁇ , CD40 ligand, LPS, flt3 ligand and/or other compound(s) that induce differentiation, maturation and proliferation of dendritic cells.
- Dendritic cells are conveniently categorized as “immature” and “mature” cells, which allows a simple way to between two well characterized phenotypes. However, this nomenclature should not be construed to exclude all possible intermediate stages of differentiation. Immature dendritic cells are characterized as APC with a high capacity for antigen uptake and processing, which conelates with the high expression of Fc ⁇ receptor and mannose receptor.
- the mature phenotype is typically characterized by a lower expression of these markers, but a high expression of cell surface molecules responsible for T cell activation such as class I and class II MHC, adhesion molecules (e.g., CD54 and CDl 1) and costimulatory molecules (e.g., CD40, CD80, CD86 and 4-1BB).
- cell surface molecules responsible for T cell activation such as class I and class II MHC, adhesion molecules (e.g., CD54 and CDl 1) and costimulatory molecules (e.g., CD40, CD80, CD86 and 4-1BB).
- APCs may generally be transfected with a polynucleotide encoding a hematological malignancy-related tumor protein (or portion or other variant thereof) such that the hematological malignancy-related tumor polypeptide, or an immunogenic portion thereof, is expressed on the cell surface.
- Such transfection may take place ex vivo, and a composition or vaccine comprising such transfected cells may then be used for therapeutic purposes, as described herein.
- a gene delivery vehicle that targets a dendritic or other antigen presenting cell may be administered to a patient, resulting in transfection that occurs in vivo.
- In vivo and ex vivo transfection of dendritic cells may generally be performed using any methods known in the art, such as those described in WO 97/24447, or the gene gun approach described by Mahvi et al, Immunology and cell Biology 75:456-460, 1997.
- Antigen loading of dendritic cells may be achieved by incubating dendritic cells or progenitor cells with the hematological malignancy-related tumor polypeptide, DNA (naked or within a plasmid vector) or RNA; or with antigen-expressing recombinant bacterium or virases (e.g., vaccinia, fowlpox, adenovirus or lentivirus vectors).
- the polypeptide Prior to loading, the polypeptide may be covalently conjugated to an immunological partner that provides T cell help (e.g., a carrier molecule).
- an immunological partner that provides T cell help e.g., a carrier molecule.
- a dendritic cell may be pulsed with a non-conjugated immunological partner, separately or in the presence of the polypeptide.
- Vaccines and pharmaceutical compositions may be presented in unit-dose or multi-dose containers, such as sealed ampoules or vials. Such containers are preferably hermetically sealed to preserve sterility of the formulation until use.
- formulations may be stored as suspensions, solutions or emulsions in oily or aqueous vehicles.
- a vaccine or pharmaceutical composition may be stored in a freeze-dried condition requiring only the addition of a sterile liquid carrier immediately prior to use.
- compositions described herein may be used for immunotherapy of cancer, such as hematological malignancy.
- pharmaceutical compositions and vaccines are typically admmistered to a patient.
- a patient refers to any warm-blooded animal, preferably a human.
- a patient may or may not be afflicted with cancer.
- the above pharmaceutical compositions and vaccines may be used to prevent the development of a cancer or to treat a patient afflicted with a cancer.
- a cancer may be diagnosed using criteria generally accepted in the art, including the presence of a malignant tumor.
- compositions and vaccines may be administered either prior to or following surgical removal of primary tumors and/or treatment such as administration of radiotherapy or conventional chemotherapeutic drugs.
- Administration may be by any suitable method, including administration by intravenous, intraperitoneal, intramuscular, subcutaneous, intranasal, intradermal, anal, vaginal, topical and oral routes.
- immunotherapy may be active immunotherapy, in which treatment relies on the in vivo stimulation of the endogenous host immune system to react against tumors with the administration of immune response-modifying agents (such as polypeptides and polynucleotides as provided herein).
- immunotherapy may be passive immunotherapy, in which treatment involves the delivery of agents with established tumor-immune reactivity (such as effector cells or antibodies) that can directly or indirectly mediate antitumor effects and does not necessarily depend on an intact host immune system.
- effector cells include T cells as discussed above, T lymphocytes (such as CD8 + cytotoxic T lymphocytes and CD4 + T-helper tumor-infiltrating lymphocytes), killer cells (such as Natural Killer cells and lymphokine- activated killer cells), B cells and antigen-presenting cells (such as dendritic cells and macrophages) expressing a polypeptide provided herein.
- T cell receptors and antibody receptors specific for the polypeptides recited herein may be cloned, expressed and transfe ⁇ ed into other vectors or effector cells for adoptive immunotherapy.
- the polypeptides provided herein may also be used to generate antibodies or anti-idiotypic antibodies (as described above and in U.S. Patent No. 4,918,164) for passive immunotherapy.
- Effector cells may generally be obtained in sufficient quantities for adoptive immunotherapy by growth in vitro, as described herein.
- Culture conditions for expanding single antigen-specific effector cells to several billion in number with retention of antigen recognition in vivo are well known in the art.
- Such in vitro culture conditions typically use intermittent stimulation with antigen, often in the presence of cytokines (such as EL-2) and non-dividing feeder cells.
- cytokines such as EL-2
- immunoreactive polypeptides as provided herein may be used to rapidly expand antigen-specific T cell cultures in order to generate a sufficient number of cells for immunotherapy.
- antigen-presenting cells such as dendritic, macrophage, monocyte, fibroblast and or B cells
- antigen-presenting cells may be pulsed with immunoreactive polypeptides or transfected with one or more polynucleotides using standard techniques well known in the art.
- antigen-presenting cells can be transfected with a polynucleotide having a promoter appropriate for increasing expression in a recombinant virus or other expression system.
- Cultured effector cells for use in therapy must be able to grow and distribute widely, and to survive long term in vivo.
- a vector expressing a polypeptide recited herein may be introduced into antigen presenting cells taken from a patient and clonally propagated ex vivo for transplant back into the same patient.
- Transfected cells may be reintroduced into the patient using any means known in the art, preferably in sterile form by intravenous, intracavitary, intraperitoneal or intratumor administration.
- the pharmaceutical compositions and vaccines may be administered by injection (e.g., intracutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or subcutaneous), intranasally (e.g., by aspiration) or orally.
- injection e.g., intracutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or subcutaneous
- intranasally e.g., by aspiration
- between 1 and 10 doses may be administered over a 52 week period.
- 6 doses are administered, at intervals of 1 month, and booster vaccinations may be given periodically thereafter. Alternate protocols may be appropriate for individual patients.
- a suitable dose is an amount of a compound that, when administered as described above, is capable of promoting an anti-tumor immune response, and is at least 10-50%» above the basal (i.e., untreated) level.
- Such response can be monitored by measuring the anti-tumor antibodies in a patient or by vaccine-dependent generation of cytolytic effector cells capable of killing the patient's tumor cells in vitro.
- Such vaccines should also be capable of causing an immune response that leads to an improved clinical outcome (e.g., more frequent remissions, complete or partial or longer disease-free survival) in vaccinated patients as compared to non-vaccinated patients.
- the amount of each polypeptide present in a dose ranges from about 25 ⁇ g to 5 mg per kg of host. Suitable dose sizes will vary with the size of the patient, but will typically range from about 0.1 mL to about 5 mL.
- an appropriate dosage and treatment regimen provides the active compound(s) in an amount sufficient to provide therapeutic and/or prophylactic benefit.
- Such a response can be monitored by establishing an improved clinical outcome (e.g., more frequent remissions, complete or partial, or longer disease-free survival) in treated patients as compared to non-treated patients.
- Increases in preexisting immune responses to a hematological malignancy-related tumor protein generally conelate with an improved clinical outcome.
- Such immune responses may generally be evaluated using standard proliferation, cytotoxicity or cytokine assays, which may be performed using samples obtained from a patient before and after treatment. 4.23 CANCER DETECTION AND DIAGNOSIS
- a cancer may be detected in a patient based on the presence of one or more hematological malignancy-related tumor proteins and/or polynucleotides encoding such proteins in a biological sample (for example, blood, sera, sputum urine and/or tumor biopsies) obtained from the patient, h other words, such proteins may be used as markers to indicate the presence or absence of a cancer such as hematological malignancy. In addition, such proteins may be useful for the detection of other cancers.
- the binding agents provided herein generally permit detection of the level of antigen that binds to the agent in the biological sample.
- Polynucleotide primers and probes may be used to detect the level of mRNA encoding a tumor protein, which is also indicative of the presence or absence of a cancer.
- a hematological malignancy-related tumor sequence should be present at a level that is at least three fold higher
- the presence or absence of a cancer in a patient may be determined by (a) contacting a biological sample obtained from a patient with a binding agent; (b) detecting in the sample a level of polypeptide that binds to the binding agent; and (c) comparing the level of polypeptide with a predetermined cut-off value.
- the assay involves the use of binding agent immobilized on a solid support to bind to and remove the polypeptide from the remainder of the sample.
- the bound polypeptide may then be detected using a detection reagent that contains a reporter group and specifically binds to the binding agent/polypeptide complex.
- detection reagents may comprise, for example, a binding agent that specifically binds to the polypeptide or an antibody or other agent that specifically binds to the binding agent, such as an anti-immunoglobulin, protein G, protein A or a lectin.
- a competitive assay may be utilized, in wliich a polypeptide is labeled with a reporter group and allowed to bind to the immobilized binding agent after incubation of the binding agent with the sample.
- the extent to which components of the sample inhibit the binding of the labeled polypeptide to the binding agent is indicative of the reactivity of the sample with the immobilized binding agent.
- Suitable polypeptides for use within such assays include full length hematological malignancy-related tumor proteins and portions thereof to which the binding agent binds, as described above.
- the solid support may be any material known to those of ordinary skill in the art to which the tumor protein may be attached.
- the solid support may be a test well in a microtiter plate or a nitrocellulose or other suitable membrane.
- the support may be a bead or disc, such as glass, fiberglass, latex or a plastic material such as polystyrene or polyvinylchloride.
- the support may also be a magnetic particle or a fiber optic sensor, such as those disclosed, for example, in U.S. Patent No. 5,359,681.
- the binding agent may be immobilized on the solid support using a variety of techniques known to those of skill in the art, which are amply described in the patent and scientific literature, hi the context of the present invention, the term “immobilization” refers to both noncovalent association, such as adsorption, and covalent attachment (which may be a direct linkage between the agent and functional groups on the support or may be a linkage by way of a cross-linking agent). Immobilization by adsorption to a well in a microtiter plate or to a membrane is prefened. In such cases, adsorption may be achieved by contacting the binding agent, in a suitable buffer, with the solid support for a suitable amount of time.
- the contact time varies with temperature, but is typically between about 1 hour and about 1 day.
- contacting a well of a plastic microtiter plate (such as polystyrene or polyvinylchloride) with an amount of binding agent ranging from about 10 ng to about 10 ⁇ g, and preferably about 100 ng to about 1 ⁇ g is sufficient to immobilize an adequate amount of binding agent.
- Covalent attachment of binding agent to a solid support may generally be achieved by first reacting the support with a bifunctional reagent that will react with both the support and a functional group, such as a hydroxyl or amino group, on the binding agent.
- the binding agent may be covalently attached to supports having an appropriate polymer coating using benzoquinone or by condensation of an aldehyde group on the support with an amine and an active hydrogen on the binding partner (see, e.g., Pierce hnmunotechnology Catalog and Handbook, 1991, at A12-A13).
- the assay is a two-antibody sandwich assay. This assay may be performed by first contacting an antibody that has been immobilized on a solid support, commonly the well of a microtiter plate, with the sample, such that polypeptides within the sample are allowed to bind to the immobilized antibody. Unbound sample is then removed from the immobilized polypeptide-antibody complexes and a detection reagent (preferably a second antibody capable of binding to a different site on the polypeptide) containing a reporter group is added. The amount of detection reagent that remains bound to the solid support is then detennined using a method appropriate for the specific reporter group.
- a detection reagent preferably a second antibody capable of binding to a different site on the polypeptide
- an appropriate contact time is a period of time that is sufficient to detect the presence of polypeptide within a sample obtained from an individual with hematological malignancy.
- the contact time is sufficient to achieve a level of binding that is at least about 95% of that achieved at equilibrium between bound and unbound polypeptide.
- the time necessary to achieve equilibrium may be readily determined by assaying the level of binding that occurs over a period of time.
- an incubation time of about 30 minutes is generally sufficient.
- Unbound sample may then be removed by washing the solid support with an appropriate buffer, such as PBS containing 0.1% Tween 20TM.
- the second antibody which contains a reporter group, may then be added to the solid support.
- Prefened reporter groups include those groups recited above.
- the detection reagent is then incubated with the immobilized antibody-polypeptide complex for an amount of time sufficient to detect the bound polypeptide.
- An appropriate amount of time may generally be determined by assaying the level of binding that occurs over a period of time.
- Unbound detection reagent is then removed and bound detection reagent is detected using the reporter group.
- the method employed for detecting the reporter group depends upon the nature of the reporter group. For radioactive groups, scintillation counting or autoradiographic methods are generally appropriate. Spectroscopic methods may be used to detect dyes, luminescent groups and fluorescent groups. Biotin may be detected using avidin, coupled to a different reporter group (commonly a radioactive or fluorescent group or an enzyme).
- Enzyme reporter groups may generally be detected by the addition of substrate (generally for a specific period of time), followed by spectroscopic or other analysis of the reaction products.
- the signal detected from the reporter group that remains bound to the solid support is generally compared to a signal that conesponds to a predetermined cut-off value.
- the cut-off value for the detection of a cancer is the average mean signal obtained when the immobilized antibody is incubated with samples from patients without the cancer, h general, a sample generating a signal that is three standard deviations above the predetermined cut-off value is considered positive for the cancer.
- the cut-off value is determined using a Receiver Operator Curve, according to the method of Sackett et al, Clinical Epidemiology: A Basic Science for Clinical Medicine, Little Brown and Co., 1985, p. 106-7. Briefly, in this embodiment, the cut-off value may be determined from a plot of pairs of trae positive rates (i.e., sensitivity) and false positive rates (100%-specificity) that conespond to each possible cut-off value for the diagnostic test result.
- trae positive rates i.e., sensitivity
- false positive rates (100%-specificity
- the cut-off value on the plot that is the closest to the upper left-hand corner is the most accurate cut-off value, and a sample generating a signal that is higher than the cut-off value determined by this method may be considered positive.
- the cut-off value may be shifted to the left along the plot, to minimize the false positive rate, or to the right, to minimize the false negative rate.
- a sample generating a signal that is higher than the cut-off value determined by this method is considered positive for a cancer.
- the assay is performed in a flow-through or strip test format, wherein the binding agent is immobilized on a membrane, such as nitrocellulose.
- polypeptides within the sample bind to the immobilized binding agent as the sample passes through the membrane.
- a second, labeled binding agent then binds to the binding agent-polypeptide complex as a solution containing the second binding agent flows through the membrane.
- the detection of bound second binding agent may then be performed as described above.
- one end of the membrane to which binding agent is bound is immersed in a solution containing the sample.
- the sample migrates along the membrane through a region containing second binding agent and to the area of immobilized binding agent. Concentration of second binding agent at the area of immobilized antibody indicates the presence of a cancer.
- concentration of second binding agent at that site generates a pattern, such as a line, that can be read visually.
- the amount of binding agent immobilized on the membrane is selected to generate a visually discernible pattern when the biological sample contains a level of polypeptide that would be sufficient to generate a positive signal in the two- antibody sandwich assay, in the format discussed above.
- Prefened binding agents for use in such assays are antibodies and antigen-binding fragments thereof.
- the amount of antibody immobilized on the membrane ranges from about 25 ng to about l ⁇ g, and more preferably from about 50 ng to about 500 ng. Such tests can typically be performed with a very small amount of biological sample.
- a cancer may also, or alternatively, be detected based on the presence of T cells that specifically react with a hematological malignancy-related tumor protein in a biological sample.
- a biological sample comprising CD4 + and or CD8 + T cells isolated from a patient is incubated with a hematological malignancy-related tumor polypeptide, a polynucleotide encoding such a polypeptide and/or an APC that expresses at least an irnmunogenic portion of such a polypeptide, and the presence or absence of specific activation of the T cells is detected.
- Suitable biological samples include, but are not limited to, isolated T cells.
- T cells may be isolated from a patient by routine techniques (such as by
- T cells may --,,-,----,--##
- PCT/US02/35728 be incubated in vitro for 2-9 days (typically 4 days) at 37°C with polypeptide (e.g., 5 - 25 ⁇ g/ml). It may be desirable to incubate another aliquot of a T cell sample in the absence of hematological malignancy-related tumor polypeptide to serve as a control.
- activation is preferably detected by evaluating proliferation of the T cells.
- activation is preferably detected by evaluating cytolytic activity.
- a level of proliferation that is at least two fold greater and/or a level of cytolytic activity that is at least 20%> greater than in disease-free patients indicates the presence of a cancer in the patient.
- a cancer may also, or alternatively, be detected based on the level of mRNA encoding a hematological malignancy-related tumor protein in a biological sample.
- at least two ohgonucleotide primers may be employed in a polymerase chain reaction (PCR) based assay to amplify a portion of a hematological malignancy-related tumor cDNA derived from a biological sample, wherein at least one of the ohgonucleotide primers is specific for (i.e., hybridizes to) a polynucleotide encoding the hematological malignancy-related tumor protein.
- PCR polymerase chain reaction
- the amplified cDNA is then separated and detected using techniques well known in the art, such as gel electrophoresis.
- ohgonucleotide probes that specifically hybridize to a polynucleotide encoding a hematological malignancy-related tumor protein may be used in a hybridization assay to detect the presence of polynucleotide encoding the tumor protein in a biological sample.
- ohgonucleotide primers and probes should comprise an ohgonucleotide sequence that has at least about 60%, preferably at least about 75%) and more preferably at least about 90%o, identity to a portion of a polynucleotide encoding a hematological malignancy-related tumor protein that is at least 10 nucleotides, and preferably at least 20 nucleotides, in length.
- ohgonucleotide primers and/or probes hybridize to a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide described herein under moderately stringent conditions, as defined above.
- Ohgonucleotide primers and/or probes which may be usefully employed in the diagnostic methods described herein preferably are at least 10-40 nucleotides in length, a prefened embodiment, the ohgonucleotide primers comprise at least 10 contiguous nucleotides, more preferably at least 15 contiguous nucleotides, of a DNA molecule having a sequence disclosed in this application.
- Techniques for both PCR based assays and hybridization assays are well known in the art (see, for example, Mulhs et al, Cold
- RNA is extracted from a biological sample, such as biopsy tissue, and is reverse transcribed to produce cDNA molecules.
- PCR amplification using at least one specific primer generates a cDNA molecule, which may be separated and visualized using, for example, gel electrophoresis.
- Amplification may be performed on biological samples taken from a test patient and from an individual who is not afflicted with a cancer. The amplification reaction may be performed on several dilutions of cDNA spanning two orders of magnitude. A two-fold or greater increase in expression in several dilutions of the test patient sample as compared to the same dilutions of the non-cancerous sample is typically considered positive.
- compositions described herein may be used as markers for the progression of cancer.
- assays as described above for the diagnosis of a cancer may be performed over time, and the change in the level of reactive polypeptide(s) or polynucleotide(s) evaluated.
- the assays may be performed every 24-72 hours for a period of 6 months to 1 year, and thereafter performed as needed, hi general, a cancer is progressing in those patients in whom the level of polypeptide or polynucleotide detected increases over time.
- the cancer is not progressing when the level of reactive polypeptide or polynucleotide either remains constant or decreases with time.
- Certain in vivo diagnostic assays may be performed directly on a tumor.
- One such assay involves contacting tumor cells with a binding agent.
- the bound binding agent may then be detected directly or indirectly via a reporter group.
- binding agents may also be used in histological applications.
- polynucleotide probes may be used within such applications.
- multiple hematological malignancy-related tumor protein markers may be assayed within a given sample. It will be apparent that binding agents specific for different proteins provided herein may be combined within a single assay. Further, multiple primers or probes may be used concu ⁇ ently. The selection of tumor protein markers may be based on routine experiments to determine combinations that results in optimal sensitivity, h addition, or alternatively, assays for tumor proteins provided herein may be combined with assays for other known tumor antigens.
- Driver #1 contained cDNA prepared from specific normal tissues (lymph node, bone ma ⁇ ow, T cells, heart and brain), and this subtraction generated the library TCS-D1 (T cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma subtracted library with driver #1).
- Driver #2 contained non-specific normal tissues (colon, large intestine, lung, pancreas, spinal cord, skeletal muscle, liver, kidney, skin and brain), and this subtraction generated the library TCS-D2 (T cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma subtraction library with driver
- driver #1 contained cDNA prepared from specific normal tissues (lymph node, bone ma ⁇ ow, B cells, heart and brain), and this subtraction generated the library BCNHL/Dl (B cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma subtracted library with driver #1).
- Driver #2 contained non-specific normal tissues (brain, lung, pancreas, spinal cord, skeletal muscle, colon, spleen, large intestine and PBMC), and this subtraction generated the library BCNHL/D2 (B cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma subtraction library with driver #2).
- PCRTM-amplified pools were generated from the subtracted libraries and clones were sequenced. Hematological malignancy-related antigen sequences may be further characterized using any of a variety of well known techniques. For example, PCRTM amplified clones may be anayed onto glass slides for microarray analysis.
- the anayed clones may be used as targets to be hybridized with different first strand cDNA probes, including lymphoma probes, leukemia probes and probes from different normal tissues.
- Leukemia and lymphoma probes may be generated from cryopreserved samples obtained at the time of diagnosis from NHL, Hodgkin's disease, AML, CML, CLL, ALL, MDS and myeloma patients with poor outcome (patients who failed to achieve complete remission following conventional chemotherapy or relapsed) or good outcome (patients who achieved long term remission).
- probes may be generated from >95% pure fractions of CD34+, CD2+, CD14+, CD15+ and CD19+ cells derived from healthy individuals.
- Polynucleotide variants may generally be prepared by any method known in the art, including chemical synthesis by, for example, solid phase phosphoramidite chemical synthesis.
- Modifications in a polynucleotide sequence may also be introduced using standard mutagenesis techniques, such as oligonucleotide-directed site-specific mutagenesis (see Adelman et al, DNA
- RNA molecules may be generated by in vitro or in vivo transcription of DNA sequences, provided that the DNA is incorporated into a vector with a suitable RNA polymerase promoter (such as T7 or SP6). Certain portions may be used to prepare an encoded polypeptide, as described herein. In addition, or alternatively, a portion may be administered to a patient such that the encoded polypeptide is generated in vivo (e.g., by transfecting antigen-presenting cells, such as dendritic cells, with a cDNA construct encoding a hematological malignancy-related antigen, and administering the transfected cells to the patient).
- antigen-presenting cells such as dendritic cells
- a portion of a sequence complementary to a coding sequence may also be used as a probe or to modulate hematological malignancy-related antigen expression.
- cDNA constructs that can be transcribed into antisense RNA may also be introduced into cells or tissues to facilitate the production of antisense RNA.
- An antisense polynucleotide may be used, as described herein, to inhibit expression of a hematological malignancy-related antigen.
- Antisense technology can be used to control gene expression through triple-helix formation, which compromises the ability of the double helix to open sufficiently for the binding of polymerases, transcription factors or regulatory molecules (see Gee et al, In Huber and Can, Molecular and Immunologic Approaches, Futura Publishing Co. (Mt. Kisco, NY; 1994)).
- an antisense molecule may be designed to hybridize with a control region of a gene (e.g., promoter, enhancer or transcription initiation site), and block transcription of the gene; or to block translation by inhibiting binding of a transcript to ribosomes.
- Probes may be labeled with a variety of reporter groups, such as radionuchdes and enzymes, and are preferably at least 10 nucleotides in length, more preferably at least 20 nucleotides in length and still more preferably at least 30 nucleotides in length. Primers, as noted above, are preferably 22-30 nucleotides in length.
- Any polynucleotide may be further modified to increase stability in vivo. Possible modifications include, but are not limited to, the addition of flanking sequences at the 5' and/or 3' ends; the use of phosphorothioate or 2' O-methyl rather than phosphodiesterase linkages in the backbone; and or the inclusion of nontraditional bases such as inosine, queosine and wybutosine, as well as acetyl- methyl-, thio- and other modified forms of adenine, cytidine, guanine, thymine and uridine.
- Hematological malignancy-related antigen polynucleotides may be joined to a variety of other nucleotide sequences using established recombinant DNA techniques.
- a polynucleotide may be cloned into any of a variety of cloning vectors, including plasmids, phagemids, lambda phage derivatives and cosmids.
- Vectors of particular interest include expression vectors, replication vectors, probe generation vectors and sequencing vectors.
- a vector will contain an origin of replication functional in at least one organism, convenient restriction endonuclease sites and one or more selectable markers. Other elements will depend upon the desired use, and will be apparent to those of ordinary skill in the art.
- polynucleotides may be formulated so as to permit entry into a cell of a mammal, and expression therein. Such formulations are particularly useful for therapeutic purposes, as described below.
- a polynucleotide may be incorporated into a viral vector such as, but not limited to, adenovirus, adeno-associated virus, retrovirus, or vaccinia or other pox virus (e.g., avian pox virus). Techniques for incorporating DNA into such vectors are well known to those of ordinary skill in the art.
- a retroviral vector may additionally transfer or incorporate a gene for a selectable marker (to aid in the identification or selection of transduced cells) and/or a targeting moiety, such as a gene that encodes a hgand for a receptor on a specific target cell, to render the vector target specific. Targeting may also be accomplished using an antibody, by methods known to those of ordinary skill in the art.
- colloidal dispersion systems such as macromolecule complexes, nanocapsules, microspheres, beads, and lipid-based systems including oil-in-water emulsions, micelles, mixed micelles, and liposomes.
- a prefened colloidal system for use as a delivery vehicle in vitro and in vivo is a liposome (i.e., an artificial membrane vesicle). The preparation and use of such systems is well known in the art.
- compositions described herein may be used for immunotherapy of hematological malignancies including adult and pediatric AML, CML, ALL, CLL, myelodysplastic syndromes (MDS), myeloproliferative syndromes (MPS), secondary leukemia, multiple myeloma, Hodgkin's lymphoma and Non-Hodgkin's lymphomas.
- compositions described herein may be used for therapy of diseases associated with an autoimmune response against hematopoetic precursor cells, such as severe aplastic anemia.
- Immunotherapy may be performed using any of a variety of techniques, in which compounds or cells provided herein function to remove hematological malignancy-related antigen-expressing cells from a patient. Such removal may take place as a result of enhancing or inducing an immune response in a patient specific for hematological malignancy-related antigen or a cell expressing hematological malignancy-related antigen.
- hematological malignancy-related antigen-expressing cells may be removed ex vivo (e.g., by treatment of autologous bone ma ⁇ ow, peripheral blood or a fraction of bone ma ⁇ ow or peripheral blood). Fractions of bone ma ⁇ ow or peripheral blood may be obtained using any standard technique in the art.
- compositions and vaccines are typically administered to a patient.
- a "patient” refers to any warm-blooded animal, preferably a human.
- a patient may or may not be afflicted with a hematological malignancy.
- the above pharmaceutical compositions and vaccines may be used to prevent the development of a malignancy or to treat a patient afflicted with a mahgnancy.
- a hematological malignancy may be diagnosed using criteria generally accepted in the art.
- Pharmaceutical compositions and vaccines may be administered either prior to or following surgical removal of primary tumors and/or treatment such as administration of radiotherapy or conventional chemotherapeutic drugs, or bone ma ⁇ ow transplantation (autologous, allogeneic or syngeneic).
- immunotherapy may be active immunotherapy, in which treatment relies on the in vivo stimulation of the endogenous host immune system to react against tumors with the administration of immune response-modifying agents (such as polypeptides and polynucleotides as provided herein).
- immune response-modifying agents such as polypeptides and polynucleotides as provided herein.
- immunotherapy may be passive immunotherapy, in which treatment involves the delivery of agents with established tumor-immune reactivity (such as effector cells or antibodies) that can directly or indirectly mediate antitumor effects and does not necessarily depend on an intact host immune system.
- agents with established tumor-immune reactivity such as effector cells or antibodies
- effector cells include T cells as discussed above, T lymphocytes (such as CD8 + cytotoxic T lymphocytes and CD4 + T-helper tumor-infiltrating lymphocytes), killer cells (such as Natural Killer cells and lymphokine- activated killer cells), B cells and antigen-presenting cells (such as dendritic cells and macrophages) expressing a polypeptide provided herein.
- T cell receptors and antibody receptors specific for the polypeptides recited herein may be cloned, expressed and transfe ⁇ ed into other vectors or effector cells for adoptive immunotherapy.
- the polypeptides provided herein may also be used to generate antibodies or anti-idiotypic antibodies (as described above and in U.S. Patent No.4,918,164) for passive immunotl erapy.
- Effector cells may generally be obtained in sufficient quantities for adoptive immunotherapy by growth in vitro, as described herein.
- Culture conditions for expanding single antigen-specific effector cells to several billion in number with retention of antigen recognition in vivo are well known in the art.
- Such in vitro culture conditions typically use intermittent stimulation with antigen, often in the presence of cytokines (such as IL-2) and non-dividing feeder cells.
- cytokines such as IL-2
- immunoreactive polypeptides as provided herein may be used to rapidly expand antigen-specific T cell cultures in order to generate a sufficient number of cells for immunotherapy.
- antigen-presenting cells such as dendritic, macrophage or B cells
- antigen-presenting cells may be pulsed with immunoreactive polypeptides or transfected with one or more polynucleotides using standard techniques well known in the art.
- antigen-presenting cells can be transfected with a polynucleotide having a promoter appropriate for increasing expression in a recombinant virus or other expression system.
- Cultured effector cells for use in therapy must be able to grow and distribute widely, and to survive long term in vivo.
- a vector expressing a polypeptide recited herein may be introduced into antigen presenting cells taken from a patient and clonally propagated ex vivo for transplant back into the same patient.
- Transfected cells may be reintroduced into the patient using any means known in the art, preferably in sterile form by intravenous, iiitracavitary, intraperitoneal or intratumor administration.
- compositions provided herein may be used alone or in combination with conventional therapeutic regimens such as surgery, inadiation, chemotherapy and/or bone manow transplantation (autologous, syngeneic, allogeneic or unrelated).
- binding agents and T cells as provided herein may be used for purging of autologous stem cells. Such purging may be beneficial prior to, for example, bone manow transplantation or transfusion of blood or components thereof.
- Binding agents, T cells, antigen presenting cells (APC) and compositions provided herein may further be used for expanding and stimulating (or priming) autologous, allogeneic, syngeneic or unrelated hematological malignancy-related antigen-specific T-cells in vitro and/or in vivo.
- Such hematological malignancy-related antigen-specific T cells may be used, for example, within donor lymphocyte infusions.
- the pharmaceutical compositions and vaccines may be administered by injection (e.g., intracutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or subcutaneous), intranasally (e.g., by aspiration) or orally.
- injection e.g., intracutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or subcutaneous
- intranasally e.g., by aspiration
- between 1 and 10 doses may be administered over a 52 week period.
- 6 doses are administered, at intervals of 1 month, and booster vaccinations may be given periodically thereafter. Alternate protocols may be appropriate for individual patients.
- a suitable dose is an amount of a compound that, when administered as described above, is capable of promoting an anti-tumor immune response, and is at least 10-50%) above the basal (i.e., untreated) level.
- Such response can be monitored by measuring the anti-tumor antibodies in a patient or by vaccine-dependent generation of cytolytic effector cells capable of killing the patient's tumor cells in vitro.
- Such vaccines should also be capable of causing an immune response that leads to an improved clinical outcome (e.g., more frequent remissions, complete or partial or longer disease-free survival) in vaccinated patients as compared to non-vaccinated patients.
- the amount of each polypeptide present in a dose ranges from about 100 ⁇ g to 5 mg per kg of host. Suitable dose sizes will vary with the size of the patient, but will typically range from about 0.1 mL to about 5 mL.
- an appropriate dosage and treatment regimen provides the active compound(s) in an amount sufficient to provide therapeutic and/or prophylactic benefit.
- a response can be monitored by establishing an improved clinical outcome (e.g., more frequent remissions, complete or partial, or longer disease-free survival) in treated patients as compared to non-treated patients.
- Increases in preexisting immune responses to a hematological malignancy-related antigen generally conelate with an improved clinical outcome.
- Such immune responses may generally be evaluated using standard proliferation, cytotoxicity or cytokine assays, which may be performed using samples obtained from a patient before and after treatment.
- methods for inhibiting the development of a malignant disease associated with hematological malignancy-related antigen expression involve the administration of autologous T cells that have been activated in response to a hematological malignancy- related antigen polypeptide or hematological malignancy-related antigen-expressing APC, as described above.
- T cells may be CD4 + and or CD8 + , and may be proliferated as described above.
- the T cells may be administered to the individual in an amount effective to inhibit the
- T cells may be stimulated prior to an autologous bone manow transplantation. Such stimulation may take place in vivo or in vitro.
- bone ma ⁇ ow and/or peripheral blood obtained from a patient may be contacted with a hematological malignancy-related antigen polypeptide, a polynucleotide encoding a hematological malignancy-related antigen polypeptide and/or an APC that expresses a hematological malignancy-related antigen polypeptide under conditions and for a time sufficient to permit the stimulation of T cells as described above.
- Bone manow, peripheral blood stem cells and/or hematological malignancy- related antigen-specific T cells may then be administered to a patient using standard techniques.
- T cells of a related or unrelated donor may be stimulated prior to a syngeneic or allogeneic (related or unrelated) bone manow transplantation. Such stimulation may take place in vivo or in vitro.
- bone manow and/or peripheral blood obtained from a related or unrelated donor may be contacted with a hematological malignancy-related antigen polypeptide, hematological mahgnancy-related antigen polynucleotide and/or APC that expresses a hematological malignancy-related antigen polypeptide under conditions and for a time sufficient to permit the stimulation of T cells as described above.
- Bone ma ⁇ ow, peripheral blood stem cells and/or hematological malignancy-related antigen-specific T cells may then be administered to a patient using standard techniques.
- hematological malignancy-related antigen-specific T cells, antibodies or antigen-binding fragments thereof as described herein may be used to remove cells expressing hematological mahgnancy-related antigen from a biological sample, such as autologous bone manow, peripheral blood or a fraction of bone manow or peripheral blood (e.g., CD34 + enriched peripheral blood (PB) prior to administration to a patient).
- a biological sample such as autologous bone manow, peripheral blood or a fraction of bone manow or peripheral blood (e.g., CD34 + enriched peripheral blood (PB) prior to administration to a patient).
- PB peripheral blood
- Such methods may be performed by contacting the biological sample with such T cells, antibodies or antibody fragments under conditions and for a time sufficient to permit the reduction of hematological malignancy-related antigen expressing cells to less than 10%, preferably less than 5% and more preferably less than 1%, of the total number of myeloid or lymphatic cells in the bone manow or peripheral blood.
- Such contact may be achieved, for example, using a column to which antibodies are attached using standard techniques.
- Antigen-expressing cells are retained on the column.
- the extent to which such cells have been removed may be readily determined by standard methods such as, for example, qualitative and quantitative PCR analysis, morphology, immunohistochemistry and FACS analysis. Bone manow or PB (or a fraction thereof) may then be administered to a patient using standard techniques.
- a hematological malignancy may be detected in a patient based on the presence of hematological malignancy-related antigen and/or polynucleotide in a biological sample (such as blood, sera, urine and/or tumor biopsies) obtained from the patient, h other words, hematological malignancy-related antigens may be used as a marker to indicate the presence or absence of such a malignancy.
- the binding agents provided herein generally permit detection of the level of antigen that binds to the agent in the biological sample.
- Polynucleotide primers and probes may be used to detect the level of mRNA encoding hematological malignancy-related antigen, which is also indicative of the presence or absence of a hematological malignancy, fri general, hematological malignancy-related antigen should be present at a level that is at least three fold higher in a sample obtained from a patient afflicted with a hematological malignancy than in the sample obtained from an individual not so afflicted.
- the presence or absence of a hematological malignancy in a patient may be determined by (a) contacting a biological sample obtained from a patient with a binding agent; (b) detecting in the sample a level of polypeptide that binds to the binding agent; and (c) comparing the level of polypeptide with a predetermined cut-off value.
- the assay involves the use of binding agent immobihzed on a solid support to bind to and remove the polypeptide from the remainder of the sample.
- the bound polypeptide may then be detected using a detection reagent that contains a reporter group and specifically binds to the binding agent/polypeptide complex.
- detection reagents may comprise, for example, a binding agent that specifically binds to the polypeptide or an antibody or other agent that specifically binds to the binding agent, such as an anti-immunoglobuhn, protein G, protein A or a lectin.
- a competitive assay may be utilized, in which a polypeptide is labeled with a reporter group and allowed to bind to the immobilized binding agent after incubation of the binding agent with the sample.
- the extent to which components of the sample inhibit the binding of the labeled polypeptide to the binding agent is indicative of the reactivity of the sample with the immobilized binding agent.
- Suitable polypeptides for use within such assays include full length hematological malignancy-related antigens and portions thereof to which the binding agent binds, as described above.
- the solid support may be any material known to those of ordinary skill in the art to which the hematological malignancy-related antigen polypeptide may be attached.
- the solid support may be a test well in a microtiter plate or a nitrocellulose or other suitable membrane.
- the support may be a bead or disc, such as glass, fiberglass, latex or a plastic material such as polystyrene or polyvinylchloride.
- the support may also be a magnetic particle or a fiber optic sensor, such as those disclosed, for example, in U.S. Patent
- the binding agent may be immobilized on the solid support using a variety of techniques known to those of skill in the art, which are amply described in the patent and scientific literature.
- immobilization refers to both noncovalent association, such as adsorption, and covalent attachment (which may be a direct linkage between the agent and functional groups on the support or may be a linkage by way of a cross-linking agent). Immobilization by adsorption to a well in a microtiter plate or to a membrane is prefened. In such cases, adsorption may be achieved by contacting the binding agent, in a suitable buffer, with the sohd support for a suitable amount of time.
- the contact time varies with temperature, but is typically between about 1 hour and about 1 day.
- contacting a well of a plastic microtiter plate (such as polystyrene or polyvinylchloride) with an amount of binding agent ranging from about 10 ng to about 10 ⁇ g, and preferably about 100 ng to about 1 ⁇ g, is sufficient to immobilize an adequate amount of binding agent.
- Covalent attachment of binding agent to a solid support may generally be achieved by first reacting the support with a bifunctional reagent that will react with both the support and a functional group, such as a hydroxyl or amino group, on the binding agent.
- a bifunctional reagent that will react with both the support and a functional group, such as a hydroxyl or amino group, on the binding agent.
- the binding agent may be covalently attached to supports having an appropriate polymer coating using benzoquinone or by condensation of an aldehyde group on the support with an amine and an active hydrogen on the binding partner (see, e.g., Pierce hnmunotechnology Catalog and Handbook, 1991, at A12-A13).
- the assay is a two-antibody sandwich assay.
- This assay may be performed by first contacting an antibody that has been immobilized on a solid support, commonly the well of a microtiter plate, with the sample, such that polypeptides within the sample are allowed to bind to the immobilized antibody. Unbound sample is then removed from the immobilized polypeptide-antibody complexes and a detection reagent (preferably a second antibody capable of binding to a different site on the polypeptide) containing a reporter group is added. The amount of detection reagent that remains bound to the solid support is then determined using a method appropriate for the specific reporter group. More specifically, once the antibody is immobihzed on the support as described above, the remaining protein binding sites on the support are typically blocked. Any suitable blocking agent known to those of ordinary skill in the art, such as bovine serum albumin or Tween 20TM
- an appropriate contact time is a period of time that is sufficient to detect the presence of polypeptide within a sample obtained from an individual with a hematological malignancy.
- the contact time is sufficient to achieve a level of binding that is at least about 95 % of that achieved at equilibrium between bound and unbound polypeptide.
- the time necessary to achieve equilibrium may be readily determined by assaying the level of binding that occurs over a period of time. At room temperature, an incubation time of about 30 minutes is generally sufficient.
- Unbound sample may then be removed by washing the solid support with an appropriate buffer, such as PBS containing 0.1% Tween 20TM.
- the second antibody which contains a reporter group, may then be added to the solid support.
- Prefened reporter groups include those groups recited above.
- the detection reagent is then incubated with the immobilized antibody-polypeptide complex for an amount of time sufficient to detect the bound polypeptide.
- An appropriate amount of time may generally be determined by assaying the level of binding that occurs over a period of time.
- Unbound detection reagent is then removed and bound detection reagent is detected using the reporter group.
- the method employed for detecting the reporter group depends upon the nature of the reporter group. For radioactive groups, scintillation counting or autoradiographic methods are generally appropriate. Spectroscopic methods may be used to detect dyes, luminescent groups and fluorescent groups. Biotin may be detected using avidin, coupled to a different reporter group (commonly a radioactive or fluorescent group or an enzyme).
- Enzyme reporter groups may generally be detected by the addition of substrate (generally for a specific period of time), followed by spectroscopic or other analysis of the reaction products.
- the signal detected from the reporter group that remains bound to the solid support is generally compared to a signal that co ⁇ esponds to a predetermined cut-off value.
- the cut-off value for the detection of a hematological malignancy is the average mean signal obtained when the immobihzed antibody is incubated with samples from patients without the malignancy, hi general, a sample generating a signal that is three standard deviations above the predetermined cut-off value is considered positive for the malignancy.
- the cut-off value is determined using a Receiver Operator Curve, according to the method of Sackett et al, Clinical Epidemiology: A Basic Science for Clinical Medicine, Little Brown and Co., 1985, p. 106-7. Briefly, in this embodiment, the cut-off value may be determined from a plot of pairs of trae positive rates (i.e., sensitivity) and false positive rates
- the cut-off value on the plot that is the closest to the upper left-hand corner is the most accurate cut-off value, and a sample generating a signal that is higher than the cut-off value determined by this method may be considered positive.
- the cut-off value may be shifted to the left along the plot, to minimize the false positive rate, or to the right, to minimize the false negative rate.
- a sample generating a signal that is higher than the cut-off value determined by this method is considered positive for a malignancy.
- the assay is performed in a flow-through or strip test format, wherein the binding agent is immobihzed on a membrane, such as nitrocellulose, hi the flow- through test, polypeptides within the sample bind to the immobilized binding agent as the sample passes through the membrane.
- a second, labeled binding agent then binds to the binding agent-polypeptide complex as a solution containing the second binding agent flows through the membrane.
- the detection of bound second binding agent may then be performed as described above.
- the strip test format one end of the membrane to which binding agent is bound is immersed in a solution containing the sample. The sample migrates along the membrane through a region containing second binding agent and to the area of immobihzed binding agent.
- Concentration of second binding agent at the area of immobilized antibody indicates the presence of a hematological malignancy.
- concentration of second binding agent at that site generates a pattern, such as a line, that can be read visually.
- the absence of such a pattern indicates a negative result, hi general, the amount of binding agent immobilized on the membrane is selected to generate a visually discernible pattern when the biological sample contains a level of polypeptide that would be sufficient to generate a positive signal in the two-antibody sandwich assay, in the format discussed above.
- Prefened binding agents for use in such assays are antibodies and antigen-binding fragments thereof.
- the amount of antibody immobihzed on the membrane ranges from about 25 ng to about l ⁇ g, and more preferably from about 50 ng to about 500 ng.
- Such tests can typically be performed with a very small amount of biological sample.
- numerous other assay protocols exist that are suitable for use with the hematological mahgnancy-related antigen sequences or binding agents of the present invention. The above descriptions are intended to be exemplary only. For example, it will be apparent to those of ordinary skill in the art that the above protocols may be readily modified to use hematological malignancy-related antigen polypeptides to detect antibodies that bind to such polypeptides in a biological sample. The detection of hematological malignancy-related antigen-specific antibodies may conelate with the presence of a hematological.
- a malignancy may also, or alternatively, be detected based on the presence of T cells that specifically react with hematological malignancy-related antigen in a biological sample.
- a biological sample comprising CD4 + and/or CD8 + T cells isolated from a patient is incubated with a hematological malignancy-related antigen polypeptide, a polynucleotide encoding such a polypeptide and or an APC that expresses such a polypeptide, and the presence or absence of specific activation of the T cells is detected.
- Suitable biological samples include, but are not limited to, isolated T cells.
- T cells may be isolated from a patient by routine techniques (such as by Ficoll/Hypaque density gradient centrifugation of peripheral blood lymphocytes). T cells may be incubated in vitro for 2-9 days (typically 4 days) at 37°C with Mtb-81 or Mtb-67.2 polypeptide (e.g., 5 - 25 ⁇ g/ml). It maybe desirable to incubate another aliquot of a T cell sample in the absence of hematological malignancy-related antigen polypeptide to serve as a control.
- activation is preferably detected by evaluating proliferation of the T cells.
- CD8 + T cells activation is preferably detected by evaluating cytolytic activity.
- a level of proliferation that is at least two fold greater and/or a level of cytolytic activity that is at least 20%> greater than in disease-free patients indicates the presence of a hematological mahgnancy in the patient.
- a hematological malignancy may also, or alternatively, be detected based on the level of mRNA encoding hematological malignancy-related antigen in a biological sample.
- at least two ohgonucleotide primers may be employed in a polymerase chain reaction (PCR) based assay to amplify a portion of hematological malignancy-related antigen cDNA derived from a biological sample, wherein at least one of the ohgonucleotide primers is specific for (i.e., hybridizes to) a polynucleotide encoding the hematological malignancy-related antigen protein.
- PCR polymerase chain reaction
- the amplified cDNA is then separated and detected using techniques well known in the art, such as gel electrophoresis.
- ohgonucleotide probes that specifically hybridize to a polynucleotide encoding hematological malignancy-related antigen may be used in a hybridization assay to detect the presence of polynucleotide encoding hematological malignancy-related antigen in a biological sample.
- ohgonucleotide primers and probes should comprise an ohgonucleotide sequence that has at least about 60% > , preferably at least about 75%o and more preferably at least about 90%>, identity to a portion of a polynucleotide encoding hematological malignancy-related antigen that is at least 10 nucleotides, and preferably at least 20 nucleotides, in length.
- ohgonucleotide primers and/or probes hybridize to a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide described herein under moderately stringent conditions, as defined above.
- Ohgonucleotide primers and/or probes which may be usefully employed in the diagnostic methods described herein preferably are at least 10-40 nucleotides in length. Techniques for both PCR based assays and hybridization assays are well known in the art (see, for example, Mullis et al, Cold Spring Harbor Symp. Quant. Biol, 57:263, 1987; Erlich ed., PCR Technology, Stockton Press, NY, 1989).
- RNA is extracted from a biological sample such as a biopsy tissue and is reverse transcribed to produce cDNA molecules.
- PCR amplification using at least one specific primer generates a cDNA molecule, which may be separated and visualized using, for example, gel electrophoresis.
- Amplification may be performed on biological samples taken from a test patient and from an individual who is not afflicted with a hematological malignancy.
- the amplification reaction may be performed on several dilutions of cDNA spanning two orders of magnitude. A two-fold or greater increase in expression in several dilutions of the test patient sample as compared to the same dilutions of the sample from a normal individual is typically considered positive.
- such assays may be performed using samples enriched for cells expressing the hematological malignancy-related antigen(s) of interest. Such enrichment may be achieved, for example, using a binding agent as provided herein to remove the cells from the remainder of the biological sample. The removed cells may then be assayed as described above for biological samples.
- hematological malignancy-related antigens may be used as markers for monitoring disease progression or the response to therapy of a hematological malignancy.
- assays as described above for the diagnosis of a hematological malignancy may be performed over time, and the change in the level of reactive polypeptide(s) evaluated. For example, the assays may be performed every 24-72 hours for a period of 6 months to 1 year, and thereafter performed as needed.
- a malignancy is progressing in those patients in whom the level of polypeptide detected by the binding agent increases over time. In contrast, the malignancy is not progressing when the level of reactive polypeptide either remains constant or decreases with time.
- Certain in vivo diagnostic assays may be performed directly on a tumor.
- One such assay involves contacting tumor cells with a binding agent.
- the bound binding agent may then be detected directly or indirectly via a reporter group.
- binding agents may also be used in histological applications.
- polynucleotide probes may be used within such applications.
- markers may be assayed within a given sample. It will be apparent that binding agents specific for different proteins provided herein may be combined within a single assay. Further, multiple primers or probes may be used concu ⁇ ently. The selection of markers may be based on routine experiments to determine combinations that results in optimal sensitivity.
- a binding agent may be coupled to a tracer substance, and the diagnosis is performed in vivo using well known techniques. Coupled binding agent may be administered as described above, and extramedullary disease may be detected based on assaying the presence of tracer substance.
- a tracer substance may be associated with a T cell specific for hematological malignancy-related antigen, permitting detection of extramedullary disease based on assays to detect the location of the tracer substance.
- nucleic acid sequences include, but are not limited to, DNAs (including and not limited to genomic or extragenomic DNAs), genes, peptide nucleic acids (PNAs) RNAs (including, but not limited to, rRNAs, mRNAs and tRNAs), nucleosides, and suitable nucleic acid segments either obtained from native sources, chemically synthesized, modified, or otherwise prepared in whole or in part by the hand of man.
- PNAs peptide nucleic acids
- Expression The combination of intracellular processes, including transcription and translation undergone by a polynucleotide such as a structural gene to synthesize the encoded peptide or polypeptide.
- Promoter a term used to generally describe the region or regions of a nucleic acid sequence that regulates transcription.
- Structural gene A gene or sequence region that is expressed to produce an encoded peptide or polypeptide.
- Transformation A process of introducing an exogenous polynucleotide sequence (e.g., a vector, a recombinant DNA or RNA molecule) into a host cell or protoplast in which that exogenous nucleic acid segment is incorporated into at least a first chromosome or is capable of autonomous replication within the transformed host cell.
- Transfection, electroporation, and naked nucleic acid uptake all represent examples of techniques used to transform a host cell with one or more polynucleotides.
- Transformed cell A host cell whose nucleic acid complement has been altered by the introduction of one or more exogenous polynucleotides into that cell.
- Transgenic cell Any cell derived or regenerated from a transformed cell or derived from a transgenic cell, or from the progeny or offspring of any generation of such a transformed host cell.
- Transgenic animal An animal or a progeny or an offspring of any generation thereof that is derived from a transformed animal cell, wherein the animal's DNA contains an introduced exogenous nucleic acid molecule not originally present in a native, wild type, non- transgenic animal of the same species.
- transgenic animal and transformed animal have sometimes been used in the art as synonymous terms to define an animal, the genetic contents of which has been modified to contain one or more exogenous nucleic acid segments.
- a nucleic acid molecule typically comprised of DNA, capable of replication in a host cell and/or to which another nucleic acid segment can be operatively linked so as to bring about replication of the attached segment.
- a plasmid, cosmid, or a virus is an exemplary vector.
- substantially co ⁇ esponds to denotes a characteristic of a nucleic acid or an amino acid sequence, wherein a selected nucleic acid or amino acid sequence has at least about 70 or about 75 percent sequence identity as compared to a selected reference nucleic acid or amino acid sequence. More typically, the selected sequence and the reference sequence will have at least about 76, 77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 82, 83, 84 or even 85 percent sequence identity, and more preferably at least about 86, 87, 88, 89, 90, 91, 92, 93, 94, or 95 percent sequence identity.
- highly homologous sequences often share greater than at least about 96, 97, 98, or 99 percent sequence identity between the selected sequence and the reference sequence to which it was compared.
- the percentage of sequence identity may be calculated over the entire length of the sequences to be compared, or may be calculated by excluding small deletions or additions which total less than about 25 percent or so of the chosen reference sequence.
- the reference sequence may be a subset of a larger sequence, such as a portion of a gene or flanking sequence, or a repetitive portion of a chromosome.
- the reference sequence will typically comprise at least about 18-25 nucleotides, more typically at least about 26 to 35 nucleotides, and even more typically at least about 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, or even 100 or so nucleotides.
- the extent of percent identity between the two sequences will be at least about 80%>, preferably at least about 85%, and more preferably about 90% or 95% or higher, as readily determined by one or more of the sequence comparison algorithms well-known to those of skill in the art, such as e.g., the FASTA program analysis described by Pearson and Lipman (1988).
- naturally occurring refers to the fact that an object can be found in nature.
- a polypeptide or polynucleotide sequence that is present in an organism (including viruses) that can be isolated from a source in nature and which has not been intentionally modified by the hand of man in a laboratory is naturally-occurring.
- laboratory strains of rodents that may have been selectively bred according to classical genetics are considered naturally occurring animals.
- heterologous is defined in relation to a predetermined referenced gene sequence.
- a heterologous promoter is defined as a promoter which does not naturally occur adjacent to the referenced structural gene, but which is positioned by laboratory manipulation.
- a heterologous gene or nucleic acid segment is defined as a gene or segment that does not naturally occur adjacent to the referenced promoter and/or enhancer elements.
- Transcriptional regulatory element refers to a polynucleotide sequence that activates transcription alone or in combination with one or more other nucleic acid sequences.
- a transcriptional regulatory element can, for example, comprise one or more promoters, one or more response elements, one or more negative regulatory elements, and or one or more enhancers.
- a "transcription factor recognition site” and a “transcription factor binding site” refer to a polynucleotide sequence(s) or sequence motif(s) which are identified as being sites for the sequence-specific interaction of one or more transcription factors, frequently taking the form of direct protein-DNA binding.
- transcription factor binding sites can be identified by DNA footprinting, gel mobility shift assays, and the like, and/or can be predicted on the basis of known consensus sequence motifs, or by other methods known to those of skill in the art.
- the term “operably linked” refers to a linkage of two or more polynucleotides or two or more nucleic acid sequences in a functional relationship.
- a nucleic acid is "operably linked" when it is placed into a functional relationship with another nucleic acid sequence.
- a promoter or enhancer is operably linked to a coding sequence if it affects the transcription of the coding sequence.
- Operably linked means that the DNA sequences being linked are typically contiguous and, where necessary to join two protein coding regions, contiguous and in reading frame.
- enhancers generally function when separated from the promoter by several kilobases and intronic sequences may be of variable lengths, some polynucleotide elements may be operably linked but not contiguous.
- Transcriptional unit refers to a polynucleotide sequence that comprises at least a first stractural gene operably linked to at least a first cw-acting promoter sequence and optionally linked operably to one or more other czs-acting nucleic acid sequences necessary for efficient transcription of the stractural gene sequences, and at least a first distal regulatory element as may be required for the appropriate tissue-specific and developmental transcription of the structural gene sequence operably positioned under the control of the promoter and/or enhancer elements, as well as any additional cis sequences that are necessary for efficient transcription and translation (e.g., polyadenylation site(s), mRNA stability controlling sequence(s), etc.
- compositions and methods for using the compositions for example in the therapy and diagnosis of cancer, such as hematological malignancy.
- Certain illustrative compositions described herein include hematological malignancy-related tumor polypeptides, polynucleotides encoding such polypeptides, binding agents such as antibodies, antigen presenting cells (APCs) and/or immune system cells (e.g., T cells).
- APCs antigen presenting cells
- T cells immune system cells
- hematological malignancy-related tumor protein refers generally to a protein that is expressed in hematological malignancy-related tumor cells at a level that is at least two fold, and preferably at least five fold, greater than the level of expression in a normal tissue, as determined using a representative assay provided herein.
- Certain hematological malignancy-related tumor proteins are tumor proteins that react detectably (within an immunoassay, such as an ELISA or Western blot) with antisera of a patient afflicted with hematological mahgnancy.
- Modification and changes may be made in the structure of the polynucleotides and peptides of the present invention and still obtain a functional molecule that encodes a peptide with desirable characteristics, or still obtain a genetic construct with the desirable expression specificity and/or properties.
- various means of introducing mutations into a polynucleotide or peptide sequence known to those of skill in the art may be employed for the preparation of heterologous sequences that may be introduced into the selected cell or animal species.
- the resulting encoded peptide sequence is altered by this mutation, or in other cases, the sequence of the peptide is unchanged by one or more mutations in the encoding polynucleotide. h other circumstances, one or more changes are introduced into the promoter and/or enhancer regions of the polynucleotide constructs to alter the activity, or specificity of the expression elements and thus alter the expression of the heterologous therapeutic nucleic acid segment operably positioned under the control of the elements.
- the amino acid changes may be achieved by changing one or more of the codons of the encoding DNA sequence, according to Table 1.
- amino acids may be substituted for other amino acids in a protein structure without appreciable loss of interactive binding capacity with structures such as, for example, antigen-binding regions of antibodies or binding sites on substrate molecules. Since it is the interactive capacity and nature of a protein that defines that protein's biological functional activity, certain amino acid sequence substitutions can be made in a protein sequence, and, of course, its underlying DNA coding sequence, and nevertheless obtain a protein with like properties. It is thus contemplated by the inventors that various changes may be made in the peptide sequences of the disclosed compositions, or conesponding DNA sequences which encode said peptides without appreciable loss of their biological utility or activity. TABLE 1
- the hydropathic index of amino acids may be considered.
- the importance of the hydropathic amino acid index in conferring interactive biologic function on a protein is generally understood in the art (Kyte and Doolittle, 1982, incorporate herein by reference). It is accepted that the relative hydropathic character of the amino acid contributes to the secondary structure of the resultant protein, which in turn defines the interaction of the protein with other molecules, for example, enzymes, substrates, receptors, DNA, antibodies, antigens, and the like.
- Each amino acid has been assigned a hydropathic index on the basis of their hydrophobicity and charge characteristics (Kyte and Doohttle, 1982), these are: isoleucine
- hydrophilicity values have been assigned to amino acid residues: arginine (+3.0); lysine (+3.0); aspartate (+3.0 + 1); glutamate (+3.0 ⁇ 1); serine (+0.3); asparagine (+0.2); glutamine (+0.2); glycine (0); threonine (-0.4); proline (-0.5 + 1); alanine (-0.5); histidine (-0.5); cysteine (-1.0); methionine (-1.3); valine (-1.5); leucine (-1.8); isoleucine (-1.8); tyrosine (-2.3); phenylalanine (-2.5); tryptophan (-3.4).
- an amino acid can be substituted for another having a similar hydrophilicity value and still obtain a biologically equivalent, and in particular, an immunologically equivalent protein, h such changes, the substitution of amino acids whose hydrophilicity values are within +2 is prefened, those that are within +1 are particularly prefened, and those within ⁇ 0.5 are even more particularly prefened.
- amino acid substitutions are generally therefore based on the relative similarity of the amino acid side-chain substituents, for example, their hydrophobicity, hydrophilicity, charge, size, and the like.
- Exemplary substitutions which take several of the foregoing characteristics into consideration are well known to those of skill hi the art and include: arginine and lysine; glutamate and aspartate; serine and threonine; glutamine and asparagine; and valine, leucine and isoleucine.
- This Example illustrates the identification of hematological malignancy-related antigen polynucleotides from non-Hodgkin's lymphomas.
- TCS libraries T cell non- Hodgkin's lymphoma mRNAs
- BCNHL libraries B cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma mRNAs
- HLS libraries Two other libraries were constructed using a pool of 2 Hodgkin's lymphoma mRNAs (refened to herein as HLS libraries.
- cDNA synthesis, hybridization and PCR amplification were performed according to Clontech's user manual (PCR-Select cDNA Subtraction), with the following changes: 1) cDNA was restricted with a mixture of enzymes, including Msc7, PvuII, Stul and Dral, instead of the single enzyme Rsal; and 2) the ratio of driver to tester cDNA was increased in the hybridization steps (to 76:1) to give a more stringent subtraction.
- the two TCS libraries were independently subtracted with different pools of driver cDNAs.
- Driver #1 contained cDNA prepared from specific normal tissues (lymph node, bone marrow, T cells, heart and brain), and this subtraction generated the library TCS-D1 (T cell non- Hodgkin's lymphoma subtracted library with driver #1).
- Driver #2 contained non-specific normal tissues (colon, large intestine, lung, pancreas, spinal cord, skeletal muscle, hver, kidney, skin and brain), and this subtraction generated the library TCS-D2 (T cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma subtraction library with driver #2).
- Driver #1 contained cDNA prepared from specific normal tissues (lymph node, bone manow, B cells, heart and brain), and this subtraction generated the library
- BCNHL/D1 B cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma subtracted library with driver #1.
- Driver #2 contained non-specific normal tissues (brain, lung, pancreas, spinal cord, skeletal muscle, colon, spleen, large intestine and PBMC), and this subtraction generated the library BCNHL/D2 (B cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma subtraction library with driver #2).
- Driver #1 contained cDNA prepared from specific normal tissues (lymph node, bone manow, B cells and lung) and this subtraction generated HLS-D1 (Hodgkin's lymphoma subtraction library with driver #1).
- Driver #2 contained non-specific normal tissues (colon, large intestine, lung, pancreas, spinal cord, skeletal muscle, liver, kidney, skin and brain) and this generated the library HLS-D2 (Hodgkin's lymphoma subtraction library with driver #2).
- actin a housekeeping gene
- actin was PCR amplified from dilutions of subtracted as well as unsubtracted PCR samples.
- complexity and redundancy of each library was characterized by sequencing 96 clones from each of the PCR subtraction libraries (TCS-D1, TCS-D2, BCNHL/D1, BCNHL D2, HLS-D1 and HLS-D2).
- the cDNAs were cloned into the pCR2.1-TOPO plasmid vector (Invitrogen).
- cDNA sequences were analyzed by microanay analysis to evaluate their expression in hematological malignancies and normal tissues. Using this approach, cDNA sequences were PCR amplified and their mRNA expression profiles in hematological malignancies and normal tissues are examined using cDNA microanay technology essentially as described (Shena et al, 1995).
- the clones identified from the subtracted cDNA libraries analyses were immobilized and anayed onto glass slides as multiple replicas on microanay slides and the slides were hybridized with two different sets of probes, with each location on the microanay slide conesponding to a unique cDNA clone (as many as 5500 clones can be anayed on a single slide, or chip).
- Each chip is hybridized with a pair of cDNA probes that are fluorescence-labeled with Cy3 and Cy5, respectively.
- the set of probes derived from the hematological malignancies was labeled with cy3 while the other set of probes derived from a pool of normal tissues was labeled with cy5.
- cy3/cy5 ratios The difference in intensities (i.e., cy3/cy5 ratios) following hybridization with both probe sets provided the information on the relative expression level of each cDNA sequences immobilized on the slide in tumor versus normal tissues.
- the probe quality is monitored using a panel of ubiquitously expressed genes.
- the control plate also can include yeast DNA fragments of which complementary RNA may be spiked into the probe synthesis for measuring the quality of the probe and the sensitivity of the analysis. This methodology provides a sensitivity of 1 in 100,000 copies of mRNA, and the reproducibihty of the technology may be ensured by including duplicated control cDNA elements at different locations.
- Table 7 in co-pending application USSN 09/796,692 lists the sequences of the polynucleotides obtained during the analyses of the present invention. Shown are the 668 polynucleotide sequences, along with their clone name identifiers, as well as the serial number and filing date of the priority provisional patent application in which the clone was first identified.
- Table 8 in co-pending application USSN 09/796,692 identifies the putative open reading frames obtained from analyses of the cDNA sequences obtained in SEQ TD NO:l-
- SEQ ID NO:668 in the co-pending application. Shown are the sequence identifiers, the clone name and translation frame, and the start and stop nucleotides in the conesponding DNA sequence used to generate the polypeptide sequence of the open reading frame.
- Table 9 in co-pending application USSN 09/796,692 identifies an additional set of particular hematological malignancy-related cDNA sequences that were obtained using the subtractive library and microanay methods as described above. These sequences, designated SEQ ID NO:2533-SEQ ID NO:9597 in the co-pending application, are shown in the Table along with the original clone name, and the serial number and filing date of the priority provisional application in which the clone was first described.
- SEQ ID NO:9599 in co-pending application USSN 10/040,862 also termed "Lyl448P," a portion of which was disclosed earlier in co-pending application USSN 09/796,692 as SEQ ID NO: 636 was identified in a series of Micro Array analyses as described in Examples 1-3 in sections 5.1-5.3 of co-pending application USSN 09/796,692. Oligonucleotides directed against a portion of SEQ ED NO:9599 were used in a series of RealTime PCR experiments using RNAs isolated from normal cells and hematologically malignant cells.
- SEQ ID NO:9599 appeared to be expressed in normal B cell lines, CD 19 + cell lines, and highly expressed in a subset of Non- Hodgkin's B-cell lymphoma cell lines, Hodgkin's lymphoma cell hnes, folhcular lymphoma cell hnes, and Chronic Lymphocytic Leukemia cell lines.
- SEQ ED NO:9599 which is a 523 base pair cDNA fragment
- SEQ ID NO:9598 also termed “LS 1384258.1” which is a 622 base pair cDNA fragment
- SEQ ID NO:9600 also termed "LS 368109.1” which is a 1,908 base pair cDNA.
- SEQ YD NO: 9600 begins at nucleotide 777, ends at nucleotide 1562 and encodes a 261 amino acid protein as identified in SEQ ED NO.9611, termed Lyl448P protein.
- SEQ ID NO:9600 is a type-lb membrane protein, containing a predicted transmembrane domain beginning at amino acid 156 and ending at amino acid 177.
- the extracellular portion of SEQ ED NO:9611 has homology with immunoglobulins and contains a predicted Ig-like domain.
- SEQ TD NO:9611 contains Src Homology-2 (SH2) binding domains an Immune Receptor Tyrosine-Based Inhibition Motif (ITEM) and an Immune Receptor Tyrosine-based Activation Motif (ITAM).
- ITEM Immune Receptor Tyrosine-Based Inhibition Motif
- ITAM Immune Receptor Tyrosine-based Activation Motif
- Lyl448P shares homology with two other protein families, the SPAP1 family and the ERTA family. Lyl448P shares homology with the SPAPl family of proteins which consists of 3 members, SPAPla, SPAPlb, and SPAPlc. As discussed in more detail below, the SPAPl proteins identified all have a unique 42 amino acid te ⁇ ninus. SPAPlb has a unique 18 amino acid carboxy terminus and SPAPlc has a unique 9 amino acid carboxy terminus. Lyl448P also shares homology with the ERTA family of proteins and specifically ERTA 4. As discussed in more detail below, Lyl448P and ERTA4 share multiple exons and the proteins identified appear to arise from alternative splicing events.
- This example illustrates the identification of peptides useful for generating cytotoxic T cell or helper T cell responses.
- Lyl448P protein peptides useful for generating a cellular immune response were identified. Prefened epitope binding motifs for many of the HLA class I and class II molecules are known. The Lyl448P amino acid sequence was searched for peptides that would bind to the specific HLA molecules identified in Table 2. 9mer peptides predicted to bind to each of the specific HLA molecules were identified and SEQ ED NOs conesponding to the peptides which bind to each HLA molecule are indicated.
- HLA A_0201 SEQ ID Nos:9618-9637
- HLA A_l 101 SEQ ID NOs:9738-9757
- HLA B60 SEQ ID NOs:9838-9857
- HLA B61 SEQ ID Nos:9858-9877
- HLA B7 SEQ ID NOs:9898-9917
- HLA B8 SEQ ID NOs:9918-9937
- HLA B_2702 SEQ ED NOs:9938-9957
- HLA B_2705 SEQ ED NOs:9958-9977
- HLA B_3701 SEQ ED NOs:9998-10017
- HLAB_3902 SEQ ED NOs: 10038- 10057
- HLAB_5101 SEQ ID Nos: 10078-10097
- HLAB_5102 SEQ ID NOs: 10098-10117
- HLAB_5201 SEQ ID NOs: 10138-10157
- HLA Cw_0401 SEQ ID NOs:10198-10217
- HLA Cw_0602 SEQ ID NOs:10218-10237
- HLA Db SEQ ID Nos:10258-10277
- HLA Kb SEQ ID Nos:10318-10337
- HLA Kk SEQ ID Nos:10358-10377
- HLA Kk SEQ ID Nos:10378-10397
- HLA Cattle_A20 SEQ ED NOs: 10418-10437
- TSITES identified the location of predicted amphipathic helices (A), the location of amino acid residues matching the Rothbard/Taylor motif (R), the location of residues matching the IAd motif (D) and the location of residues matching the IEd motif (d). Based on this analysis, four additional peptides were identified that are predicted to contain epitopes that will bind to CD4 T cells.
- Peptide 1 spans amino acids 40-78 of the Lyl448P protein and is represented by SEQ ED NO: 10455.
- Peptide 2 spans amino acids 127-150 of the Lyl448P protein and is represented by SEQ ED NO:10456.
- Peptide 3 spans amino acids 210-233 of the Lyl448P protein and is represented by SEQ ED NO:10457.
- Peptide 4 spans amino acids 141-178 of the Lyl448P protein and is represented by SEQ ED NO: 10458.
- Lyl448P protein immunogenic peptides comprising 5 non-overlapping 31mer or 32mer amino acid fragments (SEQ ED NOs:9613-9617) of the extracellular domain Lyl448P protein (amino acids 1-156 of SEQ ED NO:9611) were generated and are being used to generate antibodies specific for the Lyl448P protein. These antibodies will be useful in recognizing Lyl448P protein for diagnostic and therapeutic use in both normal and diseased cells. Each peptide fragment used to generate antibodies also contains a GCG peptide linker sequence at the carboxy-terminus of the fragment. These antibodies may also recognize the IRTA4 protein. Antibodies immunoreactive to epitopes present on peptides defined by SEQ
- ED NOs:9614-9617 may also recognize epitopes present in SPAPla.
- Antibodies which recognize epitopes present on peptides identified by SEQ ED NOs:10438 and 10439 will recognize Lyl448P protein whereas antibodies which recognize epitopes present on peptides identified by SEQ ID NOs: 10440-10454 may recognize both Lyl448P and SPAPla proteins.
- Antibodies generated against all of these peptides may also recognize ERTA4. Antibodies generated against these 17 overlapping peptides will be useful for both diagnostic and therapeutic purposes.
- This example illustrates the identification of peptides useful for generating cytotoxic T cell or helper T cell responses.
- This example illustrates the identification of two specific genes that are associated with B cell leukemias, lymphomas and multiple myelomas.
- Lyl447 and Lyl481 are cDNAs also associated with B cell leukemias, lymphomas and multiple myelomas.
- the nucleotide sequence of Ly 1447 is disclosed herein as SEQ TD
- SEQ ID NO:9602. The nucleotide sequence of Lyl481 is disclosed herein as SEQ TD NO:9603.
- the amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO:6 is disclosed herein as SEQ ID NO:10466.
- SEQ ID NOs:9602 and 9603 were used in BLASTX searches of both GenBank and
- GenSeq databases Homologous sequences were only found in the GenSeq database. This analysis showed that SEQ TD NO:9602 was homologous to the 3' untranslated region of the
- SEQ ID NO:9603 was homologous to a portion of the coding region of ERT A3 also on chromosome 1.
- the ERTA superfamily of genes comprises ERTA 1, 2a, 2b, 2c, 3, 4, and 5, whose nucleic acid sequences are disclosed herein as SEQ ID NOs:9604-9610 respectively and whose conesponding amino acid sequences are disclosed herein as SEQ ED NOs:10459- 10465 respectively.
- These ERTA genes are located on chromosome 1 (q21) and are associated with chromosomal translocations. These translocations combine a portion of chromosome 1 with a portion of chromosome 14 (q32). This portion of chromosome 14 is the location of the genes encoding the immunoglobulin proteins. These chromosomal translocations are associated with various B cell leukemias, lymphomas and multiple myelomas.
- Lyl448P-specific and TCL-1 -specific antibodies are present in the sera of patients with hematological malignancies, such as, but not restricted to, lymphoma. Detection of these specific antibodies provides a tool for early diagnosis of hematological malignancies; specifically for the screening of healthy individuals or individuals at risk for developing lymphomas, such as transplant recipients and immunocompromised patients (i.e., AEDS patients) for the presence of hematological malignancies or a marker for monitoring minimal residual disease. Furthermore, these data demonstrate that Lyl448P and TCL-1 are immunogenic in patients.
- Figure 5 shows the Lyl448P specific Ab data (black and white).
- This example illustrates the identification of all of the exons and the various spliced forms of the Lyl448P gene and its encoded protein that are associated with B cell leukemias, lymphomas and multiple myelomas.
- Lyl448P (SEQ ID NO:9600) was used to screen the publicly available human genome database, Genbank and private databases. Additional Lyl448P sequences are presented here in SEQ ED NO:l 1,016. Homologous sequences were identified in the databases and on human chromosome 1.
- a BLAST search of GenBank determined that Lyl448P protein shared homology with three recently identified proteins, SH2 domain- containing phosphatase anchor proteins la (SPAPla) lb (SPAPlb) and lc (SPAPlc), Xu et al, Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 280: 768-775 (2001).
- the nucleic acid sequence encoding SPAPla is 765 nucleotides long (SEQ TD. NO: 11,036) and encodes a protein 255 amino acids long (SEQ ED NOs:9612 and 11,057). Additional SPAPla nucleotide sequences may be found in SEQ ID NOs:9601, 11,035 and Genbank Accession No. AF319438.
- SPAPlb is an alternatively spliced variant of both Lyl448P and SPAPla.
- the nucleic acid sequence encoding SPAPlb is 576 bp (SEQ ID NO: 11,038) and encodes a protein 192 amino acids long (SEQ ID NO:l 1,058). Additional SPAPlb nucleotide sequences may be found in SEQ ED NO: 11, 037 and Genbank Accession No. AF319439.
- SPAPlc is an alternatively spliced variant of Lyl448P and SPAPsla and lb.
- the nucleotide sequence encoding SPAPlc is 432 nucleotides long (SEQ TD NO:11292 and GenBank Acession No: AF319440) and encodes a protein 144 amino acids long (SEQ ED NO:11293).
- ERTA4 Immunoglobulin Receptor Translocation Associated Protein 4
- the nucleotide sequence encoding IRTA4 is 1524 nucleotides long (SEQ ID NO:11,001), and encodes a protein 508 amino acids long (SEQ ED NOs:10,464 and 11,039).
- ERTA4 nucleotide sequences may be found in SEQ ED NOs:9609, 11,000 and Genbank Accession No. AF459633. Recently ERTA4 was also identified as a member of a family of Fc receptor homologs, specifically FcRH2 (Davis et al, Proc. Nat. Acad. Sci. USA 98:9772-9777 (2001) and Genbank Accession No. AY043465). Family members exhibit preferential B cell expression.
- PCR primers comprising nucleotide sequences 5'CTGCTGTGGTCATTGCTGGTC3' (sense) (SEQ ED NO:l 1,059) and 5'GACACTGGAATTCTCACAGGGATATTC3' (antisense) (SEQ ED NO: 11,060) were used to amplify ERTA4 and ERTA4 like sequences from a B cell cDNA library comprising cDNAs prepared from three B cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma samples.
- SEQ ID NO: 11032 is 2392 nucleotides in length and contains two open reading frames.
- Open reading frame 1 (ORF1") (SEQ ID NO:l 1,033) is 420 nucleotides long and encodes a 140 amino acid protein (SEQ ED NO:l 1,055).
- Open reading frame 2 (ORF2”) (SEQ ID NO: 11,034) is 783 nucleotides long and encodes a 261 amino acid protein (SEQ ID NO: 11,056).
- Exons and introns were identified by comparing the publicly available chromosome 1 genomic sequence data to nucleotides encoding a Lyl448P fragment, IRTA4, LY1448P, Patti PCR Clone, SPAPla, lb, and lc, (SEQ ID NOs:9598, 11,000, 11,016, 11,032, 11,035, 11,037 and 11,292 respectively) and are shown diagrammatically in Figure 7. Open reading frames were identified using the DNASTARTM MapDraw program (DNASTAR Inc.). This comparison identified 18 exons in this region of chromosome 1. This comparison further identified alternatively used exons and exons containing alternatively used splice donors or splice acceptors. Sequences for each of these exons and exons containing alternatively used splice donors or acceptors are found in SEQ ED NOs:10,979-10,999 as shown in Table 4. Table 4
- Exons 10 and 13 contain alternatively used splice donors and exons 11 and 12 contain alternatively used splice acceptors.
- Full length exon 11 is used in the Lyl448P fragment (SEQ ED NO:9598). All other transcripts use the alternative splice acceptor form of exon 11.
- Full length exon 12 contains a translation start site and is used in all SPAPl transcripts (splice forms r and s and SPAPlc) (SEQ ID NOs:ll,035-ll,038 and 11,291-11,292).
- Splice form SPAPlc does not contain any exon 13 sequences and contains 27 additional nucleotides at the 3' end of exon 12 encoding 9 additional amino acids that are found at the carboxy terminus of SPAPlc protein (SEQ TD NOs:l 1,293).
- Full length exon 13 is used in SPAPlb transcripts (splice form s) (SEQ TD NO: 11,037-11,038) and contains a transcription stop codon and polyadenylation signals.
- Exon 7 contains a translational start site and is used in IRTA4 transcripts (splice forms a-h and q) (SEQ ED NOs:l 1,000-11,015 and 11,032-11,033).
- Exons 1-6 are used in Lyl448P transcripts (splice forms i-p) (SEQ ID NOs:ll,016-ll,31).
- Exon 9 contains a translation start site for splice forms i-p.
- Exon 10 using the alternative splice donor is found in the Patti PCR Clone (splice form ql) (SEQ TD NOs:ll,032-ll,034.
- Exons 13 and 13GT contain the transmembrane domain.
- Exon 12 contains the translation start sight for splice forms r and s.
- the multiple alternate splice forms for genes and their encoded proteins include both predicted membrane (receptor) and non-membrane molecules.
- Patti PCR Clone ORF1 encodes a secreted non-membrane bound molecule (SEQ ID NOs: 11,032- 11,033 and 11,055).
- Patti PCR Clone ORF1 contains the extracellular domains found in exons 7-9 and 10GT and novel amino acids encoded by exon AG11 (see Fig. 9, splice form ql).
- SPAPlc also encodes a secreted protein (SEQ ID NOs:l 1,291-11,293).
- SPAPlc contains the same amino terminal 135 amino acids found in SPAPla and lb and contains a unique 9 amino acid carboxy terminus. All of the alternatively spliced molecules identified in Figures 8 and Table 5 and shown diagrammatically in Figure 9 have different biological activity.
- different membrane (receptor) Lyl448P molecules can have different signal transduction properties dependent on the composition of their intracellular polypeptide sequence (the "signaling" portion of the molecule) and their extracellular polypeptide sequence (the "ligand-binding" portion of the molecule).
- the linking of different extracellular domains to different intracellular sequences provides for receptors that yield different functional signals (e.g. proliferation, differentiation, apoptosis) in response to the same or a different ligand.
- Non-membrane Lyl448P molecules act to modulate signal from the membrane receptor Lyl448P molecules by acting as competitors by binding to ligand, or by binding to intracellular proteins responsible for transducing the signal from the receptor. Such examples result in both positive (e.g. proliferation/differentiation) and negative (e.g. apoptosis) affects on cells expressing these proteins.
- Antibodies directed to the various forms of Lyl448P, wliich in turn contain different epitopes, modulate the biological effect of Lyl448P in a similar manner.
- Probes e.g.
- antibodies or oligonucleotides directed to alternatively spliced forms of the proteins or nucleic acids are useful as diagnostics to determine which Lyl448P variant is being expressed. These probes are useful as therapeutics to antagonize the specific forms of the Lyl448P gene or protein. Table 5
- This example illustrates the production of recombinant Lyl448P protein in E. coli. This example further illustrates the production of polyclonal and mono-clonal anti-sera against that recombinant protein. These anti-sera are useful as diagnostics to identify tumors expressing the Lyl448P antigen. These anti-sera are useful as therapeutics for treating tumors expressing the Lyl448P antigen.
- the nucleotide sequence encoding Lyl448P (nucleotides 780-1573 of SEQ ED NO:9600) were cloned into the E. coli expression vector pET 28 which had been modified to include nucleotides encoding an initiation methionine residue, a glutamine residue and a six amino acid histidine tag adjacent to transcription initiation sequences of the vector.
- PCR primers comprising nucleotide sequences 780-801 (sense) and 1559-1573 (antisense) of SEQ TD NO: 9600 were used to amplify a nucleotide sequence encoding amino acids 2-261 of SEQ TD NO:9611 using standard techniques (Sambrook et al, supra and Ausubel et al, supra).
- the antisense primer also contained a Xhol restriction enzyme site to facilitate cloning.
- the resulting PCR product was digested with Xhol and ligated into the modified pET 28 which had been digested with Eco 721 and Xhol.
- Lyl448P protein was purified from recombinant bacterial cultures. Lyl448P protein was purified from cell lysates by Ni column chromatography (Qiagen), followed by anion exchange chromatography and anti-his affinity chromatography steps.
- ELISA analysis of antigen specificity rabbit sera were titered against Lyl448P- coated (0.1 mg/well) 96-well microtiter plates. Samples were diluted initially at 1:100, and then serially diluted 3 fold and added to the plates in duplicate. Antigen specific binding of rabbit IgG to the plate was revealed by goat anti-rabbit IgG (H+L)-HRP conjugate, and the plates were developed with TMB substrate and read at OD450nm on a microplate reader.
- FACS analysis HEK293 and Lyl448P/HEK293 cells (infra) were collected and washed with ice cold staining buffer (PBS+l%BSA+Sodium Azide).
- the cells were resuspended in 50ul staining buffer and incubated for 30 minutes on ice with 75ul of rabbit anti- Lyl448P recombinant or peptide sera diluted 1:500. Pre-bleed sera was used at the same concentration as a negative control.
- the cells were washed 3 times with staining buffer and then incubated with a 1:100 dilution of a goat anti-rabbit Ig(H+L)-FITC reagent (Southern Biotechnology) for 30 minutes on ice. Following 3 washes, the cells were resuspended in staining buffer containing Propidium Iodide (PI), a vital stain that allows for identification of permeable cells, and analyzed by FACS.
- PI Propidium Iodide
- the results of the FACS analysis show that the polyclonal antisera raised against the full length recombinant protein (anti-Lyl448P antisera) and both synthetic peptides (anti-peptide anti-sera) were able to recognize and bind to full length, native Lyl448P expressed in HEK293 transfectants.
- Pre-immunization (pre-bleed) antisera obtained from the each rabbit did not bind to the Lyl448P/HEK293 expressing cells.
- anti-Lyl448P and anti-peptide antisera did not bind to control HEK293 cells.
- Anti-peptide 3 raised against the synthetic peptide 3 (SEQ ID NO:9615) bound strongly to peptide 3 (SEQ ID NO:9615) and the recombinant Lyl448P protein. Anti- peptide 3 bound weakly to peptide 1.
- Murine monoclonal antibodies specific for recombinant Lyl448P were also generated. The monoclonal antibodies were raised by immunization of mice with bacterially-expressed recombinant protein Lyl448P. Conventional antibody-secreting murine hybridomas were made by fusion of the immune spleen cells with murine myeloma cells. Lyl448P specific mAbs were identified in the supernatants of the hybridomas by ELISA using recombinant Lyl448P protein and Lyl448P-FLAG/ ⁇ CEP4/HEK293 transfectants. The hybridomas were cloned and antibody secretion was stabilized.
- mice Female Balb/c mice were immunized intraperitoneally with 10-25 micrograms of bacterially produced recombinant Lyl448P protein in adjuvant at intervals of 9 to 60 days. After five immunizations in adjuvant, 3 micrograms of recombinant protein were administered intravenously in the absence of adjuvant. Two days later immune spleen cells were harvested and hybridomas were made using conventional PEG-mediated fusion and cells were distributed among several hundred microtiter wells and cultured under HAT selection. In approximately 2 weeks a majority of wells showed growth and supernatants were harvested and assayed by ELISA for the presence of antibody reactive to recombinant
- Lyl448P protein The ELISA method was performed as follows:
- Nunc MaxiSorp 96-well plates (Sigma) were coated overnight at 4°C with peptides at 10 ⁇ g/ml in sodium carbonate buffer (pH9.6), using 100 ⁇ l/ well. Lyl448P recombinant protein and an i ⁇ elevant peptide were coated at 1 ⁇ g/ml as positive and negative controls, respectively. Plates were washed with phosphate buffered saline(PBS)/Tween (Sigma) and blocked with Super Block (250 ⁇ l/well) for 1 hour at room temperature.
- PBS phosphate buffered saline
- Tween Sigma
- Bound antibodies were detected by adding horse radish peroxidase (HRP) conjugated goat anti-mouse IgG Fc ⁇ (Jackson Labs, 1:5000 dilution in PBS/Tween), 150 ⁇ l/well, and incubated for 1 hour at room temperature, o-phenylenediamine (OPD) peroxidase substrate (Sigma) was made and added to the washed plates, 150 ⁇ l/well and incubated for twenty minutes at room temperature. The reaction was stopped by adding 2N HC1, 50 ⁇ l/ well. Absorbances at 490 nm were measured by a plate reader from Molecular Devices.
- HRP horse radish peroxidase
- OPD o-phenylenediamine
- mAb-secreting clones were identified using the recombinant Lyl448P protein ELISA assay. 4 cloned mABs were isolated and isotyped:7A9, IgGl; 11E1, IgGl; 18B9, IgG2a; 18H10, IgGl. The specific epitope recognized by these mAbs was determined using synthetic peptides encoding different segments of the Lyl448P protein.
- Lyl448P protein encoded by SEQ ED NO:9600 is a cell surface protein.
- the nucleotide sequence encoding Lyl448P was sub-cloned in to the mammalian expression vector pCEP4 (Invitrogen) as follows.
- the portion of SEQ TD NO:9600 encoding a portion of the Lyl448P protein was PCR amplified using a sense amplimer comprising nucleotides 777-800 of SEQ TD NO:9600 and additional nucleotides on the 5' end which contained a Hindlll restriction enzyme site and an anti-sense primer comprising nucleotides 1544-1570 of SEQ TD NO:9600 and additional nucleotides on the 3'end which contained a Notl restriction enzyme site.
- the PCR product was cloned into the pCR-Blunt vector (Invitrogen), and sequenced.
- DNA from a pCR-Blunt clone with the correct sequence was digested with Hindlll and Notl to release the Lyl448P cDNA insert and subcloned into the mammalian expression vector pCEP4 (Invitrogen) which had been previously modified to contain a c-terminal FLAG epitope tag (Sigma; amino acid sequence DYKDDDDK, SEQ ED NO: 11,290).
- the recombinant vector was transiently transfected into HEK293 cells using Lipofectamine 2000 according to manufacturers instructions (GibcoBRL). Separately, HEK293 cells were also transfected with a control vector containing a recombinant FLAG construct and non-recombinant pCEP4 vector. Transfected cells were cultured for 48 hours and then whole cell lysates were prepared. Lysates were run on a polyacrylamide gel, and the gel was electroblotted onto nitrocellulose membrane using standard techniques (Ausubel et al,).
- the elecfroblot was probed with a mouse anti-FLAG monoclonal antibody and binding of the mouse mAb was detected with a biotinylated rabbit anti-mouse IgG and developed with avidin-HRP and ECL reagent.
- Anti-FLAG antibodies recognized a Lyl448P-FLAG fusion protein of the expected molecular weight.
- Lyl448P protein was present on the cell surface
- HEK293 cells transiently transfected with Lyl448P-FLAG/ ⁇ CEP4 were biotinylated with Biotin-7-NHS, cells were washed and whole cell lysates were generated in TRITON X-100 lysis buffer. Lysates were immunoprecipitated with anti-FLAG Sepharose and the resulting immunoprecipitated material was run on a polyacrylamide gel. The gel was electroblotted onto nitrocellulose membrane and the blot was developed with avidin-HRP and ECL reagent.
- the data show that a protein precipitable with anti-FLAG sepharose of the expected molecular weight for a Lyl448P-FLAG fusion protein was biotinylated in a whole cell assay indicating that Lyl448P is found on the cell surface.
- EXAMPLE 12 - LY1448P is EXPRESSED ON THE CELL SURFACE OF B CELL LEUKEMIAS
- Lyl448P protein is detected on the surface of an acute lymphoblastic leukemia cell line SUP-B15 (ATCC Cat # CRL-1929) using polyclonal antibodies described in Example 10.
- SUP-B15 cells were cultured according to the suppliers recommendation.
- FACS analysis SUP-B15 and human fibroblasts were collected and washed with ice cold staining buffer (PBS+l%BSA+Sodium Azide). Next, the cells were resuspended in 50ul staining buffer and incubated for 30 minutes on ice with 75ul of rabbit anti-Lyl448P recombinant sera diluted 1:500 (see Example 10). Pre-bleed sera was used at the same concentration as a negative control.
- the cells were washed 3 times with staining buffer and then incubated with a 1:100 dilution of a goat anti-rabbit Ig(H+L)-FITC reagent (Southern Biotechnology) for 30 minutes on ice. Following 3 washes, the cells were resuspended in staining buffer containing Propidium
- PI Iodide
- the results of the FACS analysis show that the anti-Lyl448P polyclonal antisera was able to recognize and bind to native Lyl448P normally expressed on the surface of SUP-B15 cells.
- Pre-immunization (pre-bleed) antisera obtained from each rabbit used to produce anti- Lyl448P antisera did not bind to the SUP-B15 cells.
- anti-Lyl448P antisera did not bind to control human fibroblast cells.
- EXAMPLE 13 -NOVEL SPLICE JUNCTIONS ASSOCIATED WITH LY1448P SPLICE VARIANTS
- This example illustrates the identification of 11 novel nucleotide sequences and 11 novel polypeptide sequences useful for differentiating among the multiple splice variants of Lyl448P identified in Example 9.
- the novel polypeptide junctions contain epitopes that are unique. Antibodies specific for each epitope are useful for determining which splice form is expressed in a tumor or tissue sample of interest.
- the nucleotide sequences disclosed are useful as probes for determining which splice variant is being expressed in a tumor or tissue sample of interest.
- Novel junction #1 is identified in splice forms Lyl448P b , d, f, h, i, k, m, and o and shown diagramatically in Figure 9. Novel junction #1 is generated from a splice donor in exon 9 and a splice acceptor in exon (ag)ll. Exon 10 is eliminated in this splice variant of
- Lyl448P novel junction#l 40mer is a polypeptide (SEQ ID NO:l 1,186) containing the 20 amino acids either side of the novel protein junction and contains a novel linear epitope that is recognized by an antibody that is specific to this polypeptide junction and splice forms that encode it.
- Lyl448P novel junction#l 30mer is a shorter polypeptide (SEQ ED NO: 11,187) containing the 15 amino acids either side of the same novel protein junction and contains a more defined novel linear epitope that is recognized by an antibody that is specific to this junction and splice forms that encode it.
- the nucleotide sequence encoding these two polypeptides are identified in SEQ ID NOs: 11,178 and 11,179 respectively.
- Novel junction #2 is identified in splice forms Lyl448P c, d, g, h, k, 1, o, and p shown diagramatically in Figure 9. Novel junction #2 is generated from a splice donor at the end of exon 11 and a splice acceptor in exon 13. Exon 12 is eliminated in this splice variant of Lyl448P.
- Lyl448P novel junction#2 40mer is a polypeptide (SEQ ID NO:ll,188) containing the 20 amino acids on either side of the novel protein junction and contains a novel linear epitope that is recognized by an antibody that is specific to this polypeptide junction and splice forms that encode it.
- Lyl448P novel junction#2 30mer is a shorter polypeptide (SEQ ID NO: 11,189) containing the 15 amino acids either side of the same novel protein junction and contains a more defined novel linear epitope that is recognized by an antibody that is specific to this junction and splice forms that encode it.
- the nucleotide sequence encoding these two polypeptides are identified in SEQ ID NOs: 11,180 and 11,181 respectively.
- Novel junction #3 is identified in splice forms Lyl448P e, f, g, h, m, n, o, p, and s, shown diagramatically in Figure 9. Novel junction #3 is generated by a failure to utilize a splice doner present in exon 13 resulting in a read through of the splice donor adjacent to the transmembrane domain and the synthesis of novel peptides encoded by the remainder of exon 13.
- Lyl448P novel junction#3 38mer is a polypeptide (SEQ ID NO: 11,190) containing the 20 amino acids to the amino side of the exon 13 splice donor and the 18 amino acids to the carboxy side of the exon 13 splice donor. This polypeptide contains a novel linear epitope that is recognized by an antibody that is specific to this polypeptide junction and splice forms that encode it.
- Lyl448P novel junction#3 30mer is a shorter polypeptide (SEQ ID NO: 11,190) containing
- nucleotide sequence encoding these two polypeptides are identified as SEQ ID NOs: 11,182 and 11,183 respectively.
- Novel junction #4 is identified in splice form Lyl448P ql and shown diagramatically in Figure 9. Novel junction #4 is generated from a novel splice doner in exon 10(gt) and a splice acceptor in exon (ag)ll. A portion of exon 10 is eliminated and 4 novel amino acids encoded by exon (ag)l 1 are incorporated in this splice variant. The novel amino acids result from the use of a different reading frame for that portion exon (ag)l 1 contained in this splice variant.
- Lyl448P novel junction#4 24mer is a polypeptide (SEQ ED NO:l 1,192) containing the 20 amino acids to the amino side of the novel protein junction and the 4 amino acids to the carboxy side of the novel protein junction.
- This polypeptide contains a novel linear epitope that is recognized by an antibody that is specific to this polypeptide junction and splice forms that encode it.
- Lyl448P novel junction#4 19mer is a shorter polypeptide (SEQ ID NO: 11,193) containing the 15 amino acids to the amino side of of the novel protein junction and the 4 amino acids to the carboxy side of the novel protein junction.
- This polypeptide contains a novel linear epitope that is recognized by an antibody that is specific to this polypeptide junction and splice forms that encode it.
- the nucleotide sequence encoding these two polypeptides is disclosed in SEQ ID NOs: 11,184 and 11,185 respectively.
- Novel junction #5 is identified in splice forms Lyl448P r and s shown diagramatically in Figure 9. Novel junction #5 is generated by a transcript containing all of exon 12. Translation of the entire exon 12 generates a peptide containing 42 amino acids that are not contained in other Lyl448P variants.
- the nucleotide sequence encoding the polypeptide sequence unique to Lyl448P splice variants r and s and the encoded peptide are disclosed in SEQ TD NOs:l 1,206 and 11,209 respectively.
- Lyl448P #5 plus20mer is a polypeptide (SEQ ED NO:l 1,211) containing the unique Lyl448P variants r and s polypeptide and the 20 amino acids adjacent to the novel peptide encoded by exon 13.
- This polypeptide contains novel linear epitopes that are recognized by antibodies that are specific to this polypeptide and the unique junction encoded by Lyl448P splice forms r and s.
- Lyl448P #5 plusl5mer is a shorter polypeptide (SEQ ID NO: 11,210) containing the unique Lyl448P variants r and s polypeptide and the 15 amino acids adjacent to the novel peptide encoded by exon 13.
- This polypeptide contains more defined novel linear epitopes that are recognized by antibodies that are specific to Lyl448P variants r and s and this junction encoded by exon 13.
- the nucleotide sequence encoding these two polypeptides is included as SEQ ED NOs: 11,208 and 11,207 respectively.
- Antibodies raised against the unique Lyl448P variants r and s polypeptides described Lyl448P #5 plusl5mer and Lyl448P #5 plus20mer are specific to Lyl448P variants r and s.
- SPAPlc is a variant of Lyl448P variants r and s.
- SPAPlc contains the same amino terminal 135 amino acids as Lyl448P variants r and s (also know as SPAPla and lb) but contains a unique 9 amino acid carboxy terminus (SEQ ED NO: 11,293). Antibodies raised against this 9 amino acid region would be able to differentiate between SPAPlc and Lyl448P variants r and s. All of these antibodies are used in the diagnosis, monitoring and therapeutic treatment of hematologic malignancies in general and CLL specifically.
- Antibodies that recognize these epitopes described above specifically recognize splice variants of Lyl448P that encode these epitopes and differentiate from splice variants that do not contain them. Moreover, inclusion of different and novel polypeptide junctions, as a result of differential splicing result in different secondary, tertiary structures of the molecules that contain them. Antibodies directed toward the Lyl448P molecules that occur as a result of differential splicing recognize these novel splice forms based on their unique and different secondary and tertiary structures.
- the Lyl448P variants r and s polypeptides described contain T-cell epitopes that can be utilized as a T-cell therapeutic vaccine for the treatment of hematologic malignancies in general and CLL specifically.
- Polypeptide sequences (9mers) contained within polypeptide sequence Lyl448P #5 plus20mer that are predicted to be bound by different HLA class I subtypes by the EpiSeek HLA class I binding prediction program (Parker et al, J. Immunol. 152:163-175 (1994)) are disclosed in SEQ ID NOs:ll,212-ll,287. 5.14 EXAMPLE 14 ⁇ IDENTIFICATION OF IRTA 1, 2A, 2B, 5 AND LY1448P SPLICE VARIANTS IN B-CELL NEOPLASIAS
- This example illustrates that the cell surface proteins IRTA 1, 2a, 2b, 5 and Lyl448P splice variants are expressed in B-Cell neoplasias. Diagnostic and therapeutic antibodies and compounds directed at these molecules are useful for treating the neoplasias expressing these proteins.
- Forward and reverse primers amplifying a portion of exon 11 contained in Lyl448P splice variants a-p and q2 are disclosed in SEQ ID NOs:l 1,200 and 11,201 respectively.
- Forward and reverse primers amplifying a portion of exon 12 contained in Lyl448P splice variants r and s are disclosed in SEQ TD NOs: 11,202 and 11,203 respectively.
- Forward and reverse ERTA5 primers are disclosed in SEQ ID NOs: 11,204 and 11,205 respectively.
- Forward and reverse CD20 primers are disclosed in SEQ ID NOs: 11,288 and 11,289 respectively.
- Real Time PCR was performed as described by Gibson et al, Genome Research
- Lyl448P splice variants r/s containing full length exon 12 were overexpressed in 59% (10/17) of CLL samples and had no detectable expression (0/5) in B-cell Non-Hodgkinslymphoma/Hodgkins samples at a level comparable or greater than that seen in CD19+ cells.
- Lyl448P splice variants a-p and q2containing a portion of exon 11 were only expressed in 6% (1/17) of CLL samples but was seen in 100% (5/5) of B-cell Non- Hodgkins lymphoma/Hodgkins samples at a level comparable or greater than that seen in CD19+ cells.
- exon 11 containing Lyl448P splice variants is specific to CD 19+ cells and B-cell non-Hodgkins lymphomas/Hodgkins lymphoma samples
- overexpression of full length exon 12 containing Lyl448P splice variants is specific to CD 19+ cells and a majority of CLL samples. Both types of splice variants are expressed in the single folhcular lymphoma sample analysed. However, expression of exon 12 containing Lyl448P splice variants is considerably higher than the expression of exon 11 containing Lyl448P splice variant, requiring only 23-25 cycles to be amplified as compared to 29-31 cycles.
- IRTA2a/b and E .TA5 also show overexpression in CLL samples at a level comparable to that seen with exon 12 containing Lyl448P splice variants.
- ERTA1 in contrast, is overexpressed in lymphoma at lower levels similar to those observed for exon 11 containing Lyl448P splice variants.
- RNA expression data indicate that exon 12 containing Lyl448P splice variants, IRTA2a/b and IRTA5 are overexpressed specifically in CLL at levels that are lower than seen for CD20 but at levels that result in significant protein production.
- Exon 12 containing Lyl448P splice variants, IRTA2a/b and ERTA5 constitute a CLL-specific diagnostic and therapeutic target.
- Exon 11 containing Lyl448P splice variants and ERTA1 are not expressed significantly in CLL but are overexpressed in lymphoma.
- Exon 11 containing Lyl448P splice variants and IRTA1 constitute a lymphoma specific diagnostic and therapeutic target. 5.15 EXAMPLE 15 -- EXPRESSION OF SP APIA
- This example illustrates the cloning of SPAPla (Lyl448P variant r) into the expression vector pCEP4 flag.
- This disclosure also demonstrates that mouse immunization with peptides covering the unique amino terminal 42 amino acid domain of SPAPla generates production of sera antibody which binds SPAPl but not i ⁇ elevant peptides. These polyclonal sera preferentially bind HEK transfected with the SPAPl a-pCEP4 flag construct over an empty ⁇ CEP4 construct, thus demonstrating surface expression of the SPAP-la molecule.
- this example illustrates that both the sera, as well as an anti-flag antibody, identify in western blots an overexpressed 32 kd band in lysates of SPAPl a-pCEP4 flag- transfected HEK cells which is not present in lysates of pCEP4 (empty vector)-transfected HEK cells.
- SPAPla in HEK cells revealed that this antigen can be expressed in mammalian cells on the surface and in the total cell. Positive sera titers by ELISA of SPAPla peptide immunized mice demonstrated the immunogenicity of the antigen. Cells expressing SPAPla may be used as an immunogen for therapeutic monoclonal antibody generation or for use in the generation of SPAPla specific CTL.
- SPAPla Full length SPAPla cDNA template was generated by rt PCR.
- SPAPla was PCR- amplified using primers encoding Hind III restriction site 5' of the ORF (gtaagcttaccatgtgggaatggaaatatgcaac) (SEQ ED NO: 11,294) and a Not I site 3' of the ORF (ggtagcggccgctgatttcttcacagaagagtagatgac) (SEQ ID NO: 11,295).
- This PCR product was cloned into a TOPO blunt shuttle vector (Invitrogen) containing Hind III and Not I cloning sites and a kanamycin-resistance gene.
- This material was used to transform chemically competent E. coli, which were plated to kanamycin-containing agarose plates. Following an overnight incubation, a select clone was grown at 37° C with shaking in 2x YT media and kanamycin. The plasmid DNA was isolated. The plasmid DNA and pCEP4 vector containing a 5" Hind III cloning site, a flag tag epitope 3' of the Not I cloning site as described above, and an ampicillin-resistance gene were both digested with Hind III and Not I. Following gel purification, the SPAPla insert and pCEP4 flag vector were ligated.
- Plates were coated with peptides (10 micrograms/ml) of SPAPla peptides or inelevant peptides. Plates were blocked with 1% BSA/PBS/Tween 20 (Sigma). Following 6 plate washes, serum dilutions were plated in blocking buffer and incubated. Plates were washed, and then anti-mouse-HRP antibody (1:10,000) was plated. Plates were incubated, then washed again. Plates were developed with peroxidase substrate, then quenched with IN H 2 SO 4 , and read for A450- A570. ELISA results demonstrated that sera from mice immunized with SPAPla peptides 1 and 2 have reactivity to SPAPla peptides 1 and 2 but not inelevant peptide at a 1:102400 dilution.
- SPAPla expression was validated by transient transfection of HEK cells with SPAPl a-pCEP4-flag recombinant vector described above, followed by FACS staining with sera of SPAPla peptide immunized mice, or western blot probing with the same sera or anti- flag antibody.
- SPAPl a-pCEP4 flag was validated by transfection of HEK with the construct, followed by flow cytometry to identify surface expression and western blot analysis to identify total expression. Transfection of HEK was performed with two constructs: SPAPla- pCEP4 flag and pCEP4, which contained neither SPAPl nor a flag epitope.
- Samples were stained with dilutions of sera of SPAPla peptide- immunized mouse #4 or sera of a mouse-immunized with an unrelated antigen (inelevant sera) for 30 minutes on ice. Following three washes, samples were stained with a secondary phycoerythrin-conjugated goat anti-mouse immunoglobulin (human immunoglobulin- adsorbed) for 30 minutes on ice. Samples were washed three times before the addition of Pharmingen Via-Probe for the staining of permeabilized cell DNA. Flow cytometry samples were gated so as to collect only the large, dye-impermeable (viable) cells for analysis of phycoerythrin staining.
- the blots were probed with donkey anti-mouse immunoglobulin (H+L)-HRP in TBS-Tween-20-1% milk for 1 hour, and washed 3x. The blot was reassembled and developed with chemilummescent reagent. SPAPla was expressed as a dominant band at 32 kd, and is apparent in lanes of SPAPl a-flag/HEK probed by either the anti-flag or the anti-SP AP 1 a mouse sera, but not in the pCEP4/HEK lanes.
- Cheresh et al "A monoclonal antibody recognizes an O-acetyl sialic acid in a human melanoma-associated ganglioside," J. Biol. Chem., 259:7453-59, 1984. Cheresh et al, "Disialoganglioside GD3 on human melanoma serves as a relevant target antigen for monoclonal antibody-mediated tumor cytolysis," Proc. Natl Acad. Sci. USA, 82:5155-59, 1985.
- Dippold et al "Immunohistochemical localization of ganglioside GD3 in human malignant melanoma, epithelial tumors and normal tissues," Cancer Res., 45:3699-705, 1985. Dippold et al, "Inflammatory response at the tumor site after systemic application of monoclonal anti-GD3-ganglioside antibody to patients with malignant melanoma," Am. Assoc. Cancer Res., 978:247, 1984.
Landscapes
- Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
- Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Immunology (AREA)
- General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
- Cell Biology (AREA)
- Organic Chemistry (AREA)
- Molecular Biology (AREA)
- Hematology (AREA)
- Oncology (AREA)
- Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
- Microbiology (AREA)
- Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
- Public Health (AREA)
- Biochemistry (AREA)
- Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
- Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
- Epidemiology (AREA)
- Analytical Chemistry (AREA)
- Zoology (AREA)
- Biomedical Technology (AREA)
- Urology & Nephrology (AREA)
- Pathology (AREA)
- Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
- Hospice & Palliative Care (AREA)
- Biotechnology (AREA)
- Biophysics (AREA)
- Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
- Mycology (AREA)
- Food Science & Technology (AREA)
- Gastroenterology & Hepatology (AREA)
- Wood Science & Technology (AREA)
- General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Toxicology (AREA)
- General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
- General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
Abstract
Description
Claims
Priority Applications (6)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
CA 2463659 CA2463659A1 (en) | 2001-11-06 | 2002-11-06 | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies |
EP02807085A EP1578347A4 (en) | 2001-11-06 | 2002-11-06 | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies |
KR10-2004-7006885A KR20040072626A (en) | 2001-11-06 | 2002-11-06 | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies |
US10/494,740 US20060269912A1 (en) | 2001-11-06 | 2002-11-06 | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies |
JP2003575890A JP2005523002A (en) | 2001-11-06 | 2002-11-06 | Compositions and methods for detection, diagnosis and treatment of hematological malignancies |
AU2002367594A AU2002367594B8 (en) | 2001-11-06 | 2002-11-06 | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies |
Applications Claiming Priority (4)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US10/040,862 US20030078396A1 (en) | 2000-03-01 | 2001-11-06 | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies |
US10/040,862 | 2001-11-06 | ||
US10/154,884 US20040005561A1 (en) | 2000-03-01 | 2002-05-23 | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies |
US10/154,884 | 2002-05-23 |
Publications (2)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
WO2003077836A2 true WO2003077836A2 (en) | 2003-09-25 |
WO2003077836A3 WO2003077836A3 (en) | 2005-08-11 |
Family
ID=28044043
Family Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
PCT/US2002/035728 WO2003077836A2 (en) | 2001-11-06 | 2002-11-06 | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies |
Country Status (8)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (2) | US20040005561A1 (en) |
EP (1) | EP1578347A4 (en) |
JP (1) | JP2005523002A (en) |
KR (1) | KR20040072626A (en) |
CN (1) | CN1635988A (en) |
AU (1) | AU2002367594B8 (en) |
CA (1) | CA2463659A1 (en) |
WO (1) | WO2003077836A2 (en) |
Cited By (80)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
EP1572925A2 (en) * | 2002-05-15 | 2005-09-14 | Avalon Pharmaceuticals | Cancer-linked gene as target for chemotherapy |
WO2006060533A2 (en) | 2004-12-01 | 2006-06-08 | Genentech, Inc. | Conjugates of 1, 8-bis-naphthalimides with an antibody |
EP2260858A2 (en) | 2003-11-06 | 2010-12-15 | Seattle Genetics, Inc. | Monomethylvaline compounds capable of conjugation to ligands |
WO2011000054A1 (en) | 2009-07-03 | 2011-01-06 | Avipep Pty Ltd | Immuno-conjugates and methods for producing them |
EP2286844A2 (en) | 2004-06-01 | 2011-02-23 | Genentech, Inc. | Antibody-drug conjugates and methods |
WO2011031870A1 (en) | 2009-09-09 | 2011-03-17 | Centrose, Llc | Extracellular targeted drug conjugates |
WO2011056983A1 (en) | 2009-11-05 | 2011-05-12 | Genentech, Inc. | Zirconium-radiolabeled, cysteine engineered antibody conjugates |
WO2011075786A1 (en) | 2009-12-23 | 2011-06-30 | Avipep Pty Ltd | Immuno-conjugates and methods for producing them 2 |
WO2011130598A1 (en) | 2010-04-15 | 2011-10-20 | Spirogen Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2011156328A1 (en) | 2010-06-08 | 2011-12-15 | Genentech, Inc. | Cysteine engineered antibodies and conjugates |
WO2012074757A1 (en) | 2010-11-17 | 2012-06-07 | Genentech, Inc. | Alaninyl maytansinol antibody conjugates |
WO2012142662A1 (en) | 2011-04-21 | 2012-10-26 | Garvan Institute Of Medical Research | Modified variable domain molecules and methods for producing and using them b |
WO2012155019A1 (en) | 2011-05-12 | 2012-11-15 | Genentech, Inc. | Multiple reaction monitoring lc-ms/ms method to detect therapeutic antibodies in animal samples using framework signature pepides |
US8362213B2 (en) | 2009-04-01 | 2013-01-29 | Genentech, Inc. | Anti-FcRH5 antibodies and immunoconjugates and methods of use |
US8466260B2 (en) | 2009-04-01 | 2013-06-18 | Genentech, Inc. | Anti-FcRH5 antibodies and immunoconjugates and methods of use |
WO2013130093A1 (en) | 2012-03-02 | 2013-09-06 | Genentech, Inc. | Biomarkers for treatment with anti-tubulin chemotherapeutic compounds |
WO2014057074A1 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2014-04-17 | Spirogen Sàrl | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2014140862A2 (en) | 2013-03-13 | 2014-09-18 | Spirogen Sarl | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2014140174A1 (en) | 2013-03-13 | 2014-09-18 | Spirogen Sàrl | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2014159981A2 (en) | 2013-03-13 | 2014-10-02 | Spirogen Sarl | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2015023355A1 (en) | 2013-08-12 | 2015-02-19 | Genentech, Inc. | 1-(chloromethyl)-2,3-dihydro-1h-benzo[e]indole dimer antibody-drug conjugate compounds, and methods of use and treatment |
WO2015095227A2 (en) | 2013-12-16 | 2015-06-25 | Genentech, Inc. | Peptidomimetic compounds and antibody-drug conjugates thereof |
WO2015095212A1 (en) | 2013-12-16 | 2015-06-25 | Genentech, Inc. | 1-(chloromethyl)-2,3-dihydro-1h-benzo[e]indole dimer antibody-drug conjugate compounds, and methods of use and treatment |
WO2015095223A2 (en) | 2013-12-16 | 2015-06-25 | Genentech, Inc. | Peptidomimetic compounds and antibody-drug conjugates thereof |
WO2016040825A1 (en) | 2014-09-12 | 2016-03-17 | Genentech, Inc. | Anthracycline disulfide intermediates, antibody-drug conjugates and methods |
WO2016037644A1 (en) | 2014-09-10 | 2016-03-17 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2016040856A2 (en) | 2014-09-12 | 2016-03-17 | Genentech, Inc. | Cysteine engineered antibodies and conjugates |
WO2016090050A1 (en) | 2014-12-03 | 2016-06-09 | Genentech, Inc. | Quaternary amine compounds and antibody-drug conjugates thereof |
EP3088004A1 (en) | 2004-09-23 | 2016-11-02 | Genentech, Inc. | Cysteine engineered antibodies and conjugates |
WO2017059289A1 (en) | 2015-10-02 | 2017-04-06 | Genentech, Inc. | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine antibody drug conjugates and methods of use |
WO2017064675A1 (en) | 2015-10-16 | 2017-04-20 | Genentech, Inc. | Hindered disulfide drug conjugates |
WO2017068511A1 (en) | 2015-10-20 | 2017-04-27 | Genentech, Inc. | Calicheamicin-antibody-drug conjugates and methods of use |
WO2017165734A1 (en) | 2016-03-25 | 2017-09-28 | Genentech, Inc. | Multiplexed total antibody and antibody-conjugated drug quantification assay |
EP3235820A1 (en) | 2014-09-17 | 2017-10-25 | Genentech, Inc. | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and antibody disulfide conjugates thereof |
WO2017201449A1 (en) | 2016-05-20 | 2017-11-23 | Genentech, Inc. | Protac antibody conjugates and methods of use |
WO2017205741A1 (en) | 2016-05-27 | 2017-11-30 | Genentech, Inc. | Bioanalytical method for the characterization of site-specific antibody-drug conjugates |
WO2017214024A1 (en) | 2016-06-06 | 2017-12-14 | Genentech, Inc. | Silvestrol antibody-drug conjugates and methods of use |
WO2018031662A1 (en) | 2016-08-11 | 2018-02-15 | Genentech, Inc. | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine prodrugs and antibody conjugates thereof |
US9919056B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2018-03-20 | Adc Therapeutics S.A. | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-anti-CD22 antibody conjugates |
US9931414B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2018-04-03 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US9931415B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2018-04-03 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
WO2018065501A1 (en) | 2016-10-05 | 2018-04-12 | F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag | Methods for preparing antibody drug conjugates |
US9950078B2 (en) | 2013-10-11 | 2018-04-24 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US9956299B2 (en) | 2013-10-11 | 2018-05-01 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine—antibody conjugates |
US10010624B2 (en) | 2013-10-11 | 2018-07-03 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US10029018B2 (en) | 2013-10-11 | 2018-07-24 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2018189152A3 (en) * | 2017-04-10 | 2018-11-22 | Immatics Biotechnologies Gmbh | Peptides and combination of peptides for use in immunotherapy against leukemias and other cancers |
WO2019060398A1 (en) | 2017-09-20 | 2019-03-28 | Ph Pharma Co., Ltd. | Thailanstatin analogs |
US10323094B2 (en) | 2015-06-16 | 2019-06-18 | Genentech, Inc. | Humanized and affinity matured antibodies to FcRH5 and methods of use |
US10392393B2 (en) | 2016-01-26 | 2019-08-27 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines |
US10420777B2 (en) | 2014-09-12 | 2019-09-24 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
US10435471B2 (en) | 2013-06-24 | 2019-10-08 | Genentech, Inc. | Anti-FcRH5 antibodies |
US10544223B2 (en) | 2017-04-20 | 2020-01-28 | Adc Therapeutics Sa | Combination therapy with an anti-axl antibody-drug conjugate |
US10543279B2 (en) | 2016-04-29 | 2020-01-28 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine conjugates and their use for the treatment of cancer |
WO2020049286A1 (en) | 2018-09-03 | 2020-03-12 | Femtogenix Limited | Polycyclic amides as cytotoxic agents |
CN110944660A (en) * | 2017-04-10 | 2020-03-31 | 伊玛提克斯生物技术有限公司 | Peptides and peptide compositions for immunotherapy of leukemia and other cancers |
WO2020086858A1 (en) | 2018-10-24 | 2020-04-30 | Genentech, Inc. | Conjugated chemical inducers of degradation and methods of use |
WO2020123275A1 (en) | 2018-12-10 | 2020-06-18 | Genentech, Inc. | Photocrosslinking peptides for site specific conjugation to fc-containing proteins |
US10695439B2 (en) | 2016-02-10 | 2020-06-30 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine conjugates |
US10695433B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2020-06-30 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
WO2020157491A1 (en) | 2019-01-29 | 2020-08-06 | Femtogenix Limited | G-a crosslinking cytotoxic agents |
US10736903B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2020-08-11 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-anti-PSMA antibody conjugates |
US10751346B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2020-08-25 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine—anti-PSMA antibody conjugates |
US10780096B2 (en) | 2014-11-25 | 2020-09-22 | Adc Therapeutics Sa | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US10799595B2 (en) | 2016-10-14 | 2020-10-13 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine conjugates |
US11059893B2 (en) | 2015-04-15 | 2021-07-13 | Bergenbio Asa | Humanized anti-AXL antibodies |
US11135303B2 (en) | 2011-10-14 | 2021-10-05 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
US11160872B2 (en) | 2017-02-08 | 2021-11-02 | Adc Therapeutics Sa | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US11186650B2 (en) | 2013-12-17 | 2021-11-30 | Genentech, Inc. | Anti-CD3 antibodies and methods of use |
WO2022023735A1 (en) | 2020-07-28 | 2022-02-03 | Femtogenix Limited | Cytotoxic agents |
US11318211B2 (en) | 2017-06-14 | 2022-05-03 | Adc Therapeutics Sa | Dosage regimes for the administration of an anti-CD19 ADC |
US11352324B2 (en) | 2018-03-01 | 2022-06-07 | Medimmune Limited | Methods |
US11370801B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2022-06-28 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine conjugates |
US11517626B2 (en) | 2016-02-10 | 2022-12-06 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine antibody conjugates |
US11524969B2 (en) | 2018-04-12 | 2022-12-13 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof as antitumour agents |
US11612665B2 (en) | 2017-02-08 | 2023-03-28 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US11649250B2 (en) | 2017-08-18 | 2023-05-16 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine conjugates |
US11702473B2 (en) | 2015-04-15 | 2023-07-18 | Medimmune Limited | Site-specific antibody-drug conjugates |
WO2024138128A2 (en) | 2022-12-23 | 2024-06-27 | Genentech, Inc. | Cereblon degrader conjugates, and uses thereof |
WO2024220546A2 (en) | 2023-04-17 | 2024-10-24 | Peak Bio, Inc. | Antibodies and antibody-drug conjugates and methods of use and synthetic processes and intermediates |
Families Citing this family (15)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20050266008A1 (en) * | 2004-03-29 | 2005-12-01 | Medarex, Inc. | Human anti-IRTA-5 antibodies |
EP2078728A1 (en) * | 2008-01-14 | 2009-07-15 | Université de Liège | Novel isoform of versican and use in diagnosis and therapy |
ES2705849T3 (en) * | 2012-03-29 | 2019-03-26 | Becton Dickinson Co | Nucleic acids for the amplification of nucleic acids |
CN110627797A (en) | 2012-12-21 | 2019-12-31 | 麦迪穆有限责任公司 | Asymmetric pyrrolobenzodiazepine dimers for the treatment of proliferative and autoimmune diseases |
US9562049B2 (en) | 2012-12-21 | 2017-02-07 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
US10350216B2 (en) | 2013-01-14 | 2019-07-16 | The Trustees Of Columbia University In The City Of New York | Methods of treating, preventing and diagnosing leukemia and other blood diseases and disorders |
US20160336813A1 (en) | 2015-05-15 | 2016-11-17 | NeuSpera Medical Inc. | Midfield coupler |
GB201517538D0 (en) * | 2015-10-05 | 2015-11-18 | Immatics Biotechnologies Gmbh | Novel peptides and combination of peptides for use in immunotherapy against small cell lung cancer and other cancers |
MY198087A (en) | 2015-10-05 | 2023-07-31 | Immatics Biotechnologies Gmbh | Peptides and combination of peptides for use in immunotherapy against small cell lung cancer and other cancers |
GB201521746D0 (en) * | 2015-12-10 | 2016-01-27 | Immatics Biotechnologies Gmbh | Novel peptides and combination of peptides for use in immunotherapy against CLL and other cancers |
MA45784A (en) * | 2016-07-29 | 2019-06-05 | Juno Therapeutics Inc | ANTI-BODY ANTI-IDIOTYPES DIRECTED AGAINST ANTI-CD19 ANTIBODY |
EP3589733A1 (en) * | 2017-03-03 | 2020-01-08 | F1 Oncology, Inc. | Methods and compositions for transducing and expanding lymphocytes and regulating the activity thereof |
US11255850B2 (en) | 2019-03-28 | 2022-02-22 | Alentic Microscience Inc. | Bead-based analysis of a sample |
US10684278B1 (en) * | 2019-03-28 | 2020-06-16 | Alentic Microscience Inc. | Bead-based analysis of a sample |
US11609233B2 (en) | 2019-03-28 | 2023-03-21 | Alentic Microscience Inc. | Indicator-based analysis of a sample |
Family Cites Families (2)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US5342761A (en) * | 1990-10-01 | 1994-08-30 | Research Development Foundation | Oncofetal gene, gene product and uses therefor |
ES2568625T3 (en) * | 1999-11-29 | 2016-05-03 | The Trustees Of Columbia University In The City Of New York | Isolation of five novel genes encoding new Fc receptor-type melanomas involved in the pathogenesis of lymphoma / melanoma |
-
2002
- 2002-05-23 US US10/154,884 patent/US20040005561A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2002-11-06 JP JP2003575890A patent/JP2005523002A/en active Pending
- 2002-11-06 KR KR10-2004-7006885A patent/KR20040072626A/en not_active Application Discontinuation
- 2002-11-06 EP EP02807085A patent/EP1578347A4/en not_active Withdrawn
- 2002-11-06 CA CA 2463659 patent/CA2463659A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2002-11-06 US US10/494,740 patent/US20060269912A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2002-11-06 CN CNA028268555A patent/CN1635988A/en active Pending
- 2002-11-06 AU AU2002367594A patent/AU2002367594B8/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
- 2002-11-06 WO PCT/US2002/035728 patent/WO2003077836A2/en active Search and Examination
Non-Patent Citations (2)
Title |
---|
DATABASE GENBANK [Online] 30 June 2001 XU R. ET AL: 'Molecular Cloning and Characterization of SPAP1, and Inhibitory Receptor', XP002988867 Retrieved from NCBI Database accession no. (AF319438) * |
See also references of EP1578347A2 * |
Cited By (115)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
EP1572925A4 (en) * | 2002-05-15 | 2007-08-15 | Avalon Pharmaceuticals | Cancer-linked gene as target for chemotherapy |
EP1572925A2 (en) * | 2002-05-15 | 2005-09-14 | Avalon Pharmaceuticals | Cancer-linked gene as target for chemotherapy |
EP2478912A1 (en) | 2003-11-06 | 2012-07-25 | Seattle Genetics, Inc. | Auristatin conjugates with anti-HER2 or anti-CD22 antibodies and their use in therapy |
EP2260858A2 (en) | 2003-11-06 | 2010-12-15 | Seattle Genetics, Inc. | Monomethylvaline compounds capable of conjugation to ligands |
EP3858387A1 (en) | 2003-11-06 | 2021-08-04 | Seagen Inc. | Monomethylvaline compounds capable of conjugation to ligands |
EP3120861A1 (en) | 2003-11-06 | 2017-01-25 | Seattle Genetics, Inc. | Intermediate for conjugate preparation comprising auristatin derivatives and a linker |
EP3434275A1 (en) | 2003-11-06 | 2019-01-30 | Seattle Genetics, Inc. | Assay for cancer cells based on the use of auristatin conjugates with antibodies |
EP2489364A1 (en) | 2003-11-06 | 2012-08-22 | Seattle Genetics, Inc. | Monomethylvaline compounds onjugated to antibodies |
EP2486933A1 (en) | 2003-11-06 | 2012-08-15 | Seattle Genetics, Inc. | Monomethylvaline compounds conjugated with antibodies |
EP2286844A2 (en) | 2004-06-01 | 2011-02-23 | Genentech, Inc. | Antibody-drug conjugates and methods |
EP3088004A1 (en) | 2004-09-23 | 2016-11-02 | Genentech, Inc. | Cysteine engineered antibodies and conjugates |
WO2006060533A2 (en) | 2004-12-01 | 2006-06-08 | Genentech, Inc. | Conjugates of 1, 8-bis-naphthalimides with an antibody |
US9017951B2 (en) | 2009-04-01 | 2015-04-28 | Genenech, Inc. | Anti-FcRH5 antibodies and immunoconjugates and methods of use |
US8362213B2 (en) | 2009-04-01 | 2013-01-29 | Genentech, Inc. | Anti-FcRH5 antibodies and immunoconjugates and methods of use |
US9360484B2 (en) | 2009-04-01 | 2016-06-07 | Genentech, Inc. | Anti-FcRH5 antibodies and immunoconjugates and methods of use |
US8617559B2 (en) | 2009-04-01 | 2013-12-31 | Genetech, Inc. | Anti-FcRH5 antibodies and immunoconjugates and methods of use |
US8466260B2 (en) | 2009-04-01 | 2013-06-18 | Genentech, Inc. | Anti-FcRH5 antibodies and immunoconjugates and methods of use |
WO2011000054A1 (en) | 2009-07-03 | 2011-01-06 | Avipep Pty Ltd | Immuno-conjugates and methods for producing them |
WO2011031870A1 (en) | 2009-09-09 | 2011-03-17 | Centrose, Llc | Extracellular targeted drug conjugates |
WO2011056983A1 (en) | 2009-11-05 | 2011-05-12 | Genentech, Inc. | Zirconium-radiolabeled, cysteine engineered antibody conjugates |
WO2011075786A1 (en) | 2009-12-23 | 2011-06-30 | Avipep Pty Ltd | Immuno-conjugates and methods for producing them 2 |
WO2011130598A1 (en) | 2010-04-15 | 2011-10-20 | Spirogen Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2011156328A1 (en) | 2010-06-08 | 2011-12-15 | Genentech, Inc. | Cysteine engineered antibodies and conjugates |
WO2012074757A1 (en) | 2010-11-17 | 2012-06-07 | Genentech, Inc. | Alaninyl maytansinol antibody conjugates |
WO2012142662A1 (en) | 2011-04-21 | 2012-10-26 | Garvan Institute Of Medical Research | Modified variable domain molecules and methods for producing and using them b |
EP3103810A2 (en) | 2011-04-21 | 2016-12-14 | Garvan Institute of Medical Research | Modified variable domain molecules and methods for producing and using them |
WO2012155019A1 (en) | 2011-05-12 | 2012-11-15 | Genentech, Inc. | Multiple reaction monitoring lc-ms/ms method to detect therapeutic antibodies in animal samples using framework signature pepides |
US11135303B2 (en) | 2011-10-14 | 2021-10-05 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2013130093A1 (en) | 2012-03-02 | 2013-09-06 | Genentech, Inc. | Biomarkers for treatment with anti-tubulin chemotherapeutic compounds |
US10335497B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2019-07-02 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
US10646584B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2020-05-12 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
US11771775B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2023-10-03 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US11701430B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2023-07-18 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
US11690918B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2023-07-04 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-anti-CD22 antibody conjugates |
US12121590B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2024-10-22 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
US9931414B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2018-04-03 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
EP2839860A1 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2015-02-25 | Spirogen Sàrl | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
US9931415B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2018-04-03 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US11779650B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2023-10-10 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US9919056B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2018-03-20 | Adc Therapeutics S.A. | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-anti-CD22 antibody conjugates |
WO2014057074A1 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2014-04-17 | Spirogen Sàrl | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
US10994023B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2021-05-04 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
US10799596B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2020-10-13 | Adc Therapeutics S.A. | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US10780181B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2020-09-22 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US10751346B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2020-08-25 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine—anti-PSMA antibody conjugates |
US10736903B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2020-08-11 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-anti-PSMA antibody conjugates |
US10722594B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2020-07-28 | Adc Therapeutics S.A. | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-anti-CD22 antibody conjugates |
US9889207B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2018-02-13 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
US10695433B2 (en) | 2012-10-12 | 2020-06-30 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
WO2014159981A2 (en) | 2013-03-13 | 2014-10-02 | Spirogen Sarl | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2014140174A1 (en) | 2013-03-13 | 2014-09-18 | Spirogen Sàrl | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2014140862A2 (en) | 2013-03-13 | 2014-09-18 | Spirogen Sarl | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
US11352431B2 (en) | 2013-06-24 | 2022-06-07 | Genentech, Inc. | Anti-FCRH5 antibodies |
US10435471B2 (en) | 2013-06-24 | 2019-10-08 | Genentech, Inc. | Anti-FcRH5 antibodies |
WO2015023355A1 (en) | 2013-08-12 | 2015-02-19 | Genentech, Inc. | 1-(chloromethyl)-2,3-dihydro-1h-benzo[e]indole dimer antibody-drug conjugate compounds, and methods of use and treatment |
US9950078B2 (en) | 2013-10-11 | 2018-04-24 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US9956299B2 (en) | 2013-10-11 | 2018-05-01 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine—antibody conjugates |
US10010624B2 (en) | 2013-10-11 | 2018-07-03 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US10029018B2 (en) | 2013-10-11 | 2018-07-24 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2015095227A2 (en) | 2013-12-16 | 2015-06-25 | Genentech, Inc. | Peptidomimetic compounds and antibody-drug conjugates thereof |
WO2015095212A1 (en) | 2013-12-16 | 2015-06-25 | Genentech, Inc. | 1-(chloromethyl)-2,3-dihydro-1h-benzo[e]indole dimer antibody-drug conjugate compounds, and methods of use and treatment |
WO2015095223A2 (en) | 2013-12-16 | 2015-06-25 | Genentech, Inc. | Peptidomimetic compounds and antibody-drug conjugates thereof |
US11186650B2 (en) | 2013-12-17 | 2021-11-30 | Genentech, Inc. | Anti-CD3 antibodies and methods of use |
US10188746B2 (en) | 2014-09-10 | 2019-01-29 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2016037644A1 (en) | 2014-09-10 | 2016-03-17 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2016040825A1 (en) | 2014-09-12 | 2016-03-17 | Genentech, Inc. | Anthracycline disulfide intermediates, antibody-drug conjugates and methods |
US10420777B2 (en) | 2014-09-12 | 2019-09-24 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof |
WO2016040856A2 (en) | 2014-09-12 | 2016-03-17 | Genentech, Inc. | Cysteine engineered antibodies and conjugates |
EP3235820A1 (en) | 2014-09-17 | 2017-10-25 | Genentech, Inc. | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and antibody disulfide conjugates thereof |
US10780096B2 (en) | 2014-11-25 | 2020-09-22 | Adc Therapeutics Sa | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
WO2016090050A1 (en) | 2014-12-03 | 2016-06-09 | Genentech, Inc. | Quaternary amine compounds and antibody-drug conjugates thereof |
US11702473B2 (en) | 2015-04-15 | 2023-07-18 | Medimmune Limited | Site-specific antibody-drug conjugates |
US11059893B2 (en) | 2015-04-15 | 2021-07-13 | Bergenbio Asa | Humanized anti-AXL antibodies |
US11192950B2 (en) | 2015-06-16 | 2021-12-07 | Genentech, Inc. | Humanized and affinity matured antibodies to FcRH5 and methods of use |
US10323094B2 (en) | 2015-06-16 | 2019-06-18 | Genentech, Inc. | Humanized and affinity matured antibodies to FcRH5 and methods of use |
US12030947B2 (en) | 2015-06-16 | 2024-07-09 | Genentech, Inc. | Humanized and affinity matured antibodies to FcRH5 and methods of use |
WO2017059289A1 (en) | 2015-10-02 | 2017-04-06 | Genentech, Inc. | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine antibody drug conjugates and methods of use |
WO2017064675A1 (en) | 2015-10-16 | 2017-04-20 | Genentech, Inc. | Hindered disulfide drug conjugates |
WO2017068511A1 (en) | 2015-10-20 | 2017-04-27 | Genentech, Inc. | Calicheamicin-antibody-drug conjugates and methods of use |
US10392393B2 (en) | 2016-01-26 | 2019-08-27 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines |
US10695439B2 (en) | 2016-02-10 | 2020-06-30 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine conjugates |
US11517626B2 (en) | 2016-02-10 | 2022-12-06 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine antibody conjugates |
WO2017165734A1 (en) | 2016-03-25 | 2017-09-28 | Genentech, Inc. | Multiplexed total antibody and antibody-conjugated drug quantification assay |
EP4273551A2 (en) | 2016-03-25 | 2023-11-08 | F. Hoffmann-La Roche AG | Multiplexed total antibody and antibody-conjugated drug quantification assay |
US10543279B2 (en) | 2016-04-29 | 2020-01-28 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine conjugates and their use for the treatment of cancer |
WO2017201449A1 (en) | 2016-05-20 | 2017-11-23 | Genentech, Inc. | Protac antibody conjugates and methods of use |
WO2017205741A1 (en) | 2016-05-27 | 2017-11-30 | Genentech, Inc. | Bioanalytical method for the characterization of site-specific antibody-drug conjugates |
WO2017214024A1 (en) | 2016-06-06 | 2017-12-14 | Genentech, Inc. | Silvestrol antibody-drug conjugates and methods of use |
WO2018031662A1 (en) | 2016-08-11 | 2018-02-15 | Genentech, Inc. | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine prodrugs and antibody conjugates thereof |
WO2018065501A1 (en) | 2016-10-05 | 2018-04-12 | F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag | Methods for preparing antibody drug conjugates |
US10799595B2 (en) | 2016-10-14 | 2020-10-13 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine conjugates |
US11160872B2 (en) | 2017-02-08 | 2021-11-02 | Adc Therapeutics Sa | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US11813335B2 (en) | 2017-02-08 | 2023-11-14 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
US11612665B2 (en) | 2017-02-08 | 2023-03-28 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates |
CN110944660A (en) * | 2017-04-10 | 2020-03-31 | 伊玛提克斯生物技术有限公司 | Peptides and peptide compositions for immunotherapy of leukemia and other cancers |
US10899819B2 (en) | 2017-04-10 | 2021-01-26 | Immatics Biotechnologies Gmbh | Peptides and combination of peptides for use in immunotherapy against leukemias and other cancers |
WO2018189152A3 (en) * | 2017-04-10 | 2018-11-22 | Immatics Biotechnologies Gmbh | Peptides and combination of peptides for use in immunotherapy against leukemias and other cancers |
US10993963B2 (en) | 2017-04-10 | 2021-05-04 | Immatics Biotechnologies Gmbh | Peptides and combination of peptides for use in immunotherapy against leukemias and other cancers |
US11135246B2 (en) | 2017-04-10 | 2021-10-05 | Immatics Biotechnologies Gmbh | Peptides and combination of peptides for use in immunotherapy against leukemias and other cancers |
US11559550B2 (en) | 2017-04-10 | 2023-01-24 | Immatics Biotechnologies Gmbh | Peptides and combination of peptides for use in immunotherapy against leukemias and other cancers |
US11370801B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2022-06-28 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine conjugates |
US10544223B2 (en) | 2017-04-20 | 2020-01-28 | Adc Therapeutics Sa | Combination therapy with an anti-axl antibody-drug conjugate |
US11318211B2 (en) | 2017-06-14 | 2022-05-03 | Adc Therapeutics Sa | Dosage regimes for the administration of an anti-CD19 ADC |
US11938192B2 (en) | 2017-06-14 | 2024-03-26 | Medimmune Limited | Dosage regimes for the administration of an anti-CD19 ADC |
US11649250B2 (en) | 2017-08-18 | 2023-05-16 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepine conjugates |
WO2019060398A1 (en) | 2017-09-20 | 2019-03-28 | Ph Pharma Co., Ltd. | Thailanstatin analogs |
US11352324B2 (en) | 2018-03-01 | 2022-06-07 | Medimmune Limited | Methods |
US11524969B2 (en) | 2018-04-12 | 2022-12-13 | Medimmune Limited | Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof as antitumour agents |
WO2020049286A1 (en) | 2018-09-03 | 2020-03-12 | Femtogenix Limited | Polycyclic amides as cytotoxic agents |
WO2020086858A1 (en) | 2018-10-24 | 2020-04-30 | Genentech, Inc. | Conjugated chemical inducers of degradation and methods of use |
WO2020123275A1 (en) | 2018-12-10 | 2020-06-18 | Genentech, Inc. | Photocrosslinking peptides for site specific conjugation to fc-containing proteins |
WO2020157491A1 (en) | 2019-01-29 | 2020-08-06 | Femtogenix Limited | G-a crosslinking cytotoxic agents |
WO2022023735A1 (en) | 2020-07-28 | 2022-02-03 | Femtogenix Limited | Cytotoxic agents |
WO2024138128A2 (en) | 2022-12-23 | 2024-06-27 | Genentech, Inc. | Cereblon degrader conjugates, and uses thereof |
WO2024220546A2 (en) | 2023-04-17 | 2024-10-24 | Peak Bio, Inc. | Antibodies and antibody-drug conjugates and methods of use and synthetic processes and intermediates |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
CN1635988A (en) | 2005-07-06 |
WO2003077836A3 (en) | 2005-08-11 |
KR20040072626A (en) | 2004-08-18 |
US20060269912A1 (en) | 2006-11-30 |
US20040005561A1 (en) | 2004-01-08 |
AU2002367594B8 (en) | 2008-10-09 |
CA2463659A1 (en) | 2003-09-25 |
EP1578347A4 (en) | 2008-05-21 |
EP1578347A2 (en) | 2005-09-28 |
AU2002367594A1 (en) | 2003-09-29 |
JP2005523002A (en) | 2005-08-04 |
AU2002367594B2 (en) | 2008-09-11 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
AU2002367594B8 (en) | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies | |
US8071732B2 (en) | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies | |
AU2003210670A1 (en) | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematogolical malignancies | |
US6630574B1 (en) | Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of lung cancer | |
JP5053497B2 (en) | Compositions and methods for the treatment and diagnosis of breast cancer | |
US20020198362A1 (en) | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies | |
US6844325B2 (en) | Compositions for the treatment and diagnosis of breast cancer and methods for their use | |
US20020022591A1 (en) | Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of ovarian cancer | |
US20040175739A1 (en) | Compositions and methods for the detection, diagnosis and therapy of hematological malignancies | |
US6686447B1 (en) | Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of lung cancer | |
US20030008299A1 (en) | Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of ovarian cancer | |
GAIGER et al. | Patent 2473746 Summary | |
KR20030008369A (en) | Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of breast cancer | |
AU2007201253A1 (en) | Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of breast cancer | |
ZA200208365B (en) | Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of breast cancer. |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
AK | Designated states |
Kind code of ref document: A2 Designated state(s): AE AG AL AM AT AU AZ BA BB BG BR BY BZ CA CH CN CO CR CU CZ DE DK DM DZ EC EE ES FI GB GD GE GH GM HR HU ID IL IN IS JP KE KG KP KR KZ LC LK LR LS LT LU LV MA MD MG MK MN MW MX MZ NO NZ OM PH PL PT RO RU SD SE SG SI SK SL TJ TM TN TR TT TZ UA UG US UZ VC VN YU ZA ZM ZW |
|
AL | Designated countries for regional patents |
Kind code of ref document: A2 Designated state(s): GH GM KE LS MW MZ SD SL SZ TZ UG ZM ZW AM AZ BY KG KZ MD RU TJ TM AT BE BG CH CY CZ DE DK EE ES FI FR GB GR IE IT LU MC NL PT SE SK TR BF BJ CF CG CI CM GA GN GQ GW ML MR NE SN TD TG |
|
121 | Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application | ||
WWE | Wipo information: entry into national phase |
Ref document number: 2463659 Country of ref document: CA |
|
WWE | Wipo information: entry into national phase |
Ref document number: 2003575890 Country of ref document: JP Ref document number: 1020047006885 Country of ref document: KR |
|
WWE | Wipo information: entry into national phase |
Ref document number: 2002367594 Country of ref document: AU |
|
WWE | Wipo information: entry into national phase |
Ref document number: 532979 Country of ref document: NZ |
|
WWE | Wipo information: entry into national phase |
Ref document number: 2002807085 Country of ref document: EP |
|
WWE | Wipo information: entry into national phase |
Ref document number: 20028268555 Country of ref document: CN |
|
WWE | Wipo information: entry into national phase |
Ref document number: 2006269912 Country of ref document: US Ref document number: 10494740 Country of ref document: US |
|
WWP | Wipo information: published in national office |
Ref document number: 2002807085 Country of ref document: EP |
|
WWP | Wipo information: published in national office |
Ref document number: 10494740 Country of ref document: US |
|
DFPE | Request for preliminary examination filed prior to expiration of 19th month from priority date (pct application filed before 20040101) |